Samsung GSM Smartphone Galaxy S II Plus I9105 Android GT-I9105P - Mode d'emploi - Manuel de l'utilisateur - Manuels SAMSUNG sur FNAC.COM  - Liste des manuels utilisateur Samsung - Revenir à l'accueil

 

 

Description

Date de publication 

Langue

Fichier 

Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.03.14 NÉERLANDAIS (T-Mobile) 17.85 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.02.13 ALLEMAND (DTM) 7.25 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.02.01 ANGLAIS (DTM) 17.36 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.01.23 ALLEMAND 16.35 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.01.23 FRANÇAIS (suisse) 6.63 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.01.23 FRANÇAIS 0.01MB
Quick Start Guide 2013.01.16 FRANÇAIS 1.57 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2013.01.10 NÉERLANDAIS 6.26 MB
Instructions de sécurité 2012.11.13 ENGLISH(Europe), BULGARIAN, DUTCH, FRENCH(FRANCE), GERMAN, POLISH 6.28 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2012.11.13 ANGLAIS (EUROPE) 6.28 MB
COMMANDER un produit SAMSUNG sur FNAC.COM 

 

Liste des manuels APPLE Liste des produits Sony Liste des produits Dell Liste des Manuels Samsung Listes des Manuels Konica Minolta

Manuels Utilisateurs Samsung :

Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Ordinateur-portable-serie-9-NP900X3C-A02ZA-de-Samsung-Manuels

Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-5-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-H01ZA-Manuels

Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-5-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-H01ZA-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5570-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-Refrigerateur-Combine-RB29FEJNDWW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-noir-Open-market-GT-S5600-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-Table-induction-2-zones-7-2-KW-CTN364N006-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-Camera-WB250F-SAMSUNG-WB250F-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B530-LE37B530P7W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12NSBN-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F90WP-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D4003BW-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-SH24TA6D-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH200WHXES-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C457C6H-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22A455C1D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5000-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TV-UE22ES5000W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-152B-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2240W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-40-UE40D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE40D5000PW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Jetnoir-Open-market-GT-S8000-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-64-PS64D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS64D8000FS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7510-M16-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5750E-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-360-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-5637FR-SCX-5637FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-775ND-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RV510I-NP-RV510-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T24B300-T24B300EW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-16ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1660-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T23A750-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-DVD-DVD-D530WXZF-serie-5-DVD-D530-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Ultra-rouge-open-market-GT-S8300-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-N140-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS05FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-T01FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26B350F1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A465C1M-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT63VBPN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE52A568-LE52A568P3M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22B650-LE22B650T6W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS58B680-PS58B680T6W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A465-LE32A465C1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C452C4H-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-WS32V54N-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T27B750EW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-S23A350H-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL100-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-Ecran-avant-LCD-1-5-compact-double-ecran-Samsung-PL120-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2231-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-RL34HGMG-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18PSBX-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH18AP2X-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FJEA-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGEN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-LE40A796-LE40A796R2M-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09UGAX-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS0351DXEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-32-LE32D550WXZF-serie-5-HD-TV-LCD-TV-LE32D550K1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE19C4000PW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A536T1F-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-55-Moniteur-LED-UD55A-mur-d-image-bord-fin-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6000-UE46C6000RW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimantes-Photos-SPP-2040-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-16ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-3205-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-460DR-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12UGBN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8240NA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B653T5P-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A456C2D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A426-PS42A426C1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE19B450C4H-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C5100QW-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18KBAX-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH060FXEA3A-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6900VS-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXCSH028EE-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXTJH036EE-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A457C1D-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S03FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S05FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-S04FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A04FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S07FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300V5AH-NP300V5A-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AI-NP300E7A-A04FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A04FR

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T03FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S08FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-A05FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T05FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP500A2D-S02FR-2-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C8700XS-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6750WS-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6200TS-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B550-PS50B550T4W-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S04FR-manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-RVXMHF050EA-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9103-manuels

Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-MZ-7TD120-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-ES4200-ZFHT-ES4200-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300V3AH-NP300V3A-S02FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S06FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-NP350V5C-S07FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie%209-900X1A-NP900X1A-A01FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1AXE-700T1A-A02FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A01FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-A04FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AH-NP300E7A-S0DFR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X3C-NP900X3C-A03FR-manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F800BP-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T03FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4B-NP900X4B-A01FR-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5369-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE700T1A-XE700T1A-HF1FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T06FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A05FR-NP900X3D-A05FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S0AFR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24A650S-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27C650D-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B970D-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GS1CW-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-H02FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-S08FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X3C-A05FR-NP900X3C-A05FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP500A2D-S02FR-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-N7100-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D8000FS-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D7000LS-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS43E450-ZF-PLASMA-43-HD-TV-PS43E450A1W-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-2-noir-Open-market-GT-S5620-manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3500-noir-Open-market-GT-S3500-manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS071SDXEA-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A626-LE37A626A3M-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500C21-XE500C21-AZ2FR-manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5C-NP300E5C-T02FR-manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-27-UE27D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE27D5000NW-2-manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1130-B.manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S03FR.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1310-NRJ-Mobile-GT-E1310B.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2220.manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12TSBN.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-C3750.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2550D.manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12FAN

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ES60-SAMSUNG-ES60.manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12KBAN-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH020FNEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6570S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3D-UE32ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6560S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6100W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D6300WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D6300SS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D8000YS-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FWEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530-LE37C530F1W.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5620.manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09KBBN.manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W.manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-F480G.manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S0CFR.manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6710S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-32-UE32D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6500VS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5410-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TVUE22ES5410W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D8000YQ-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18UGAN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C490-PS50C490B3W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH068FXEA4-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS51D6900DS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D450G1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A676-PS50A676T1M-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FEEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6540S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700-UE55C8790XS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6570WS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6530S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6560S-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I8190-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1CW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100P-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32S86BD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42C96HD-PS-42C96HD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32T51B-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A456-PS42A456P2D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-46-UE46D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D5000PW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS59D530A5W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C6700-UE32C6700US-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-43-PS43D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-PDP-TVPS43D450A2W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B7000-UE46B7000WW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE32D5000PW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS43D490A1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22ES5400WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C350D1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6000RH-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-ES6000-ZF-Lecteur-Blu-Ray-3D-SMART-HUB-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuals-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5000PW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C450MR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C200NW-Manuels

Samsung-InformatiqueMoniteur-LCD-S19C450MW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5000NH-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG32EA590LS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450-LE32C450E1W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-User-Manuals-Manuel

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-User-Manuals-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D7000LS-User-Manuals-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A466-PS42A466P2M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A466-LE26A466C2M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C6970-PS50C6970YS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Telephone-coulissant-Samsung-S5200-bleu-SFRGT-S5200-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A456-LE32A456C2D-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAX-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH160PHXEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C7000YW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE22D5000NW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5380-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P3100-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Galaxy-Tab-GT-P1000-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Nexus-noir-Open-market-GT-I9250-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9000-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-GT-N7000-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C430C4W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FJEA-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700XS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS63B680-PS63B680T6W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C630-LE40C630K1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6100W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Pieton-Bluetooth-HM1700-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A577P2M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS64E8000-ZF-PLASMA-64-SMART-INTERACTION-3DPS64E8000GS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-B1930N-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B651-LE32B651T3P-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-27-UE27D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE27D5000NW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B7000-UE40B7000WW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6500VH-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-CW29Z504N-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A856-LE40A856S1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES8000S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22B450-LE22B450C4W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE39EH5003W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40EH6030W-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A437T2D-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PWAN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TVUE46ES5500W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530F1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5300W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES7000S-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXWNH022EE-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Mains-Libres-Bluetooth-HF1000-BHF1000-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-Cassette-4-voies-MH035FMEA-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09PSBX-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D550K1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6100W-AQV09PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450-LE26C450E1W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE60EH6000S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-5.0-Blanc-8G-YP-G70CW-Manuels

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo 3D UE32D6300SS

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE32A437T2D

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV PDP PS50A466 PS50A466P2M

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LED UE46EH5300W

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LED UE37C6000UE37C6000RW

Samsung Informatique Moniteur LCD 770TFT

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 51" cерия 5 Full HD PS51E530 PS51E530A3W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE46EH5000W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE46D5000PW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 26" серия 4 HD LED UE26EH4000UE26EH4000W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 42" Серия 4 HD PS42C431A2 PS42C431A2W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 46" серия 5 SMART TV Full HD LED UE46EH5300 UE46EH5300W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные PS42A410C3 Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D Телевизор 40" серия 6 SMART TV 3D Full HD LED UE40ES6100 UE40ES6100W Russe

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE40B651LE40B651T3W

Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE40B651LE40B651T3W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE55B7000WW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UE40ES7500S Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D Телевизор 40" серия 6 SMART TV 3D Full HD LED UE40ES6100 UE40ES6100W Russe4

Samsung Мобильные телефоны Мобильные телефоны C3510 TVGT-C3510T Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные PS42B430P2W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UE46D7000LS Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D LED телевизор 40" Серия 7 3D SMART TV Full HD UE40D7000L UE40D7000LS Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры 37" FULL HD LED телевизор серии 5 UE37EH5007KUE37EH5007K Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры LED телевизор 32" Серия 5 Full HD UE32C5000Q UE32C5000QW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 46" серия 5 SMART TV Full HD LED UE46EH5307 UE46EH5307K Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника ЖК-телевизоры ЖК телевизор 40" Серия 5 Full HD LE40C530F1 LE40C530F1W Russe

Samsung Мобильные телефоны Смартфоны Samsung S6012 GT-S5830I Russe

Samsung Мобильные телефоны Смартфоны GT-S5830I Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника ЖК-телевизоры LE40C530F1W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UA55D6600WR Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 43" cерия 4 HD PS43E450PS43E450A1W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 32" серия 5 Full HD LED UE32EH5040 UE32EH5040W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры LED телевизор 40" Серия 6 Full HD UE40C6000R UE40C6000RW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника ЖК-телевизоры LE32B450C4W Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UA40C7000WR Russe

Samsung Бытовая техника Настенное крепление Настенная сплит-система "Стандарт" AQ07RLAQ07RLN Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UA40C5000QR Russe

TV Audio / Vidéo 3D 40", UE40D6200WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV UE40D6200TS

Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры LED телевизор 32" Серия 4 HD UE32C4000P UE32C4000PW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D LED телевизор 40" Серия 6 3D SMART TV Full HD UE40D6100S UE40D6100SW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D Телевизор 55" серия 8 3D SMART TV Full HD LED UE55ES8007 UE55ES8007U Russe

Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 40" серия 5 SMART TV Full HD LED UE40EH5307 UE40EH5307K

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D LED телевизор 46" Серия 8 3D SMART TV Full HD UE46D8000Y UE46D8000YS Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D Телевизор 65" серия 8 SMART TV 3D Full HD LED UE65ES8007 UE65ES8007U Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE32D5000PW Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D Плазма 51" Серия 8 3D SMART TV Full HD PS51D8000F PS51D8000FS Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 40" серия 5 Full HD LED UE40EH5047 UE40EH5047K Russe

Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры Телевизор 40" серия 5 SMART TV Full HD LED UE40ES5537 UE40ES5537K Russe

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1EW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Francais-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50Q96HD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C5100QW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B7020WW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PH-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ09UGFN-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-12-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-compact-essentiel-Samsung-ES80-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF1702NHWG-YLE-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-U100-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P5100-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E570-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5720RS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-R200-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A457C1D-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS08FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-France-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-LED-UE40B7000WW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3185FN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-300-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Francais-Manuels

Samsung-Monitors-2493HM-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels

Samsung-Exhibit-4G-Android-Smartphone-SGH-T759-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6100W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D7000LS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40C7700WS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6500VQ-Manuels

Samsung-Refrigerators-26-CU-FT-FRENCH-DOOR-REFRIGERATOR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-QX510-NP-QX510-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Francais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-Q35-NP-Q35T007-SEF-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Francais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9201NA-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9301NA-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-francais-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S5150-gold-Open-market-GT-S5150-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-Neo-Forte-EHS-Hybride-NH022NHXEA-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-S06FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19-D4003-Series-4-LED-TV%20-UE19D4003BW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Netbook-NP-N220-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-R519-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Inde-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8123NA-Manuels

Samsung-SCX-3400-Pakistan-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-ATIV-Smart-PC-XE500T1C-3G-XE500T1C-H01SG-Singapour-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-S06FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19-D4003-Series-4-LED-TV%20-UE19D4003BW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Netbook-NP-N220-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-R519-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Inde-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8123NA-Manuels

Samsung-SCX-3400-Pakistan-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-ATIV-Smart-PC-XE500T1C-3G-XE500T1C-H01SG-Singapour-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-ML-1674-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3100-gris-Open-market-GT-S3100-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000-UE32C4000PW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T23A350-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B350F1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-BD-P1600A-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-C6930W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26C4000PW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R719NP-R719-XA01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-Basic-Kit-64-GoMZ-7PC064B-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Samsung-Smart-Camera-NX210-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Sans-sac-SC8850-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-gril-niche-380-mm-23-L-FG87SST-FG87SST-XEF-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBSL-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBWQ-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Feature-Phone-GT-E1175T-Anglais-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C530-LE46C530F1W-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Nexus-GT-I9250-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-550-noir-Open-market-GT-I5500-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-WB100-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-E430D-Micro-chaine-DVD-DivX-Double-Dock-USB-Bluetooth-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YH-820MW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S22B150N-Manuels

Samsung-Stockage-informatique-Graveur-DVD-Slim-External-8X-DVD-Writer-SE-208AB-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-CTN431SC0S-Manuels

24ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6250FX-Samsung-Manuels

32-UE32D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6200TS-Samsung-Manuels

35-35ppm-Copieur-couleur-CLX-9350ND-Samsung-Manuels

Galaxy-Y-S5360-AndroidGT-S5360-Manuels-Utilisateur-et-Guides-Rapide-Samsung

Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-19-UE19D4000WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LED-TV-UE19D4000NW-Samsung

N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels

Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R730-Red-Gloss-NP-R730-JS01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-SGH-I320-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV510-NP-RV510-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7ANP300E7A-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D7000LS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1150-rouge-Open-market-GT-E1150-Manuels

Samsung-Téléphone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT08FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Style-Open-market-SGH-F480-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-NP350V5C-S03FR-Manuels

Samsung-RV511-NP-RV511-A06MA-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R590-Crystal-NP-R590-JS01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R530E-NP-R530-JT50FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C630-LE32C630K1W-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-S850-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6530WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D6530WS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-City-blanc-Orange-GT-S5260P-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-PDP-2012-PS43E450A1R-43-inch-HD-Ready-Plasma-TV-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Robot-Aspirateur-Robot-2-murs-Virtuel-Noir-SR8895-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E2530-Open-market-GT-E2530-Manuels

Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-3405W-Manuels

Samsung-I9300-GT-I9300-Afrique-du-Nord-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels

Samsung-Camera-Camcorder-Compact-ST66-SAMSUNG-ST66-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-Mono-Multi-function-SCX-3405FW-Hong-Kong-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Samsung-GALAXY-S-III-GALAXY-S3-GT-I9300-Singapour-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Music-GT-S6010-Royaume-Uni-Manuels

Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Mounted-Fridge-Freezer-SR365TSS-Nouvelle-Zelande-Manuels

Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Loader-Top-Load-Washing-Machine-WA10W9-Singapour-Manuels

Samsung-electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Belgique-Manuels

Samsung-PC-Office-LCD-LED-S22C200BW-Hong-Kong-Manuels

Samsung-Camaras-Alta-definicion-Videocamara-HD-F80HMX-F80SP-Espagne-Manuels

Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels

Samsung-Sprzet-komputerowy-i-Drukarki-Notebooki-NP-R710-AS04PL-Pologne-Manuels

Samsung-Informatica-LCD-2043SW-Portugues-Portugais-Bresil-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu-ray-HT-E3550-English-Anglais-Manuels

Samsung-Camera-Camcorder-Compact-ES90-14.2MP-Digital-Camera-FIND-A-PRODUCT-SAMSUNG-ES90-English-Anglais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X1B-NP900X1B-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0CFR-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT50QMSW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46EH6030W-Manuels

Samsung-Home-Appliance-Side-by-Side-RSA1STMG-Arabe-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS59D6900DS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7C-NP700Z7C-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-Side-By-Side-RS6178UGDSR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-S730-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E590-Manuels

20ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6220FX-Samsung-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5100P-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Francais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT0BFR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-francais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-francais-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF5FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C520-Hello-Kitty-Open-marketS-GH-C520-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-Player-mini-2GT-C3310-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A06FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5C-NP700Z5C-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-Z360-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A856-LE46A856S1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B620T2WXXC-LE40B620R3W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A568-LE40A568P3M-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ18FAN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22D450G1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D6200TS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-NL22B-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0BFR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A568-LE46A568P3M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE65ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-65-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE65ES8000S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-C6625-gris-Open-market-GT-C6625-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B8000WW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Corby-Pro-rouge-Open-market-GT-B5310-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-SBS-A-507-L-Blanc-RSA1TWP-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D430DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A626-LE40A626A3M-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-GT-C3310-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C3520-GT-C3520-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrig%C3%A9rateur-SBS-A-510-L-Inox-RSH5TERS-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-mono-23L-SILVER-ME82V-Manuels*

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D503F7W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-RSA1DTMG-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-6900-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-C5530-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B300BL-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-D4200-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730C-NP-R730-JB03FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-R-mix-YP-R1JCP-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-P2470HD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J770-Open-market-SGH-J770-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Home-cinema-DVD-5.1-HT-D350WXZF-serie-3HT-D350-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-6200FX-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-Smart-Camera-WB850F-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A456-PS50A456P2D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6570WS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-22-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T22A300-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-S2-YP-S2QB-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-24ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-2580N-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-3710ND-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5003BW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P2500-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Definition-Standard-5-MP-Ecran-LCD-2.7-6.86-cm-Camescope-SD-Samsung-F700-SMX-F700BP-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R710-NP-R710-ASS1FR-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL101-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A566P1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46D550K1W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH026FWEA-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV07PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B850-PS50B850Y1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37D5000ZF-UE37D5000PW-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH300WHXES-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40ES5700S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-60-UE60D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE60D8000YS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D403E2W-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ST500-SAMSUNG-ST500-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5610-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-27-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T27A300-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1170-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40R86BD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C350-LE22C350D1W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J700-SGH-J700G-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-Gril-23L-SILVER-GS89F-1SPGS89F-1SP-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B5B-NP400B5B-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-12-5-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B2B-NP400B2B-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-RC-RC730-NP-RC730-S05FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-3405W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-RC-RC530-NP-RC530-S03FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5-ANP300E5A-S08FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-Lecteur-blu-ray-BD-D6900WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3DBD-D6900-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A568-LE37A568P3M-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-24-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T24A350-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-G600-Open-market-SGH-G600-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-DA-E650-ZF-Double-Dock-Bluetooth-3.0-USB-AUXDA-E650-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-QF20BP-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-PL90-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C550-LE32C550J1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE23R86BD-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450E1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A436T1D-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1151-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-P3YP-P3JCB-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique%20Multifonction-Monochrome-24ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4824FN-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1A-3G-XE700T1A-H01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-F250-Open-market-SGH-F250-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730-NP-R730-JA05FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X3C-NP900X3C-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4.0-Blanc-8GoYP-G1CW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D470DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-MM-D470D-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Solid-B2100-rouge-Open-market-GT-B2100-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U3B-NP530U3B-A02FR-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Chat-335-gris-Open-market-GT-S3350-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-GT-S5690-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B530P7W-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF0702NBE-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-Home-cinema-blu-ray-HT-D6750WWXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C7700-UE55C7700WS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-E8300-ZF-Enregistreur-Blu-Ray-320-Go-SMART-HUB-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-DVD-SH893-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Systeme-NX-NX100-14-6-MP-Ecran-7-6cm-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-365-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-305E5A-NP305E5A-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-2-Gamme-Professionnelle-200A5B-NP200B5B-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Samsung-Q3YP-Q3CB-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-B3310bleu-Open-market-GT-B3310-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600B-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E250-Open-market-SGH-E250-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B350H-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S0BFR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES7000S-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-NP900X4D-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7CH-NP700Z7C-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z3A-NP700Z3A-S02FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-SUR40-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6510WS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-300V3A-NP300V3A-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-NC10-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I5800-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2160-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R720E-NP-R720-JS03FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT07FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R620E-NP-R620-JS02FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D5720RS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP550P5C-NP550P5C-T04FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D8000YS-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV515-NP-RV515-S04FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3DUE46ES6710S-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-2MP-Ecran-3-hVGA-Smart-Camera-Samsung-WB150F-SAMSUNG-WB150F-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG40EA590LS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-E8200-ZF-Barre-de-son-Blu-Ray-3D-Bluetooth-HT-E8200-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-CE117PPT-Manuels

Samsung-TV-AV-3D-TV-TV-UN50ES6350F-Coree-du-Sud-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-19ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4200-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-32-32ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-770ND-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-320-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9000-RW8-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-TC220W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9001-M8-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels-Mode-d-emploi

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-I9070P-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE40C750-LE40C750R2W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-UE32ES5500W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A676-LE40A676A1M-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5230-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40EH5300W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46B651-LE46B651T3W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5010NW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi%203.6-Noir-8GoYP-GS1CB-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5000-ZF-LED-32-FULL-HD-UE32EH5000W-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-blanc-SFR-GT-N7000-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7.0-Wi-FiGT-P3110-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7300-M16-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-noir-SFRGT-N7000-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6900S-ZF-Slim-LED-50-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D6500VS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A676-LE32A676A1M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE55D6200TS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6540S-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6750WS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450E1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C530-LE40C530F1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6750WS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B6000-UE40B6000VW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A556P1F-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6710-UE46C6710US-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C530-PS50C530C1W-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U4B-NP530U4B-S01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-DV90-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-460DR-2-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME32B-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Samsung-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT41MASW-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P6800-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-C24B550U-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-Lave-linge-EcoBubble-12kg-1400tours-WF1124XBC-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Ampli-Tuner-AV-HW-E551-ZF-Barre-de-son-Format-46-Convertible-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Phone-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF2FR-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV24PSBN-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37B6000VW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A466-LE40A466C2M-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A676-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXDUH112EE-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B651T3P-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-S5220GT-S5220-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59NBPN-Manuels

Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B750V-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME75B-Manuels

Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59PMSW-Manuels

Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3Serie-9-900X3A-NP900X3A-A01FR-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME40B-Manuels

Samsung-SGH-D500-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels

Samsung-Table-induction-3-foyers-7-2-KW-CTN463NC01-CTN463NC01-XEF-Manuels

Samsung-RR92HAWW-Refrigerateur-une-porte-Monochrome-Manuels

Samsung-UE40D6510WS-Manuels

Samsung-ML-2160-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels

Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME46B-Manuels

Samsung-LE37A466-LE37A466C2M-Manuels

Samsung-UE32EH4003W-Manuels

Samsung-LE32D460C9H-Manuels

Samsung-LE40B551A6W-Manuels

Samsung-Zephyr-AQV09YWAN-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels

Samsung-S22B350B-Manuels

Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Note-II-GT-N7100-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9300-Manuels

SAMSUNG/SAMSUNG-DV90-Manuels

Samsung-GT-N8000-Manuels

Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Pologne-Manuels

Samsung-ML-2165W-Roumanie-Manuels

Samsung-Notebook-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z5C-S01-NP700Z5C-S01DE-Manuels

Samsung-Player-One-noir-Open-market-GT-S5230-Manuels

Samsung-LE32E420E2W-Manuels

Samsung-910MP-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open-market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels

Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Pro-gris-Open-market-GT-B7510-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-noir-SFR-GT-S5660-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Spica-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5700-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7610-noir-Open-market-GT-B7610-Manuels

Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels

Samsung-LE32C650-LE32C650L1W-Manuels

Samsung-LE26D450G1W-Manuels

Samsung-N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels

Samsung-N150-NP-N150-Manuels

Samsung-NP20-NP20FK02BG-SEF-Manuels

Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110726_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.2_120725_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-LE32D400E1W-Manuels

Samsung-Gainable-Slim-MH026FEEA-Manuels

Samsung-CW21Z573N-Manuels

Samsung-40-UE40D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels

Samsung-UE32D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3D-UE46ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1-Manuels

Samsung-NS140SDXEA-Manuels

Samsung-MH050FXEA2B-Manuels

Samsung-UE75ES9000S-Slim-LED-75-SMART-Interaction-3D-Manuels

Samsung-RR92HAWW-Manuels

Samsung-GT-P6200-Manuels

Samsung-Refrigerateur-1porteA-350-L-Blanc-RR82FHSW-Manuels

Samsung-UE26EH4000-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4000W-Manuels

Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9DVBEU4E-ENG-Manuel

Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_111130_Screen-Manuel

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuel

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuels

Samsung-GT-S5360-Manuels

Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4-0-Blanc-8Go-YP-G1CW-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-551-noir-Open-marketGT-I5510-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Note-10-1-GT-N8000-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-LTE-SC-03D-JP-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-Note-SC-05D-JP-Manuels

Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R530-JA02FR-Manuels

Samsung-UE40C6000-UE40C6000RW-Manuels

Samsung-Congelateur-1porteA-277-L-Blanc-RZ80FHSW-Manuels

Samsung-GT-B5310-Manuels

Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-GT-B5310-Manuels

Samsung-32-LE32D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LCD-TV-Manuels

Samsung-46-UE46D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE55ES6560S-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES8000S-Manuels

Samsung-UE55ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-TV-3D-UE55ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-AQV18UGAX-Manuels

Samsung-UE50EH5300W-Manuels

Samsung-LE46A676-LE46A676A1M-Manuels

Samsung-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels

Samsung-CW21Z503N-Manuels

Samsung-AQ18UGFN-Manuels

Samsung-Refrigerateur-DP-A275-L-Blanc-RT34GBSW-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES6100W-Manuels

Samsung-RR92HASX-Manuels

Samsung-LE40S71B-Manuels

Samsung-UE32ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3DUE32ES6710S-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-GT-P1000-GT-P1000-M16-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Lite-noir-Orange-GT-B7300-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT-I9100-Manuels

Samsung-Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFRGT-I8000-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFR-GT-I8000-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-7-noir-Open-market-GT-I8700-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-noir-Bouygues-GT-I7500-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-mini-gris-Open-market-GT-S5570-Manuels

Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1FR-Manuels

17,3" Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S01FR - Manuels

40", UE40D6500WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV - UE40D6500VS - Manuels

CLX-3185FW Manuels

Galaxy Ace GT-S5830

Galaxy S II GT-I9100

Galaxy Tab 8.9 GT-P7310/M16

Galaxy Tab 10.1 GT-P7500/M16

Galaxy YGT-S5360

LE32C350 LE32C350D1W

LE40C630 LE40C630K1W

MM-C330D

MM-D330D

Micro-chaîne, MM-D330DWXZF, série 3 - MM-D330 - Manuels

N145Plus - NP-N145P - Manuels

N150 - NP-N150 - Manuels

RSH5UEPN

SGH-F490

Samsung Galaxy Ace noir - Open market - GT-S5830 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S II noir - Open market - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S III - GT-I9300 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S noir - Open market - GT-I9000 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy NoteGT-N7000

Samsung Galaxy SGT-I9000

Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S03FR - Manuels

T23A550 T23A550

UE40D6500ZF UE40D6500VS

UE55ES8000/ZF, Slim LED 55", SMART INTERACTION, 3D - UE55ES8000S - Manuels

Wave 575 GT-S5750E

Wave II GT-S8530

16/4ppm Imprimante laser couleur CLP-310 Manuels

16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3170FN Manuels

16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3185FW Manuels Samsung

16/4ppm Multifonction laser couleur CLX-3185 Manuels Samsung

samsung-Wave-II-noir-Open-market-GT-S8530-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-578-noir-Open-market-GT-S5780-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-market-GT-S5330-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-3-noir-Open-market-GT-S8600-Manuels

Samsung-Player-HD-noir-Open-market-GT-I8910-Manuels

Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels

Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-W-noir-Open-market-GT-I8350-Manuels

PRODUITS SAMSUNG :
Belkin Chargeur Secteur pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Coque pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire Translucide
Belkin Etui cuir Verve Folio pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Belkin Etui Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir
Belkin Kit de Charge Secteur + Automobile pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Anti-reflets
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Transparentes
Belkin Micro-Chargeur allume-cigares pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Protection d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Confidentialité 360°
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung
Coque semi-rigide glossy noire pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Déclencheur sans Fil Hahnel combi TF pour Canon/Pentax/Samsung
Enceintes iLuv iSM524 noir pour Samsung Galaxy Tab
Etui-Brassard Belkin DualFit pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Etui Samsung CC9S70B noir
Fnac chargeur secteur POWY pour Samsung SGH-D800
G-Mobility Pack confort pour Samsung Galaxy SII i9100
Imprimante Samsung CLX-3185FN - Ethernet
Kensington Etui pliant pour Samsung Galaxy Tab
Le Tanneur Etui cuir Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S11 I9100 - Noir
Lunettes 3D actives Samsung SSG-4100GB
Modelabs 2 protections écran pour Samsung Galaxy ACE S5830
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran One Touch pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Transparentes
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Transparentes
Muvit Adaptateur Jack 3,5 mm pour Samsung (ancienne connectique)
Muvit Coque à rabat Agenda pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Noire
Muvit Coque Doodle Coeur pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque Doodle Extraterrestres pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque Doodle Rose pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy Ace
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire
Muvit Etui Clapet pour Samsung I9100 - Noir
Muvit Etui Slim Clapet pour Samsung Galaxy Note
Muvit Housse Minigel pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung nexus S - 1 Miroir/1 Secret
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung S5830
Muvit Pack Accessoires pour Samsung S5830
Muvit Sticker Carbone pour Samsung I9100
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Ibiza
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love London
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love New-York
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Paris
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Tokyo
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - United Kingdom
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - USA
QDOS Coque Cubic pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100
QDOS Coque Steel 4 pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste
Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD
Samsung B5722 Double SIM
Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles
Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310
Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB
Samsung batterie IA-BP420E
Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST
Samsung batterie SLB-10A
Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS
Samsung BD-E5300
Samsung BD-E5500 3D
Samsung BD-E6100 3D
Samsung BD-E8300 3D
Samsung BD-ES5000
Samsung BD-ES6000 3D
Samsung C3050 Stratus
Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"
Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung
Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100
Samsung CB20A12
Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir
Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB
Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir
Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung CLP-C300A
Samsung CLP-K300A
Samsung CLP-M300A
Samsung CLP-Y300A
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet
Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Noire
Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 512 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series
Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Sennheiser RS170
Samsung DP7000A3B-A01FR 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0
Samsung DP700A3B-S02FR 23" LED Tactile
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi + Etui
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi + Etui
Samsung E1150 - Silver
Samsung ES90 Noir
Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir
Samsung Etui coque pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Noir
Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir
Samsung Etui rabat pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir
Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung EX1
Samsung Flash SEF15A
Samsung Flash SEF20A
Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Note
Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy Note - Dark Blue
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Blanc Marbre
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Bleu Galet
Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 16 Go
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi + HP Housse Mini Sleeve 10,2" pour Netbook et Tablette - Ocean Drive
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Noir Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Argent
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 7.0" LED 8 Go
Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Android)
Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir
Samsung Graveur Externe BluRay SE-506AB
Samsung HMX-F80 Noir
Samsung HMX-Q20 Noir
Samsung HMX-QF20 Noir
Samsung HMX-W350 Noir (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go
Samsung HMX-W350 Rouge (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung HT-D330
Samsung HT-D350
Samsung HT-D4500
Samsung HT-D5000 3D
Samsung HT-E4200 3D
Samsung HT-E4500 3D
Samsung HT-E5200 3D
Samsung HT-E5530 3D
Samsung HT-ES4200 3D
Samsung HT-ES6200 3D
Samsung HT-ES8200 3D
Samsung HW-E350
Samsung HW-E450
Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)
Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220
Samsung kit HDMI
Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm
Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm
Samsung LE32E420
Samsung LE40D503
Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500
Samsung ML-2010D3
Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi
Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung MLT-D1052S
Samsung MLT-D1082S
Samsung MLT-D1092S
Samsung MM-D430D
Samsung MM-E320
Samsung MV800 Noir
Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir
Samsung NP300E7A-S09FR 17,3" LED
Samsung NP700Z5C 15.6" LED
Samsung NP-RC730-S07FR 17.3"LED
Samsung NX1000 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung NX 50 - 200 mm f/4.0 - 5.6 ED OIS II i-Fonction; Dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200
Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100
Samsung Pack HMX-F800 Noir : Caméscope HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go
Samsung Pack HMX-Q200 Noir : Caméscope Full HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go
Samsung PC portable NP300E5A-S0AFR 15.6"LED
Samsung PL210 Noir
Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go
Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal
Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante
Samsung PS43E450
Samsung PS43E490 3D
Samsung PS43E490 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung PS51E450
Samsung PS51E490 3D
Samsung PS51E530
Samsung Q3 noir 4 Go
Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go
Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED
Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes
Samsung S19A100N Moniteur 18,5" - Flat Panel Display
Samsung S22B150N 21,5" LED
Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED
Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D
Samsung S23B350H 23" LED
Samsung S23B550V Moniteur 23" LED
Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED
Samsung S27B350H 27" LED
Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi
Samsung SCX-4200A
Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0
Samsung SE-218BB graveur DVD externe ultra slim USB 2.0
Samsung SLB07A pour ST50
Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000
Samsung ST200F Noir - WiFi
Samsung ST200F Rouge - WiFi
Samsung ST200F Violet - WiFi
Samsung ST65 Noir
Samsung ST65 Rouge
Samsung ST66 Noir
Samsung ST77 Blanc
Samsung ST77 Noir
Samsung ST77 Rouge
Samsung ST77 Violet
Samsung ST88 Noir
Samsung station d'accueil
Samsung station d'accueil HD2
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR
Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED
Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED
Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D
Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX
Samsung T22A300 21.5" Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T22B300EW 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T24B301 24" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T27A550 27" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir
Samsung UE19ES4000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5410 LED
Samsung UE26EH4000 LED
Samsung UE26EH4500 LED
Samsung UE32EH4000 LED
Samsung UE32EH5000 LED
Samsung UE32ES5500 LED
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE37ES5500 LED
Samsung UE40D5000 LED
Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D
Samsung UE40EH5000 LED
Samsung UE40ES5500 LED
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D
Samsung UE46EH5000 LED
Samsung UE46ES5500 LED
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE46ES8000 LED 3D
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE60ES6100 LED 3D
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" - Aluminium + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium+ Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Marron
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Rose
Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10
Samsung Wave 575
Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi
Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi
Samsung WB690 Noir
Samsung WB700 Noir
Samsung WB850F Noir - WiFi - GPS
Samsung WMN250M accroche murale
Samsung XE700T1A-A02FR 11,6" 64 Go SSD
Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go
Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose
Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go
Samyang 14 mm f/2.8 Aspherical IF ED UMC; Monture Samsung NX
Samyang 35 mm f/1.4 AS UMC; Monture Samsung NX
Samyang Fish-eye 8 mm f/3.5 Aspherical IF MC; Monture Samsung Type NX
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go + Casque weSC Conga Matte noir
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 8 Go
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 5" 8 Go
T'nB Coque Clip On pour Samsung Galaxy SII - New York
Toner Samsung CLT-C4072S - Cyan
Toner Samsung CLT-C4092S Cyan
Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S - Noir
Toner Samsung CLT-K4092S Noir
Toner Samsung CLT-M4072S - Magenta
Toner Samsung CLT-M4092S Magenta
Toner Samsung CLT-P4092C - Pack de 4 Toners
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4072S - Jaune
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4092S Jaune
Toner Samsung MLT-D1042S - Noir
We Digital by Samsung - Silver We 1 To USB 2.0
We Digital by Samsung - Silver WE 2 To USB 2.0
Xqisit Coque iPlate Glossy pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Blanche
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Noire
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanc
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir

Samsung - Aspirateur robot Navibot SR8845

Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86G0 gris foncé/fuchsia

Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac SC4780 noir

Samsung - Four micro-ondes MW73B - blanc

SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 36 L - Micro ondes 36 L - CP1395ES

SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 42 L - Micro ondes 42 L - CQ1570U

Samsung - Micro-ondes combiné CE117PT-B

SAMSUNG - Micro-ondes Grill simultané GS89F-1SP

Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED

Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste

Samsung Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86H0 gris clair/bleu

Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD

Samsung B5722 Double SIM

Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles

Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310

Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB

Samsung batterie IA-BP420E

Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST

Samsung batterie SLB-10A

Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS

Samsung BD-E5300

Samsung BD-E5500 3D

Samsung BD-E8300 3D

Samsung C3050 Stratus

Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"

Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung

Samsung Caméra additionnelle de vidéosurveillance SEB-1015RWP EX

Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100

Samsung CB20A12

Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir

Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB

Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir

Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB

Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLP-325 WiFi

Samsung CLP-325 WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0

Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet

Samsung CLP-C300A

Samsung CLP-K300A

Samsung CLP-M300A

Samsung CLP-Y300A

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi

Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0

Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet

Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet

Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung Coque silicone Croisillons pour nexus S

Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128D 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series

Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX

Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0

Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel

Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose

Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi

Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi

Samsung E1150 - Silver

Samsung E2550

Samsung EcoBlue SC61E0 bleu azur

Samsung ES30 Noir

Samsung ES30 Noir + Carte SD 2 Go

Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir

Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir

Samsung Etui flap en cuir pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - Noir

Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S

Samsung Flash SEF15A

Samsung Flash SEF20A

Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)

Samsung Galaxy Note

Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc

Samsung Galaxy Note - Rose

Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc

Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir 16 Go 3G

Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi

Samsung Galaxy Xcover s5690 (sous Androïd) - Smartphone Samsung Solide certifié IP67

Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir

Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"

Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"

Samsung HT-D330

Samsung HT-D350

Samsung HT-D423

Samsung HT-D4500

Samsung HT-D5000 3D

Samsung HT-E4200 3D

Samsung HT-E4500 3D

Samsung HT-E5200 3D

Samsung HT-ES6200 3D WiFi

Samsung HW-E450

Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)

Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"

Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX

Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220

Samsung Kit Etui + Clavier Bluetooth pour Galaxy Tab 10,1" - Brun foncé

Samsung kit HDMI

Samsung kit HDMI

Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm

Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm

Samsung LE40D550

Samsung Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Galaxy S2 - Transparente/Miroir

Samsung Lot de 2 Protections d'écran pour i9000 Galaxy S

Samsung Lunettes 3D SSG-3050GB

SAMSUNG ME106V-SX

Samsung ME82V Micro-onde monofonction

SAMSUNG ME82V-SX

SAMSUNG Micro ondes MW87Y

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE117APT B

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE137NEMX

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes FW113T002

Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500

Samsung ML-2010D3

Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi

Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet

Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung MLT-D1052S

Samsung MLT-D1082S

Samsung MLT-D1092S

Samsung MM-D430D

Samsung MV800 Noir

Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir

Samsung NP300E7A-S03FR 17,3" LED

Samsung NP700Z5A-S02FR 15,6" LED

Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS + Flash SEF-8A NG8

Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8

Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200

Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100

Samsung Pack étui cuir + chargeur + protection d'écran pour Galaxy S

Samsung PL170 Noir

Samsung PL210 Noir

Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go

Samsung PL90 Noir et Rouge

Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal

Samsung Player Mini C3300 - Noir

Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante

Samsung PS43D450

Samsung PS43E450

Samsung PS43E490 3D

Samsung PS51E450

Samsung PS51E490 3D

Samsung PS59D530

Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go

Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED

Samsung RC730-S06FR 17,3" LED

Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes

Samsung S22A300B 21,5" TFT

Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED

Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D

Samsung S23B350H 23" LED

Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED

Samsung S27B350H 27" LED

Samsung SC4340 noir ébène

Samsung SC4790 - Aspirateur sans sac - traineau - rouge

Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions

Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions

Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet

Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi

Samsung SCX-4200A

Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung SE-084D graveur DVD externe slim USB 2.0

Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0

Samsung SLB07A pour ST50

Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000

Samsung ST65 Noir

Samsung ST65 Rouge

Samsung station d'accueil

Samsung station d'accueil HD2

Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 10,1"

Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"

Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR

Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED

Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED

Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D

Samsung SyncMaster S24A350H 24" LED

Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD

Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX

Samsung T22A350 21,5" LED Tuner TNT

Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir

Samsung UE19D4010 LED

Samsung UE19ES4000 LED

Samsung UE22ES5000 LED

Samsung UE22ES5410 LED

Samsung UE26EH4000 LED

Samsung UE26EH4500 LED

Samsung UE32D5000 LED

Samsung UE32EH4000 LED

Samsung UE32EH5000 LED

Samsung UE32ES5500 LED

Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc

Samsung UE40D5000 LED

Samsung UE40D5710 LED

Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D

Samsung UE40EH5000 LED

Samsung UE40ES5500 LED

Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D

Samsung UE46EH5000 LED

Samsung UE46ES5500 LED

Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc

Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir

Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10

Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi

Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi

Samsung WB700 Noir

Samsung WB750 Noir

Samsung WIS09ABGN LinkStick WLAN-Adapter

Samsung WMN250M accroche murale

Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go

Samsung YP-F3 noir 2 Go

Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go

Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go

Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose

Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go

Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go

Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go

Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go

http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-R610-AS01FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-RV510-S01FR-downloads [+] http://www.samsung.com [+] http://www.samsung.com/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/careers/whysamsung/Careers_WhySAMSUNG.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/corporateprofile/affiliatedcompanies.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/accessibility/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?pid=fr_header_applisetservices_20120821 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/business-monitor [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/large-format-display [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/printers-multifunction [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/education/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/healthcare [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/bli-report/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/brochure/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/case-study/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/data-sheet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/solution-brief/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/white-paper/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/large-format-display-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/printing-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorders/camcorder-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/compact-cameras/compact-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/nx-system/nx-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/hd-camcorders/HMX-QF20BP/EDC?pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right2_qf20_20120907 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/galaxy-camera/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/multi-doors/RFG23UERS1/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right2_rfg23uers1_20121023 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/cook-top/CTN431SC0S/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_left1_cookidol_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/color-multifunction-devices [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/memory-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ativ-smart-pc/XE500T1C-A01FR?pid=fr_home_it_right2_ativsmartpc_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/pc-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/laser-printers/?pid=fr_home_it_middle1_laser-printers_20120823 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/supplies-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/note/GT-N8000EAEXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left2_galaxynote10.1_20120920 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mp3-media-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P1000CWALUX [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P5110TSAXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left1_galaxytab2_20121029 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/bd-dvd-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hi-fi/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hifi [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/mp3 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/sound-bar [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/?pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right2_accessoires3d_20110901 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/function/ipredirection/ipredirectionLocalList.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/contactus.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/legal.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html?anchor=cookie-policy [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/sitemap.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/samsung-apps/index.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttvapps [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/download/supportDownloadMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/location/supportServiceLocation.do?page=SERVICE.LOCATION [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10001 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10002 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10003 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10004 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10005 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10006 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/newsalert/supportNewsAlertMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/troubleshootingguides/supportTroubleShootingGuidesMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/warranty/warrantyInformation.do?page=POLICY.WARRANTY [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/enterprise-communications/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/healthcare/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/led/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/semiconductor/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/set-top-box/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/system-air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/telecommunication-systems/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_primary-article_galaxysiii_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/galaxy-siii-smartphone-you-have-never-been-so-closed-to-your-friends/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_capture-photo_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/capture-an-unforgettable-group-photo/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_multifunction-printers_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/low-maintenance-color-multifunction-printers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_twin-ovens-and-steam_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/twin-ovens-and-steam-extra-hands-in-the-kitchen/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_left1_nxmicrosite_20121108&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nx/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle2_smartcameramicrosite_20120926&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smartcamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right1_mv900fmicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/mv900f/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle1_ecobubblemicrosite_20121219&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/ecobubble/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle2_nouvellesinvits2012_20120703&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nouvellesinvitations/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_left1_inkjet_20120907&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/inkjet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_right1_serie9moniteurmicrosite_20120813&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/serie9moniteur/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_middle1_galaxynote2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right1_samsungkies_20130104&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?page=kies [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right2_mobileshop2_20120622&URL=http://www.mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_left_mobileshop_20120622&URL=http://mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_right_mysamsung_20110901&URL=http://www.mysamsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle1_galaxys2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle2_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle1_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle2_smarttvmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=pid=fr_home_it_left2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/us/aboutsamsung/ir/newsMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com [+] http://www.samsung.com/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/careers/whysamsung/Careers_WhySAMSUNG.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/corporateprofile/affiliatedcompanies.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/accessibility/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?pid=fr_header_applisetservices_20120821 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/business-monitor [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/large-format-display [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/printers-multifunction [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/education/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/healthcare [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/bli-report/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/brochure/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/case-study/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/data-sheet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/solution-brief/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/white-paper/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/large-format-display-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/printing-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorders/camcorder-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/compact-cameras/compact-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/nx-system/nx-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/hd-camcorders/HMX-QF20BP/EDC?pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right2_qf20_20120907 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/galaxy-camera/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/multi-doors/RFG23UERS1/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right2_rfg23uers1_20121023 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/cook-top/CTN431SC0S/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_left1_cookidol_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/color-multifunction-devices [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/memory-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ativ-smart-pc/XE500T1C-A01FR?pid=fr_home_it_right2_ativsmartpc_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/pc-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/laser-printers/?pid=fr_home_it_middle1_laser-printers_20120823 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/supplies-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/note/GT-N8000EAEXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left2_galaxynote10.1_20120920 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mp3-media-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P1000CWALUX [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P5110TSAXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left1_galaxytab2_20121029 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/bd-dvd-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hi-fi/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hifi [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/mp3 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/sound-bar [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/?pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right2_accessoires3d_20110901 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/function/ipredirection/ipredirectionLocalList.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/contactus.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/legal.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html?anchor=cookie-policy [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/sitemap.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/samsung-apps/index.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttvapps [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/download/supportDownloadMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/location/supportServiceLocation.do?page=SERVICE.LOCATION [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10001 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10002 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10003 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10004 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10005 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10006 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/newsalert/supportNewsAlertMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/troubleshootingguides/supportTroubleShootingGuidesMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/warranty/warrantyInformation.do?page=POLICY.WARRANTY [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/enterprise-communications/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/healthcare/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/led/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/semiconductor/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/set-top-box/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/system-air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/telecommunication-systems/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_primary-article_galaxysiii_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/galaxy-siii-smartphone-you-have-never-been-so-closed-to-your-friends/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_capture-photo_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/capture-an-unforgettable-group-photo/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_multifunction-printers_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/low-maintenance-color-multifunction-printers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_twin-ovens-and-steam_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/twin-ovens-and-steam-extra-hands-in-the-kitchen/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_left1_nxmicrosite_20121108&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nx/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle2_smartcameramicrosite_20120926&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smartcamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right1_mv900fmicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/mv900f/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle1_ecobubblemicrosite_20121219&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/ecobubble/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle2_nouvellesinvits2012_20120703&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nouvellesinvitations/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_left1_inkjet_20120907&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/inkjet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_right1_serie9moniteurmicrosite_20120813&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/serie9moniteur/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_middle1_galaxynote2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right1_samsungkies_20130104&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?page=kies [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right2_mobileshop2_20120622&URL=http://www.mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_left_mobileshop_20120622&URL=http://mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_right_mysamsung_20110901&URL=http://www.mysamsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle1_galaxys2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle2_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle1_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle2_smarttvmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=pid=fr_home_it_left2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/us/aboutsamsung/ir/newsMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/careers/whysamsung/Careers_WhySAMSUNG.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/corporateprofile/affiliatedcompanies.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/aboutsamsung/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/accessibility/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?pid=fr_header_applisetservices_20120821 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/business-monitor [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/large-format-display [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/business-products/printers-multifunction [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/education/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/industry/healthcare [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/bli-report/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/brochure/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/case-study/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/data-sheet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/solution-brief/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/resource/white-paper/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/large-format-display-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/business/solutions-services/printing-solutions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorder/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/camcorders/camcorder-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/compact-cameras/compact-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/nx-system/nx-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-camcorders/hd-camcorders/HMX-QF20BP/EDC?pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right2_qf20_20120907 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/camera-camcorder/smart-cameras/galaxy-camera/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cold/multi-doors/RFG23UERS1/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right2_rfg23uers1_20121023 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/cuisson/cook-top/CTN431SC0S/XEF?pid=fr_home_home-appliances_left1_cookidol_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/vacuum-cleaners/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/home-appliances/washers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/all-in-one/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/color-multifunction-devices [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/memory-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/monitors/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/ativ-smart-pc/XE500T1C-A01FR?pid=fr_home_it_right2_ativsmartpc_20121219 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/notebook/pc-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/optical-disk/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/laser-printers/?pid=fr_home_it_middle1_laser-printers_20120823 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/supplies-accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/ssd-card/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/galaxy-note/note/GT-N8000EAEXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left2_galaxynote10.1_20120920 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mobiles/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/mp3-media-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/smartphones/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P1000CWALUX [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/mobile-phones/tablets/tablets/GT-P5110TSAXEF?pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_left1_galaxytab2_20121029 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/bd-dvd-players/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/hi-fi-wireless-with-dock/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-blu-ray [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater-dvd [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/home-theater/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hi-fi/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/micro-hifi [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/mp3 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/sound-bar [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/tv-audio-video/tv/accessories/?pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right2_accessoires3d_20110901 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/function/ipredirection/ipredirectionLocalList.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/index.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/contactus.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/legal.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/privacy.html?anchor=cookie-policy [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/info/sitemap.html [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/news/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/samsung-apps/index.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttvapps [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/download/supportDownloadMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/location/supportServiceLocation.do?page=SERVICE.LOCATION [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10001 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10002 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10003 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10004 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10005 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/main/supportMain.do?supportIaCode=10006 [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/newsalert/supportNewsAlertMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/troubleshootingguides/supportTroubleShootingGuidesMain.do [+] http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/warranty/warrantyInformation.do?page=POLICY.WARRANTY [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/enterprise-communications/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/healthcare/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/led/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/semiconductor/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/set-top-box/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/system-air-conditioner/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/global/business/telecommunication-systems/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_primary-article_galaxysiii_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/galaxy-siii-smartphone-you-have-never-been-so-closed-to-your-friends/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_capture-photo_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/capture-an-unforgettable-group-photo/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_multifunction-printers_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/low-maintenance-color-multifunction-printers/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_articles-tab_secondary-article_twin-ovens-and-steam_20121113&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/article/twin-ovens-and-steam-extra-hands-in-the-kitchen/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_left1_nxmicrosite_20121108&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nx/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_middle2_smartcameramicrosite_20120926&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smartcamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_camera-camcorder_right1_mv900fmicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/mv900f/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle1_ecobubblemicrosite_20121219&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/ecobubble/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_middle2_nouvellesinvits2012_20120703&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/nouvellesinvitations/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_home-appliances_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_left1_inkjet_20120907&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/consumer/it/print/inkjet/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_it_right1_serie9moniteurmicrosite_20120813&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/serie9moniteur/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_middle1_galaxynote2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right1_samsungkies_20130104&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/applisetservices/?page=kies [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_mobile-phones_right2_mobileshop2_20120622&URL=http://www.mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_left_mobileshop_20120622&URL=http://mobileshop.samsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_subbanner_right_mysamsung_20110901&URL=http://www.mysamsung.fr/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle1_galaxys2microsite_20121029&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxynote2/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_middle2_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right1_galaxycameramicrosite_20121130&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/galaxycamera [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_thelatest_right2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_left1_angrybirdsmicrosite2_20121206&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/angrybirds [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle1_hifi-sans-filmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/hifi-sans-fil/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_middle2_smarttvmicrosite_20121031&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/smarttv/ [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=fr_home_tv-audio-video_right1_promos_20120622&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/promotions [+] http://www.samsung.com/public/redirect.html?sitecode=fr&pid=pid=fr_home_it_left2_emotionslab_20121214&URL=http://www.samsung.com/fr/emotionslab [+] http://www.samsung.com/us/aboutsamsung/ir/newsMain.do http://www.samsung.com/us/support/owners/product/RF266AEBP http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP400B5B-S02FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/BD-C8500/XEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201004/20100405125800515/01960B-BD-C8200_8500-XEF-FRA-0323.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/MM-D470D/ZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120103150428464/AH68-02345F-MM-D470D-FRA-20120103.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP200B5B-A01FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300V3A-A01FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-N7000ZBESFR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120809172648710/GT-N7000_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120716_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120611165201603/GT-P3110_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120608_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-N7000RWASFR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201203/20120329200748757/GT-N7000_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.1_120126_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216180827802/GT-N7000_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.1_111104_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120809173956440/GT-P7510_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120809_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111205085630494/GT-P7510_UM_Orange_Honeycomb_Fre_Rev.1.0_111202_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120713085451049/GT-P7510_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-P7510FKAXEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120802111559199/GT-I9070P_UM_Orange_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120629_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120517111406195/GT-I9070P_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.0_120510_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120802111559199/GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120424154452484/GT-P3100_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120424_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201209/20120917105131603/GT-P3100_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120801_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-P5110TSAXEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201208/20120810190309322/GT-P5110_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.0_120808_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120614144504602/GT-P5110_UM_EU_Icecream_Eng_Rev.1.0_120614_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I5800DKABOG-downloads http://www.samsung.com/uk/support/model/NP-R519-FA06UK-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201008/20100809184447671/GT-I5800_UM_Open_Fre_Rev.1.0_100722_cms.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201009/20100907222536765/GT-I5800_QSG_Open_Eng_Rev.1.1_100907a_cms.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110525183942011/GT-I5800_QSG_EU_Froyo_Eng_UK_Rev.1.1_110525_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110525175249448/GT-I5800_QSG_EU_Froyo_Eng_Rev.1.1_110525_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201105/20110530173657729/GT-I5800_UM_Open_Froyo_Fre_Rev.1.1_110527_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I9001HKDFTM-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111212155049797/GT-I9001_UM_EU_Gingerbread_Eng_Rev.1.3_111212_Screen.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LF22TOWHBDN/EN-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201211/20121102145205481/BN68-03899A-04.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121108171138109/BN46-00315A-Fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121108171138109/BN46-00315A-Eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP550P5C-T04FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121113125618982/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121113125618982/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE32D5720RSXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110517143435031/[UD5700-XN]BN68-03506F-03L04-0427.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216084511364/Web_W_X6DVBEUA_Fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216084511364/Web_W_X6DVBEUA_Eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-I9000RWYSFR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE55D8000YSXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128101809663/02_FRA_GPDVBEUA-0106.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128101809663/01_ENG_GPDVBEUA-0106.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120314192959318/[UD8000-XN]BN68-03442T-00L04-0804.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120405165711377/2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE46ES6710SXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120405165711377/2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121110095845360/02-XTDVBEUE-FRA-1109.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121110095845360/01-XTDVBEUE-ENG-1109.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120712095934377/2012_Skype_FRA-0424.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120712095934377/2012_Skype_ENG-0424.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-RV515-S04FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/CD/201104/20110408115840622/DoC160-RV515-RV415-Scala2-15-14-AMD.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026202221731/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026202221731/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP900X4D-A01FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP350E7C-S0BFR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121022141232121/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121022141232121/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120518170921365/EN/english.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/DR/201205/20120521130845677/FR/french.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/ML-2160/SEE-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120322160533913/BN68-03304C-00.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120622172918410/BN46-00030A-Fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201206/20120622172918410/BN46-00030A-Eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE55C7700WSXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502130400267/02230C-01-BD-E8900-ZF-0413.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502130543045/Smart_Hub-FRA-0309.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201205/20120502133933796/AllShare-FRA-0221.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201004/20100426150918218/7Series_Power_consumption_LED_TV.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201005/20100529095515140/BN68-02590B-03L04-0518.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP700G7A-S01FR http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP305E5A-A01FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026193501356/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090428183905421/YPP3J-COMMON-ENGLISH3.0.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200904/20090407081834937/YPP3J-02154C-XEF-QG1.0-NOCD.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090428183905421/YPP3J-EUROPE-FRENCH3.0.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201005/20100504091945781/GT-E1151_UM_Open_Fre_Rev.1.0_100311.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100324124741578/BN68-02592F-01L04_0316.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200805/20080520175711468_BN68-01409H-01L02-0429.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200805/20080530182204609_Pearl-France-01409H-Eng-0530.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LT24A350EW/EN-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300E5A-S08FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE22C350D1WXZF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40R86BDX/XEC-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200703/20070322190622750_BN68-01169B-01L08-0313.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE40ES5700SXZF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LT22A300EW/EN-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-U600HBAXEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200803/20080318192114953_SGH-U600_Eng.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200903/20090312154510796/SGH-U600_French_090311_Rev1.3.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200904/20090410095951906/SGH-U600_UG_090311_Rev1.3.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP305V5A-S02FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201204/20120420172612547/WB850F-CE_DoC_in_French.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/AQ18FAN-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200703/20070308174715062_FORTE_DB98-27531A_IB_F.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40B620R3WXXC-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200909/20090925093818484/BN68-02098D-01Eng-0909.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-Z360ZSAFTM-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200801/20080108134949406_SGH-Z360_UG_ORA_Fre_Rev.1.1_061123.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/EK-GC100ZWAXEF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP900X4D-A02FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026104030074/Win8_Manual_eng.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP700Z7C-S02FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121028112443918/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-RC710-S02FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-E590NSAXEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200706/20070627104827281_SGH-E590_UG_Eng_Rev.1.1_070622.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/RS6178UGDSR/EF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201203/20120316175747467/DA99-01779L.pdf https://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP300E7A-S0CFR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/RT50QMSW1/XEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121119193716527/DA99-01906C_v0.6.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE46EH6030WXZF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/sg/support/model/GT-I9300RWDXSP-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121117090011154/GT-I9300_UM_EU_Jellybean_Eng_Rev.1.1_121113_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121122102418917/GT-I9300_UM_SEA_Jellybean_Chi_Rev.1.1_121116_Screen.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201102/20110228142459539/DJ68-00558R_0.0.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/GT-S5260RWPFTM http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE32C630K1WXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201003/20100322135354718/BN68-02802A-00Eng_0310.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-R530-JT50FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NP-R590-JS01FR-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/SGH-F480ESAXEF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026124954559/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200805/20080509152035250_SGH-F480_UG_Fre_Rev.1.0_080509.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200911/20091118083418500/SGH-F480i_UM_Open_Fre_Rev.1.0_090527.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121026124954559/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201004/20100415162800953/UPD_Guide_EN.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100329103902500/BN68-02655A-00L06-0304.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100324125247750/BN68-02655D-00L04-0304.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE55D6300SSXZF http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111208190112921/Web_GSDVBEUA_FRE.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201106/20110630112704040/FR/french.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111208190112921/Web_GSDVBEUA_FRE.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/YH-820MW/ELS http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200508/20050829114410765_YH820-ELS-FRE0[1].0.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201106/20110630112704040/FR/french.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120718221859806/WB100_WB101_French.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111216102348708/SX5DVBEU1A-ENG.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201210/20121009090604327/Win8_Manual_chs.pdf http://www.samsung.com/sg/support/model/XE500T1C-H01SG-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/DP700A3D-A01FR-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201211/20121129094347177/Win8_Manual_fre.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201112/20111208190558077/Web_GSDVBEUA-RUS.pdf http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/UE55ES8007UXRU-downloads http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/UE32D5000PWXMS http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128102909679/26_RUS_GPDVBEUA-0106.pdf http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/UE46D7000LSXBY http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200911/20091102085239468/BN68-01978J-02Rus_1027.pdf http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/UE46EH5300WXRU-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/200805/20080520230647453_Carnelian_P410_W.Europ-0516.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201207/20120712095934377/2012_Skype_RUS-0424.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100325101925437/BN68-02692E-00L04-0304.pdf http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/PS42C431A2WXRU-downloads http://www.samsung.com/ru/support/model/UE46D5000PWXMS-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201201/20120128135824882/UX9DVBEU1A_RUS.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201101/20110105125332353/Maldives_EUR_AQV09P_IBIM_32436A_F_12.28.10.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40C630K1WXZF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/PS63B680T6WXXC-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200910/20091027091933953/BN68-02333J-02L09_1022_CMS.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201008/20100806092414234/BN68-02807N-02L04-0625.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201105/20110519141142308/[UD6200_6300-XN]BN68-03476E-00L04-0314.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE40D6300SSXZF-downloads http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/UE32ES6300SXZF-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/EM/201211/20121122130011792/[UE6300-XN_ZF]BN68-04108R-01L04-0808.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/NS071SDXEA http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201104/20110412155113342/DB98-31483A-E.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/RT45JSTS1/XES-downloads http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201212/20121206105751393/Refrigerator_FR_DA68-01934E_Rev_0.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/201003/20100324121205406/BN68-02748G-00L04-0224.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200803/20080322125814015_BN68-01424C-00L09-0303.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200805/20080520175711468_BN68-01409H-01L02-0429.pdf http://downloadcenter.samsung.com/content/UM/200809/20080909142117484_BN68-01736J-00L02-0805.pdf http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/model/LE40A796R2MXZF http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/detail/supportPrdDetail.do?menu=SIA00200&prd_ia_cd=&prd_mdl_cd=NP-NC110-A05FR&prd_mdl_name=NP-NC110&srchword=NC110 http://www.samsung.com/fr/support/detail/supportPrdDetail.do?menu=SIA00200&prd_ia_cd=&prd_mdl_cd=NP-NC110-A05FR&prd_mdl_name=NP-NC110&srchword=NC110#

This user manual includes detailed usage instructions for your camera. Please read this manual thoroughly. User Manual NX5 Ä Click a topic Quick reference Contents Basic functions Basic shooting Extended shooting functions Playback/Editing Camera settings menu Appendixes2 Health and safety information Always comply with the following precautions and usage tips to avoid dangerous situations and ensure peak performance of your camera. Warning—situations that could cause injury to yourself or others Caution—situations that could cause damage to your camera or other equipment Note—notes, usage tips, or additional information Do not use your camera near flammable or explosive gases and liquids Do not use your camera near fuels, combustibles, or flammable chemicals. Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or explosive materials in the same compartment as the camera or its accessories. Keep your camera away from small children and pets Keep your camera and all accessories out of the reach of small children and animals. Small parts may cause choking or serious injury if swallowed. Moving parts and accessories may present physical dangers as well. Prevent damage to subjects’ eyesight Do not use the flash in close proximity (closer than 1 m/3 ft) to people or animals. Using the flash too close to your subject’s eyes can cause temporary or permanent damage. Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care Use only Samsung-approved batteries and chargers. Incompatible batteries and chargers can cause serious injuries or damage to your camera. Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations when disposing of used batteries. Never place batteries or cameras on or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. Batteries may explode when overheated. Handle and store your camera carefully and sensibly Do not allow your camera to get wet—liquids can cause serious damage. Do not handle your camera with wet hands. Water damage to your camera can void your manufacturer’s warranty. • • • • Safety warnings Safety precautions 3 Do not expose the camera to direct sunlight or high temperatures for an extended period of time. Prolonged exposure to sunlight or extreme temperatures can cause permanent damage to your camera’s internal components. Avoid using or storing your camera in dusty, dirty, humid, or poorly-ventilated areas to prevent damage to moving parts and internal components. Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period of time. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Protect your camera from sand and dirt when using it on beaches or in other similar areas. Protect your camera from impact, shock, bending, or press of heavy goods when you connect either cable or power code. It may damage your camera or cable or cause by electric shock or fire. Exercise caution when connecting cables or adaptors and installing batteries and memory cards. Forcing the connectors, improperly connecting cables, or improperly installing batteries and memory cards can damage ports, connectors, and accessories. Do not insert foreign objects into any of your camera’s compartments, slots, or access points. Damage due to improper use may not be covered by your warranty. Do not use broken power cord, plug, or wall-outlet. It may cause by electric shock or fire. Protect batteries, chargers, and memory cards from damage Avoid exposing batteries or memory cards to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0º C/32º F or above 40º C/104º F). Extreme temperatures can reduce the charging capacity of your batteries and can cause memory cards to malfunction. Prevent batteries from making contact with metal objects, as this can create a connection between the + and – terminals of your battery and lead to • • • • • • • • • • temporary or permanent battery damage. Prevent memory cards from making contact with liquids, dirt, or foreign substances. If dirty, wipe the memory card clean with a soft cloth before inserting in your camera. Turn off the camera when inserting or removing the memory card. Do not bend, drop, or subject memory cards to heavy impact or pressure. Do not use memory cards that have been formatted by other cameras or by a computer. Reformat the memory card with your camera. Never use a damaged charger, battery, or memory card. Use only Samsung-approved accessories Using incompatible accessories may damage your camera, cause injury, or void your warranty. Protect your camera’s lens Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight, as this may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. Protect your lens from fingerprints and scratches. Clean your lens with a soft, clean, debris-free lens cloth. Allow only qualified personnel to service your camera Do not allow unqualified personnel to service the camera or attempt to service the camera yourself. Any damage that results from unqualified service is not covered by your warranty. Ensure maximum battery and charger life Overcharging batteries may shorten battery life. After • • • • • • • • Important usage information 4 Basic functions 12 Learn about your camera’s layout, icons, and basic functions for shooting. Basic shooting 38 Learn how to take a photo by selecting a mode and how to record a video. Extended shooting functions 50 Learn about the options you can set in shooting mode. By using the shooting options, you can enjoy more customized pictures and movies. Playback/Editing 78 Learn how to play back photos, videos, and edit photos or videos. Also, learn how to connect your camera to your computer, photo printer, TV, or HDTV. Camera settings menu 103 The camera use environment can be set to a desired state by using the setup menu. Appendixes 109 Refer to settings, error messages, specifications, and maintenance tips. charging is finished, disconnect the cable from your camera. Over time, unused batteries will discharge and must be recharged before use. Disconnect chargers from power sources when not in use. Use batteries only for their intended purpose. Exercise caution when using the camera in humid environments When transferring the camera from a cold environment to a warm and humid one, condensation can form on the delicate electronic circuitry and memory card. In this situation, wait for at least 1 hour until all moisture has evaporated before using the camera. Check that the camera is operating properly before use The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from camera malfunction or improper use. Copyright information Microsoft Windows and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation. HDMI, the HDMI logo and the term "High Definition Multimedia Interface" are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licencing LLC. • • • • • Organization of the user manual Camera specifications or contents of this manual may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of camera functions. For Open Source License information, refer to the “OpenSourceInfo.pdf” in the provided CD-ROM. • •5 Indications used in this manual Shooting mode Marking Smart Auto Program Aperture Priority Shutter Speed Priority Manual Night Portrait Landscape Scene Movie Shooting mode explanation shown next to the title This shows that the functions explained can only be selected from within the shooting mode. In the case of the mode, this corresponds to only part of the scene. Ex) Adjusting exposure (brightness) The diagram below illustrates the shooting mode dial on the camera body. To select a shooting mode, you rotate the dial until the mode you want lines up with the hash mark on the camera. The diagram below shows the status has been changed to ( ). Directional Keys in the User's Manual When explaining the steps needed for navigating the menu, the up, down, left and right directional arrows are shown below. Ex) Executing the 'Play' mode The user can check saved pictures and movies. 1 Press [ ] • Show most recently saved files. 2 Check the following pictures sequentially by using [X]. Adjusting the exposure (brightness) The images can be taken bright or dark according to the amount of light. In this case, appropriate adjustment can be made by controlling the amount of light entered into the lens. S Applying - S 0 S Applying + (Program), (Aperture priority), (Shutter priority), (Night), (Portrait), (Landscape), (Scene), or (Movie) mode. Currently selected shooting mode AF MF WB ISO [S] [T] [W] [X]6 Menu display used in this manual Menu display of the photo shooting mode Menu display of the movie shooting mode Ex) Setting the image quality of movie file 1 Set the mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality. 4 Select a desired image quality. Icons used in this manual Symbol Explanation Additional information about the function Safety warnings and precautions [ ] Indicates a camera button, for example: [Shutter] represents the shutter button. ( ) Shows the reference page → Display when selecting a menu or option within the step Example: Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Quality. (represents select Shooting 1 ( 1), and then Quality) * Comment explaining symbols Abbreviations used in this manual Abbreviations Explanation AF (Auto Focus) Auto focus BKT (Bracketing) Bracketing DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) Printing order mark EV (Exposure Value) Exposure value OIS (Optical Image Stabilization) Optical image stabilization ISO (International Standard for color negative film) Film sensitivity WB (White Balance) White balance 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Shooting 1( 1) Shooting 2( 2) Shooting 3( 3) User setup ( 1) Setting 1( 1) Setting 2( 2) Setting 3( 3) 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Shooting 1( 1) Shooting 2( 2) Shooting 3( 3)7 Pressing the shutter Half-press [Shutter]: press the shutter halfway down Press [Shutter]: press the shutter all the way down Half-press [Shutter] Press [Shutter] Subject, background, and composition Subject: the main object of a scene, such as a person, animal, or still life Background: the objects around the subject Composition: the combination of a subject and background Subjectuect Background Composition • • • • • Exposure (Brightness) The amount of light that enters your camera determines the exposure. You can alter the exposure with shutter speed, aperture value, and ISO speed. By altering the exposure, your photos will be darker or lighter. Normal exposure Overexposure (too bright) Expressions used in this manual8 Viewing files by category in Smart Album f 81 Deleting all files on the memory card f 83 Viewing files as a slide show f 84 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV f 92 Connecting your camera to a computer f 93 Adjusting sound and volume f 105 Adjusting the brightness of the display f 105 Changing the display language f 105 Setting the date and time f 107 Formatting the memory card f 106 Troubleshooting f 115 • • • • • • • • • • • Taking photos of people mode → Beauty Shot f47 Red-eye reduction f56 Face Detection AF f64 • • • Taking photos at night or in the dark mode f45 Flash setting options f55 ISO speed setting f59 • • • Taking action photos mode f42 Continuous, Burst shooting f73 • • Taking photos of text, insects, or flowers mode → Close-up shot f39 Using the White Balance f68 • • Adjusting the exposure (brightness) ISO speed setting f59 Adjusting exposure f66 Metering f67 BRK(Bracketing) f74 • • • • Applying a different effect Picture Wizard f75 Photo Style f88 • • Reducing camera shake • Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) f35 Quick reference9 Contents Basic functions ....................................................12 Unpacking ................................................................. 13 Title and role of each part .......................................... 14 Diopter adjustment dial/eye-cup/Status lamp ........... 16 Description for each part of the lens ......................... 17 Preparations before shooting .................................... 18 Charging the battery ................................................. 18 Installing the battery .................................................. 19 Installing the memory card ....................................... 20 Mounting/dismounting the lens ................................ 21 Connecting the strap ................................................ 22 Turning on the power and initialization ...................... 23 Icons ........................................................................ 25 Option/menu selection method ................................. 26 Using the dial ............................................................ 26 Using [Fn] ................................................................. 27 Setting the display and sound ................................... 28 Changing the display type ........................................ 28 Setting user display .................................................. 29 Setting the sound ..................................................... 29 Setting the screen display ........................................ 30 Simple picture-taking method ................................... 31 Tips for getting a clearer photo.................................. 32 Holding your camera correctly .................................. 32 Image stabilization .................................................... 32 Half-pressing the shutter button ............................... 32 Getting your subject in focus .................................... 33 Setting the automatic/manual focus function ............ 34 Zooming ................................................................... 34 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) ............................... 35 Using the OIS in the menu option ............................ 36 Depth preview .......................................................... 37 Basic shooting .....................................................38 Using the Smart Auto mode ...................................... 39 Using the Program mode .......................................... 40 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode ........................................................ 41 Using the Aperture Priority mode .............................. 41 Aperture value .......................................................... 41 Using the Shutter Priority mode ................................ 42 Shutter speed ........................................................... 42 Using the Manual mode ........................................... 43 Using the Night/Portrait/Landscape mode ................ 45 Using the night mode ............................................... 45 Using the portrait mode ............................................ 45 Using the landscape mode ....................................... 45 Using the Scene mode .............................................. 46 Using the Beauty Shot mode ....................................... 47 Recording a Movie .................................................... 48 Setting the aperture value ......................................... 48 To fade out the screen ............................................. 48 Using the Wind Cut .................................................. 4910 Contents Extended shooting functions ...............................50 Setting the resolution and quality .............................. 51 Setting a resolution ................................................... 51 Setting the image quality of the picture ..................... 52 Setting the quality of movie....................................... 52 Noise reduction ........................................................ 53 Using the timer function ............................................ 54 Setting the timer function .......................................... 54 Taking a picture in a dark place ................................. 55 Using the flash popup button ................................... 55 Setting the flash option ............................................. 55 Using the red-eye fix function ................................... 56 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain ........................................... 56 Adjusting the amount of flash light ............................ 57 Using an external flash unit (purchased separately) .. 58 Adjusting the ISO sensitivity ...................................... 59 Focusing methods .................................................... 60 Changing the Focusing methods .............................. 60 AF Priority ................................................................. 60 Using the AF assist light ........................................... 61 Changing the focus area .......................................... 61 Setting the focus of the selected area ...................... 62 Setting the MF Assist................................................ 63 Face detection .......................................................... 64 Normal face detection .............................................. 64 Self-portrait face detection ....................................... 65 Brightness and color adjustment of picture ............... 66 Adjusting the exposure (brightness) .......................... 66 Exposure adjustment................................................ 66 Changing the brightness measurement method ....... 67 Setting the white balance ......................................... 68 Color space .............................................................. 71 Smart range ............................................................. 72 Changing the shooting method ................................. 73 Successive shooting method and timer setup .......... 73 Detailed bracket setup ............................................. 74 Special effect/photo retouching ................................ 75 Picture wizard ........................................................... 75 Key Mapping ............................................................. 77 Setting the Key Mapping .......................................... 7711 Contents Playback/Editing ..................................................78 Play (picture/movie) ................................................... 79 Viewing pictures in the play mode ............................ 79 View files in the smart album by category ................. 81 Converting into the thumbnail view ........................... 81 File protection ........................................................... 82 Deleting a file ............................................................ 82 Enlargement/reduction ............................................. 84 View a movie ............................................................ 85 Picture editing ........................................................... 87 Changing the resolution ............................................ 87 Rotating .................................................................... 87 Red-eye fix ............................................................... 88 Adjusting the backlight ............................................. 88 Picture style .............................................................. 88 Face retouching........................................................ 88 Setting the print info (DPOF) ..................................... 89 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV ................................... 91 Transferring files to your computer ............................ 93 For Windows users ................................................... 93 For Mac users .......................................................... 96 Using Intelli-studio .................................................... 97 Transferring files using Intelli-studio .......................... 98 Using the Samsung RAW Converter ......................... 99 Correcting the exposure ......................................... 100 Handling the JPEG/TIFF files as you edit RAW files ... 101 Saving the RAW files into JPEG or TIFF format ...... 101 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) ..... 102 Camera settings menu .......................................103 Camera settings menu ............................................ 104 Sound .................................................................... 105 Display.................................................................... 105 Normal setup 1 ....................................................... 106 Normal setup 2 ....................................................... 107 Normal setup 3 ....................................................... 108 Appendixes ........................................................109 Error messages ....................................................... 110 Camera maintenance .............................................. 111 Cleaning your camera............................................. 111 About memory cards .............................................. 112 About the battery.................................................... 113 Before contacting a service center .......................... 115 Camera specifications ............................................. 118 Lens specifications .................................................. 122 Accessories (optional items) .................................... 123 Index ....................................................................... 125 Basic functions Learn about your camera’s layout, icons, and basic functions for shooting. Unpacking …………………………………………………13 Title and role of each part ………………………………14 Preparations before shooting ……………………………18 Turning on the power and initialization …………………23 Option/menu selection method …………………………26 Setting the display and sound ……………………………28 Simple picture-taking method ……………………………31 Tips for getting a clearer photo …………………………3213 Unpacking Check your product box for the following items. Camera (Body cap, eye-cup, Hot-shoe cover included) USB cable Battery Strap Software installation CD (including user's manual) Quick Start Manual Charger/AC power cable The actual components or optional parts may differ from the illustrations above. For information about optional items, see “Accessories (optional items).” (p. 123)14 Title and role of each part Mode dial (p. 5) AF-assist light /timer lamp (p. 61) Power switch (p. 23) Lens mount index (p. 21) Hot-shoe cover (p. 58) Strap holder (p. 22) Built-in flash (p. 55) Dial (p. 26) Shutter button (p. 7) Lens removal Lens mount (p. 21) button (p. 21) Flash button (p. 55) Depth preview button (p. 37) Hot-shoe (p. 58) Green button* Drive mode button (p. 73) Diopter adjustment dial (p. 16) * Use the green button [ ]. The following setup values are initialized if the button is pushed once in the standby state for shooting. Program shift / Detailed setup of picture wizard / Fine tuning of white balance / Color Temp. setting value / Adjusting the colors of screen menu / Timer / Flash EV / When selecting or setting AF, shift the changed focus area to the center / Bracketing setup Body cap (p. 21) DC-IN port HDMI port (p. 92) Shutter release connection port USB/AV OUT Port (p. 94) Image Sensor15 Title and role of each part AEL button (p. 77) EV button (p. 43) Eye-cup (p. 16) Display Viewfinder Eye sensor* DISP button (p. 28) Function(Fn) button (p. 27) Direction key (p. 5) Delete/Picture wizard button (p. 82) Battery chamber cover (p. 19) Playback button (p. 79) Tripod mount * Use of eye sensor This product will automatically convert to EVF when the users try to use the view-finder (EVF) by operating the eye sensor in Auto Select mode and all the information will be shown on the viewfinder. Do not cover the eye sensor with your hands or materials. Memory card slot Status lamp (p. 16) Memory card cover MENU button (p. 26)16 Title and role of each part Diopter adjustment dial/Eye-cup/ Status lamp Use of Diopter adjustment dial It is possible to adjust the viewfinder appropriate for the eyesight of user. If the image is not shown clearly through the viewfinder, move the eyesight adjustment dial in the left/right direction to have a clear view. Eye-cup Removal of Eye-cup When the camera is shipped, the eyecup is attached to the viewfinder. Push the Eye-cup up as shown in the figure for removal. Eyesight adjustment dial Status lamp In the case of saving a picture or shooting a movie, this shows the operating status of the camera by blinking the status indicator lamp • Blinking: When saving photos, recording movies, being read by a computer or printer. • Steady: When there is no data transfer or when connecting to a computer or printer is complete. Status lamp17 Title and role of each part Description for each part of the lens When purchasing the lens separately, please contact a Samsung service center to verify the compatibility of the camera an lens. This information in this user manual is based on the SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS lens. Please refer to the lens user manual for more information about the lens. • • Lens contacts Lens hood mount Zoom ring Lens mount connecting point OIS switch (p. 35) AF/MF switch (p. 34) Focus ring (p. 33) Lens [SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS] [SAMSUNG 30mm F2] Focus ring Lens Lens mount connecting point18 Preparations before shooting Charging the battery Please charge the battery fully before using this product. Please make the connections as in the following figure. Color of charge lamp Charging status Red Charging Green Fully charged Turned off, or Yellow Charging error To remove the battery from the charger, lift slightly in the direction of the arrow. Please use designated charger or batteries for proper use. SAMSUNG is not responsible for any accident that may occur from using a product other than designated. • • INSERT 1 2 INSERT CHARGE AC power code INSERT Charging lamp Charger19 Preparations before shooting Installing the battery When taking out the battery, pull down slightly on the lock lever. You can then remove the battery. 2 Lock lever 1 Open by pushing in the direction of the arrow 3 Close by pushing down in the direction of the arrow.20 Preparations before shooting Installing the memory card To remove the memory card, push the card slightly in the direction of insertion. Please do not remove the memory card or battery while the status indicator lamp is blinking. It may cause loss of data of product damage. • • 1 3 2 After checking the direction of metal terminal, you can insert the memory card.21 Preparations before shooting Mounting/dismounting the lens Please remove the lens mount cover and body cap prior to the installation of lens. After matching the lens mount index (red) of camera body with the point (red) of lens mount, join the lens by turning the lens clockwise until it clicks. When removing the lens, turn the lens counter clockwise while holding down the lens dismount button. Before mounting the lens Lens mounting Dismounting the lens Mounting or dismounting the lens while the camera is powered off is desirable to ensure the stable operation of the lens. SAMSUNG is not responsible for any accident, damage, or trouble caused by using other company's lens. The body cap protects the product from scratches or dust when you transport it. • • • Change lenses in a clean, low dust environment. Foreign particles inside the body or lens of the camera can cause the camera to malfunction. When mounting the lens, please do not touch the inner part of the camera with your finger. Dust or foreign particles inside the camera can affect image quality or cause the camera to malfunction. • • Lens mount connecting point22 Preparations before shooting Connecting the strap Connecting the strap to the camera body so you can carry the camera easily.23 Turning on the power and initialization When turning the power on/off, please set the power switch to ON/OFF. When you turn on the camera for the fi rst time, the camera may ask you to set the language and date. 1 Press [T] to select Language, and then press [ ]. 2 Press [S/T/W/X] to select a language, and then press [ ]. • The screen appears in the language you selected. 3 Press [S/T] to select Date, and then press [ ]. 4 Press [S/T/W/X] to set the date, and then press [ ]. MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time Exit Change Exit Change Exit Change24 5 Press [T] to select Time Zone and then press [ ]. 6 Select a desired world time zone by pressing [W/X]. 7 To set daylight saving time, press [S]. Press [S] again to disable. 8 Press [ ] to save. 9 Press [T] to select Time, and then press [ ]. 10 Set desired time by pressing [S/T/W/X], and then press [ ]. 11 Press [MENU] to finish setting. MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time Exit Change MENU 2 Time Zone London [GMT +00:00] 2010/01/01 01:10 AM Back DST Turning on the power and initialization25 Turning on the power and initialization A Information display Shooting mode Movie shooting mode Focus checking Flash 15 Shutter speed F3.5 Aperture value 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 Adjusted value of exposure AEL/AFL setting 0001 Possible no. of shots Battery information Displays no-insertion of memory card Warning of camera shake 12:00AM 2010.01.01 Time, date and year info Focus indicator ମGGଯ Spot metering area AF zone Histogram Grid display B Shooting option display(left) 14M Size Movie size SF Image quality Movie quality Focus area Flash Flash light adjustment RGB Color space Smart range OIS OIS Voice recording Fader Wind Cut C Shooting option display(right) Drive mode Timer AF mode White balance White balance adjustment ISO ISO Metering option Picture wizard The display shows the icons for the currently selected option. 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 15 F3.5 0001 A C AEL AFL 12:00AM 2010.01.01 14M SF RGB ISO B 3 - + 2 1 1 0 2 3 15 F3.5 0001 AAEEELL AFFFLL 12:00 12:0000 AMAM 2010.01.01 2010.01.01 OIS Icons All the details shown on the view finder will appear identically on the display. By using the live view function, the user can take a picture conveniently without having to look through the viewfinder. The icons shown on the screen are for when the OIS and AF/MF switches on the lens are in use.26 1 Press [MENU] in the Shooting mode. 2 You can select a desired option or menu by pressing [S/T/W/X] or [ ]. 3 To save a selected option or menu, press [ ]. Return to the previous screen To return to the previous menu screen, press [MENU]. Using the dial The user may change the menu setting's value by either using the dial or move the menu screen to a desired direction. For example when taking a picture in the shutter speed priority mode, this allows you to quickly adjust the desired shutter speed. Example. Using the dial in the S mode 1 Set the Mode dial to S. 2 Adjust the shutter speed by turning the dial. • The camera sets aperture value automatically according to the shutter speed you set. Option/menu selection method After pressing [MENU], you can select an option or menu by pressing [S/T] or [ ]. The user can return to the state of shooting by pressing [Shutter]. AF MF WB ISO AF/MF setting, Menu navigation (S) ISO setting, Menu navigation (T) White balance setting, Menu navigation (X) Metering method setting, Menu navigation (W) OK button, Setting Selection AF27 Using [Fn] By pressing the [Fn] function button, you can easily access major functions such as Quality, Size, AF area, Flash, Color Space, Smart Range, and OIS. Example. Flash setting in the P mode 1 Set the Mode dial to P. 2 Press the [Fn] button on the body of camera. 3 Select Flash using the [W/X] or dial. 4 Press [S]. 5 Set the flash menu option using the [W/X] or dial. 6 Press [S]. 7 Set the flash intensity using the [W/X] or dial. • You can adjust the intensity of the flash by ±2 levels. 8 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 9 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Option/menu selection method Displays the level of flash intensity adjustment Flash 14M SF RGB OIS Fill in 14M SF RGB OIS28 Setting the display and sound Learn how to change basic display and sound settings according to your preferences. Changing the display type You can select the icons and options the camera displays in the Shooting and Play modes by selecting a Display Type. Press [DISP] repeatedly. Shooting mode Display all the shooting information except for User Display setting values. Display all the shooting modes set by user. (p. 29) Hide all the information except for shooting mode, shutter speed, aperture value, exposure, number of available shots, and battery information. • • • Playback mode Display the shooting meta information. Display the RGB histogram, currently selected histogram option, and date set. Display shutter speed, aperture value, ISO, file in play, and total number of files saved. • • • Viewing the function descriptions of menu 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select a menu option. • Press and hold [DISP]. The function descriptions of the menu appears on the screen. ? Resolution and H/V ratio of images can be set. Photo Size DISP AF - MF WB ISO DISP button 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 20 F3.7 0001 09:45 2010.01.01 OIS29 Setting the display and sound Setting user display You can add or remove shooting information from the display. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → User Display → an option. About histogram A histogram is a graph that shows the brightness distribution of picture. This represents a dark picture if the graph is inclined to the left and if the graph is leaning to the right, this represents a bright picture. The height of graph is related to the color information and the graph gets higher if a specific color is distributed more. ▲Insufficient exposure ▲Balanced exposure ▲Excessive exposure Setting the sound You can set the sound the camera makes when you press the OK button. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Setting2( 2) → Sound → System Volume → an option. Off The camera makes no sound when you press [ ]. Low, Medium, High The camera makes a signal sound when you press [ ]. 3 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M RGB 20 F3.7 0001 09:45 2010.01.01 Icon 09:45 009:45 5 2010.01.01 2010 01 010.01.0101 SF 3 - + 2 1 1 0 2 3 20 F3.7 0001 14M RGB SFF Histogram Grid Icon ISO OIS30 Setting the screen display The screen display can be set according to the user’s convenience. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Setting3 ( 3) → Display Select 3 Select a desired option. Auto Select Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF The screen will be shown only through EVF MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 Display Select Video Out Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC) HDMI Size Firmware Update Auto NTSC On Auto 3 Auto Select Main Display EVF Back Set Setting the display and sound31 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame. All the details shown on the view finder will appear identically on the display. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Simple picture-taking method Using the Smart Auto mode, you can take a picture easily with minimum setup. • Please refer to the "Tips for getting a clearer photo" (p. 32) to take a clear picture. • Press [ ] to see the saved images on the screen. ● Green: Focus is set. ● Red: Focus is not set. 14M RGB WHITE 0001 OIS 14M SMART RGB WHITE 0001 OIS32 Holding your camera correctly Please make sure that your hand, hair, and strap do not interfere with the lens or flash. Image stabilization Half-pressing the shutter button In order to check in advance whether the focus of composition is set appropriately, please use the half-shutter function. If you press the shutter halfway down, the focus and exposure will be adjusted automatically. In order to check in advance whether the focus of composition is set appropriately, please use the half-shutter function. If you press the shutter halfway down, the focus and exposure will be adjusted automatically. Tips for getting a clearer photo Shows the shutter speed and aperture value being set. Focus frame If green, take the picture by pressing the [Shutter]. If red, either change the composition or adjust the focus again since the focus is not correctly set. • • To avoid the blurring effect of camera shake, set the optical Image Stabilization (OIS) function. (p.35) • 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 125 F3.5 0001 OIS33 Under the following circumstances, it may be difficult to get your subject in focus: When the color contrast is not clear (When someone is wearing clothes similar in color to the background) When the subject is in front of a strong backlight When the subject generates strong reflected light When there is a horizontally repeated line pattern (window blinds, etc.) When the subject is not located in the center When there is a flat white wall behind the subject which does not have specific patterns. When there is a fast moving subject. When the subject is too close to the camera. • • • • • • • • Using the manual focus If the auto focus function does not operate normally due to the environmental factors, your can set the lens to Manual Focus (MF) and adjust the focus manually. When the lens’ focus method is set to Manual Focus (MF), this function helps focus the subject by expanding the screen automatically. If the focus is adjusted by using the expanded image, the focus can be adjusted more accurately.(p. 63) Getting your subject in focus Please try to use the focus lock function. Adjust the focus by using the half-shutter function where the camera can focus easily. Then, simply press the [Shutter] button after moving the camera to a desired composition. Keep pressing and holding down the half-shutter until you actually make a photo shot. Under the half-shutter state, press the [AEL] button of the camera to fix the exposure value and focus information at the same time according to the setting. To cancel the function, press the [AEL] button once more. (p. 77) • Use the [AF/MF] control switch on the lens to switch the camera to manual focus. • If the lens doesn't have an AF/MF switch, you may be able to select Manual Focus in the AF mode menu • The availability of this option differs, depending on the lens you are using. • When you adjust the focus manually, the picture may appear blurred if you don't set the focus accurately. Take pictures after setting the focus accurately. • When using the manual focus function, the AF Area is not available to use. • In the movie shooting mode, you can not set the focus by using the expanded image.34 Setting the automatic/manual focus function You can set the camera to adjust focus automatically or manually by using the AF/MF switch on the side of the lens. 1 Using automatic focus Set the AF/MF switch of the lens to AF. The focus adjusts automatically when you press the shutter button half way down. 2 Using manual focus Set the AF/MF switch of the lens to MF. You can adjust the focus manually by turning the focus ring. Zooming Using the zoom ring, you can enlarge (telephoto angle) or reduce (wide angle) the size of an image by changing the focal length value of the camera lens. Adjust the image to the desired size, and then take a picture. 1 Check the focus, and then turn the zoom ring to the left/right.  The focal length of the lens changes and the subject appears enlarged or reduced. 2 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Since the focus can change slightly when you zoom in or out, we recommend you adjust the focus again prior to taking a picture. Some lens models do not have the AF/MF switch. Please consider this when purchasing a lens. (p.60)35 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) Use the optical image stabilization (OIS) function when taking pictures to minimize camera shake and improve focus. ▲ Before applying OIS ▲ After applying OIS Using the OIS switch of lens The OIS function can be used only in the case that the lens in use has the OIS function. To use this function, please set [OIS] to ON. ON OIS OFF36 Using the OIS in the menu option After setting the OIS switch, select the OIS function in the menu option 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3/ 3) → OIS → an option. OIS Mode 1 The OIS function is applied only when pressing the shutter in full or half. OIS Mode 2 The OIS function is always applied. The OIS function may not work well in the following situations: When you take a picture while tracing a moving object When a big vibration occurs beyond the range of stabilization When the shutter speed is too slow due to a circumstance like night shooting When the battery capacity is not sufficient When you are shooting a close-up shot When you use a tripod, please disable the OIS function since the image can be shaken due to the vibration of OIS function. If the camera is struck or dropped while you are taking a picture, the display can be impaired. If this occurs, turn the camera off and then on, and the camera should operate normally again. Since the battery consumption can increase along with the use of OIS function, it is recommended to use the function only if needed. To set the OIS function by using the menu, set [OIS] of lens to ON. This function may not operate depending on the lens model. The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode. • - - - - - • • • • •37 Depth preview When you are not using the depth preview function, you can only see the subject through the camera in the condition of the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) in the shooting mode. Use the Depth of Field Preview function before taking a picture to view the depth of field of the scene as it looks with the lens set to its current f-stop number. 1 Press the [Depth Preview] in the Shooting mode. 2 You can check the depth of field result actually taken through the display and viewfinder. What is the depth of field? When you focus on a specific subject, there is a range in which objects closer and further away are all in focus. This focused range is called the depth of field. The wider the wide-angle lens, the higher the aperture value, the greater the depth of field. For example, the aperture stop, f 11 is higher than f 2.8. Current position of the subject Current position of the subject 10 meters 6 meters 4 meters 2 meters 1 meters 10 meters 6 meters 4 meters 2 meters 1 meters S This refer to an appropriate range of focus when the depth of field is deep. S This refer to an appropriate range of focus when the depth of field is shallow. You can set the function of a button differently by using the Key Mapping menu option. (p. 77) Depth preview buttonBasic shooting Learn how to take a photo by selecting a mode and how to record a video. Using the Smart Auto mode ………………………… 39 Using the Program mode …………………………… 40 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode ……………………………………… 41 Using the Night/Portrait/Landscapee mode ……… 45 Using the Scene mode ……………………………… 46 Recording a Movie …………………………………… 4839 Using the Smart Auto mode The smart auto mode allows taking pictures under an optimized condition since the camera recognizes various photographing conditions automatically. Therefore, even a beginner can use the camera easily. 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame. • The camera automatically detects the type of scene and displays the corresponding scene icon in the display. Outdoor landscape shot Highly bright background shot Night landscape shot Outdoor portrait shot at night Backlight landscape shot without a man Portrait shot under backlight Portrait shot Close-up shot Close-up character shot Sunset shot Blue sky shot Nature shot such as forest and leaves Close-up shot for the subject with various colors Close-up portrait shot With the camera on a tripod, a shot of a subject that does not move for a period of time. Shot of fast moving subject or subject that moves frequently. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. If the camera does not detect a type of scene, it takes pictures with the basic settings of the mode. . Even if it detcts a face, the camera may not select portrait mode because of the orientation and brightness of the face. The camera may not recognize a scene because of adverse photograph conditions such as bad lighting, camera shake, and subject distance. The camera may not recognize the mode, even it the camera is on a tripod, depending on the movement of the subject. • • • • The camera displays the scene icon corresponding to the scene it detects. 14M SMART RGB WHITE 14M 0001 OIS40 Using the Program mode In the program mode, the camera automatically adjusts the shutter speed and aperture value to maintain the correct exposure. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 3 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. What is the program shift method? If this function is used, desired shutter speed and aperture value can be selected while maintaining the same brightness. The shutter speed and aperture value are changed as in the following rules. The available aperture numbers for exposure setting is different depending on the lens model. Dial direction Changing the exposure value Left Decreased shutter speed + increased aperture Right Increased shutter speed + decreased aperture 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 15 F3.5 0001 OIS41 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode By using the aperture value of adjusting light volume and shutter speed, you can take pictures of desired exposure. As for the shooting modes that allows adjusting the aperture value and shutter speed, there are the aperture priority mode, shutter speed priority mode, and manual mode. Using the Aperture Priority mode The Aperture Priority mode lets you to set the aperture value manually while the camera automatically selects an appropriate shutter speed. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to A. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the aperture value. 3 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Aperture value The aperture value of a lens can be adjusted to control the amount of light reaching the image sensor. When opening the aperture (reduce the aperture value), objects closer and further away than the focused subject will be out of focus. When closing the aperture (increase the aperture value), the range in focus expands forward and backward. ▲ Increased aperture value (narrower opening) ▲ Reduced aperture value (wider opening) 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M 20 F3.5 0001 SF RGB ISO A OIS F442 Using the Shutter Priority mode The Shutter Priority mode lets you set the shutter speed manually while the camera automatically selects an appropriate aperture value. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to S. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Shutter speed Shutter speed is the length of time the shutter is open. You can creat many interesting effects by adjusting the shutter speed. A low shutter speed blurs motion on the image. You can feel the speed in the picture when the low shutter speed is used for a shot. A fast shutter speed is essential for capturing the movement. A faster shutter speed froze the subject in its movement. ▲ Slow shutter speed ▲ Fast shutter speed Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M SF RGB ISO S 250 F3.7 0001 OIS43 Using the Manual mode In the manual mode, you can take pictures by setting various shot options directly including the shutter speed and aperture value. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to M. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Rotate the dial to adjust the aperture value while press and hold the [EV]. 4 Set desired shooting options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 5 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 6 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode EV button Dial In the P (Program), S (Shutter Priority), or A (Aperture Priority) modes, when a value appears in red, it is outside the range of values that produces good pictures. P mode: Shutter speed and aperture value can appear in red. S mode: Shutter speed can appear in red. A mode: Aperture value can appear in red. The camera can not set the ISO speed automatically in the M (manual) mode. • •44 Using the bulb exposure By using the bulb exposure, you can set the shutter speed as long as you want. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to M. 2 Rotate the dial and set the shutter speed to Bulb. • Bulb exposure indication appears next to the shutter speed of 30"(seconds). 3 To adjust the aperture value, press and hold the [EV] while rotating the dial. 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. • The exposure time continues until you finish holding the [Shutter]. Press and hold the [Shutter] for desired time. As soon as you finish holding the [Shutter], the shooting is complete. Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode To improve image stability in the Bulb Exposure mode, we recommend you use a reliable tripod or shutter release (purchased separately). With long exposures, the time the camera takes to save images gets longer as well. This is not a problem with the product and you do not need to replace the battery. Before using Bulb Exposure to take long exposures, we recommend you fully charging the battery. When you use Bulb Exposure to take long exposures, visual noise can occur. To control visual noise, we recommend you turn the Noise Reduction function on. The Noise Reduction function operates when the shutter exposure exceeds 1 seconds. When you use Bulb Exposure, the Successive Shooting function is unavailable. When you use Bulb Exposure, you can not set the ISO Speed to AUTO. • • • • • • 14M SF RGB ISO Bulb F3.5 00'00'' 0173 OIS45 Using the night mode Night mode provides the optimal exposure settings for dark or night time environments. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the portrait mode In Portrait mode, the camera automatically sets optimal portrait shot settings. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the landscape mode Landscape mode provides the optimal exposure and focus settings for natural landscapes. 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the Night/Portrait/Landscape mode When you use Night mode, we recommended you also use a tripod, shutter release, or Timer function (purchased separately) to minimize camera shake. In the portrait mode, the focus area is automatically set to the face as it is set to the Face Detection AF mode automatically. In the landscape mode, the camera adjusts shutter speed automatically according to the aperture value. We recommend you use a tripod in case the camera selects a slow shutter speed setting.46 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Select a scene. x Press [MENU] to select a scene. You can select a desired scene. x For the Beauty Shot mode, see “Using the Beauty Shot mode.” 3 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. If you have the camera set to Standby mode and the Mode dial set to , you can directly select a desired scene by pressing [Fn]. Using the Scene mode Since an appropriate option is set in advance by the scene, the shot can be taken conveniently by selecting a scene appropriate for the situation. MENU OK 1 Beauty Shot Back Set47 Using the Beauty Shot mode In the beauty shot mode, you can take pictures with options that make faces appear smooth and blemishfree. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → SCENE → Beauty Shot. 4 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Face Tone. 5 Set options. x Select a higher setting to make skin tone appear lighter. 6 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Face Retouch. 7 Set options. x Select a higher setting to make skin tone appear lighter. 8 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 9 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. MENU OK 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Face Tone Face Retouch OIS Level 1 In the Beauty Shot mode, AF area is set to Face Detection AF or Self-Portrait AF. Using the Scene mode MENU OK 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Face Tone Face Retouch OIS Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Back Set Back Set Level 1 Level 2 Level 348 Recording a Movie In the movie shooting mode, you can shoot videos in High Definition quality (1280x720). You can continue recording movies up to 25 minutes. The recorded video is saved as an H.264 (MPEG-4.AVC) file. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality. 4 Set options. 5 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Voice. 6 Select whether to record sound. 7 Press [Shutter] to start recording. 8 Press [Shutter] again to stop recording. Setting the aperture value You can set the aperture value when shooting a movie. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Movie AE Mode → an option. P Program The aperture value is adjusted automatically. A Aperture Priority Set the aperture value by using the dial before taking the movie. To fade out the screen You can make the movie screen darker or brighter gradually in recording by using the fader function. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Fader. Off Fader function not used In Scene gradually fades in when recording starts. Out Scene gradually fades out when recording ends In-Out The fader function is applied at the start and end of the scene Movie frame speed is fixed at 30 fps (30 frames/sec). While shooting a movie, push the [Depth Preview] button once to activate the AF function and once again to cancel the function. This function may not work depending on the lens you are using. • • REC WWaWX 01:00 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 F3.5 01:0049 Recording a Movie Using the Wind Cut Use the wind noise removal function to remove some surrounding noise in addition to the wind noise. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Wind Cut → an option. Pause while recording a movie By using the pause function, you can shoot only desired scenes into one file without generating several movie files. To pause during the recording, press [ ]. • To continue on recording, press [ ] again. H.264 (MPEG-4 part10/AVC) is the latest video coding format established in 2003 collaboratively by ISO-IEC and ITU-T. Since this format uses a high compression rate, more data can be saved in less memory space. When using a slow writing memory card, your movie's recording can be interrupted because the card can not process data at the rate the video is being shot. If this occurs, replace the card with a faster memory card or reduce the image size. If you have the image stabilizer option on when shooting a movie, the camera may record the image stabilizer sound. When the size of a movie file exceeds 4GB, the camera automatically stops recording. If this occurs, continue the movie by starting a new movie file. When formatting a memory card, always format using this camera. If you format on another camera or a PC, you can cause a change in the capacity of the card or make it incompatible with your camera. If you remove the camera lens while recording a movie, the recording will be interrupted. Do not change the lens while recording. While you shoot a movie, the camera can record the sounds of the zoom mechanism working and the sounds the camera makes when you press the buttons. If you change the shooting angle of the camera suddenly while shooting a movie, the camera may not be able to record images accurately. We recommend using a tripod when shooting a movie. In this way, you can minimize camera shake. In the Movie Shooting mode, the camera supports only the Multi AF function. You can not use any other focus area setting functions, such as Face Detection AF. • • • • • • • • • When you use the Fader function, it may takes longer to save images. •Extended shooting functions Learn about the options you can set in shooting mode. By using the shooting options, you can enjoy more customized pictures and movies. Setting the resolution and quality …………………… 51 Using the timer function ……………………………… 54 Taking a picture in the dark place …………………… 55 Focusing methods …………………………………… 60 Face detection ………………………………………… 64 Brightness and color adjustment of picture ………… 66 Changing the shooting method ……………………… 73 Special effect/photo retouching ……………………… 75 Key Mapping …………………………………………… 77 51 Setting a resolution To capture the high level of detail and excellent image quality in your picture or video, it is a good idea to set the resolution to the highest setting. The main drawback is that the file size becomes relatively big. Setting picture resolution 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Photo Size → an option. Picture size (display ratio) Proper use 14M 4592 x 3056 (3:2) For printing photos on A1 size prints. 10M 3872 x 2592 (3:2) For printing photos on A2 size prints. 6M 3008 x 2000 (3:2) For printing photos on A3 size prints. 2M 1920 x 1280 (3:2) For printing photos on A5 size prints. 4592 x 2584 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A1 size prints. 3872 x 2176 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A3 size prints. 3008 x 1688 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A4 size prints. 1920 x 1080 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A5 size prints. Setting video resolution 1 Press [MENU] in the Video Shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Movie Size → an option. 1280 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV 640 640 (4:3) When outputting to normal TV 320 320 (4:3) When uploading and using on the web Setting the resolution and quality You can also set the Resolution function by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.52 Setting the image quality of a picture The camera saves pictures in either in the JPEG or RAW format. The compression ratio is reduced as the image quality gets better. It is necessary to increase the file size to have a better quality picture. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Quality → an option. SF Super Fine Set to super fine quality F Fine Set to fine quality N Normal Set to normal quality RAW RAW Save in the RAW file format RAW S.FINE S.Fine+RAW Save super-fine image and RAW file at the same time RAW FINE Fine+RAW Save fine image and RAW file at the same time RAW NORMAL Normal+RAW Save normal image and RAW file at the same time Setting the quality of a movie The camera saves movies in normal or high quality. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality → an option. Normal Set normal quality HQ Set high quality • The camera saves RAW fi le format images without data loss and only in the 14M (4592 x 3056) photo size. Although settings for white balance, contrast, saturation, and sharpness, etc. are not reflected in the image, they are saved as information. If you want to save the RAW data into an image fi le format such as JPEG or TIFF, use the provided software (SAMSUNG RAW Converter). RAW fi les have an "SRW" extension. (For example: “SAM_9999.SRW”) Setting the resolution and quality You can also set the Quality function by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.53 Noise reduction This function can be set to reduce the noise in pictures. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → Noise Reduction → an option. High ISO NR This function reduces noise that may occur when you set a highspeed ISO (3200). Long Term NR This function reduces noise when you set the camera for a long exposure (over 1 seconds). It requires additional processing time equal to the shutter speed you used to take the picture. Setting the resolution and quality When the Noise reduction function is disabled, there might be a noise in the recorded picture.54 Setting the timer function 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Drive. 3 Press [Fn] after selecting Timer. 4 Select the operation time by rotating the dial or pressing [W / X]. • You can select the timer setting from 2 ~ 30 seconds. 5 The shot is taken automatically after the time being set has passed by pressing [Shutter]. Using the timer function The function can be set directly by pressing [ ] in the shooting mode. To cancel the self timer function, press [ ] one more time, or press [Shutter]. MENU 2 Timer Back Reset55 Using the flash popup button The flash operates when you pop-up the built-in flash by pressing the flash button. When the flash is closed, it will not burst out the light and the , , , and modes support automatic popup and flash light. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [ ]. 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. • Even if you have opened the flash using the 'Flash' button, the flash will not work if you have the Flash Option in the menu set to Off. Setting the flash option If a picture is taken in a dark place, the picture may appear to be dark since the light source is not sufficient. Press [ ] to pop up the flash. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) →Flash→ an option. Off The flash light doesn't operate. SMART Smart Flash The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to the amount of light in the surrounding environment. Auto The flash light operates automatically in the dark place. Auto+Red The flash light operates automatically and prevents the red-eye effect. Fill in • The flash operates whenever you take a picture. • The brightness of the flash is automatically controlled. Fill-in Red The flash operates whenever you take a picture and prevents the red-eye effect. 1st Curtain The flash operates immediately after the shutter opens. 2nd Curtain The flash operates just before the shutter closes. • You can take a better picture if the subject is located within the operational range of the flash. (Refer to the Guide Number in “Specification,”) • You can set the auto flash option for external flashes on the NX-series models only. • The flash options available differ, depending on the shooting modes. Flash button Taking a picture in a dark place The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.56 Using the red-eye fix function When you take a portrait using the flash, the bright burst of light can cause the red-eye effect. To prevent the red eye effect, set the flash option to Auto+Red or Fill-in Red. 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain The following images were obtained by taking the pictures of straight-moving subject along with the respective options of 1st Curtain and 2nd Curtain. In case of using the 1st Curtain flash function, the front part of action is remained clearly since the flash will burst light immediately upon shutter opening. Since the flash bursts the light at a later time when having used the 2nd Curtain option, the picture expresses the last image of the subject clearly. Ball moving direction Ball moving direction S Use of early 1st Curtain option S Use of 2nd Curtain option Taking a picture in a dark place • When you set the red-eye fix function, the camera prevents red-eye by emitting a preliminary flash prior to the brighter flash it emits when capturing the image. • When the subject is moving or is far away from the camera at the time of the preliminary flash, the function may not function well.57 Adjusting the amount of flash light When setting a fl ash option, you can adjust the brightness of the flash. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Flash. 3 Press the [Fn] button after selecting a desired item. 4 Adjust the brightness of the fl ash by rotating the dial or pressing [W / X]. • You can adjust fl ash brightness by ±2 levels. Taking a picture in a dark place • If the subject is too close, the ISO sensitivity is high, or the exposure value is too large or small, the adjustment effect will be reduced. • The Flash Brightness Adjustment function is not available in some shooting modes. • If an external fl ash unit has a flash control function, the light control value of the external flash is applied when you connect it to the camera. • If the distance from the subject is quite close when taking images by using the built-in flash, part of the images may appear dark as the lens is interfered with the flash light. Please check the distance between camera and subject when taking pictures. The distance interfered with flash light may vary by the type of lens in use. • If you've installed a lens hood, the hood can block light from the built-in flash. Please remove the lens hood when using the built-in flash. MENU 1 Flash Exposure Value Back Reset Display the level of flash light adjustment 58 Using an external flash unit (purchased separately) You can use the A-TTL auto fl ash mode when you attach an external fl ash unit (SEF20A or SEF42A) to the camera. This section of the user manual was prepared based on the model SEF20A flash. For more details about the external fl ash units, see the flash units user’s manual. Installing the flash 1 Install the external fl ash after removing the hot shoe cover. 2 Turn on the external fl ash. • The burst mode of external flash is set to the TTL auto mode. 3 Make sure the external flash is fully charged, and then start shooting. The available flash modes The flash modes available are determined by the camera lens or camera exposure mode you are using. 1 Smart Flash Mode • The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to amount of light in the surrounding environment. 2 Auto • The flash operates automatically in dim or dark light. 3 Auto + Red • The flash operates automatically in dim or dark light and prevents the red-eye effect. 4 Fill in • The flash operates whenever you take a picture and its brightness is controlled automatically. 5 Fill-in Red • Always operates the flash light, and prevents the red-eye effect. 6 1st Curtain • The flash operates immediately after the shutter opens. 7 2nd Curtain • The flash operates just before the shutter closes. Taking a picture in a dark place • Only a fl ash device manufactured for the NX series automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash. To enjoy the auto mode functions, please use the flash manufactured for NX models. Although the flash fires without the battery being fully charged, we recommend using the fl ash only after you charge the battery fully. • If an external flash unit has a flash control function, the light control value of the external flash is applied when you connect it to the camera.59 Adjusting the ISO sensitivity The ISO sensitivity, as the film sensitivity established by the international standards organization (ISO), represents the degree of reaction when camera receives light. Since it reacts more sensitively with greater ISO value, a natural shot can be obtained in a dark place by raising the ISO value. This reduces the degree of camera shaking with faster shutter speed. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → ISO → an option. Taking a picture in a dark place • The higher the ISO speed you select, the more visual noise you may get. • When the noise reduction function is used, the noise caused by the high-sensitive ISO(3200) can be reduced. • The available ISO setting options may differ depending on the Shooting mode. • You can set the ISO directly by pressing [ISO] in the Shooting mode.60 Focusing methods Changing the Focusing methods You can select a focusing method appropriate to the subject you are photographing. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2/ 2) → AF Mode → an option. Single AF When you press [shutter] half way down, the focus fixes in one position. Continuous AF When you hold the [shutter] half-way down, the focus adjusts continually as the subject changes position. Manual Focus Adjust the focus manually by turning the focus ring. AF Priority When you use the AF focusing function, the AF Priority function prevents the shutter from fi ring if the focus is not appropriately set. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Priority → an option. Off Camera takes a shot regardless of the focus. On The camera takes a shot only if the focus is set correctly when you press the shutter button. Even if the focus is set correctly when you press the shutter half way, the camera will not take the shot if the focus is not set correctly when you press the shutter button fully. • If your lens has an [AF/MF] switch, you can set the lens to MF and adjust the focus manually. • If there is no AF/MF switch on the lens, you can switch to manual focus by selecting Manual Focus in the AF mode menu. • The selectable option may differ according to the lens in use. • When adjusting the focus manually, the picture may appear blurred if you don't set the focus accurately. Please take a picture after setting the focus accurately. (p. 32). • You can also set the AF/MF function directly by pressing [ ] on top of the directional button while in Shooting mode. Even with AF Priority on, the Continuous and the Burst Shot options let the shutter fi re whether the focus is set correctly or not.61 Focusing methods Using the AF assist light The auto focus functions more accurately in dark places when the AF assist light is on. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → AF Lamp. Off AF assist light not used On AF assist light turns on when light is not sufficient. Changing the focus area The AF Area function changes the positions of the focus area or areas and can give you clearer, sharper pictures. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) →AF Area→ an option. Selection AF Sets the focus appropriately for an area you have selected. Multi AF Displays a green rectangle in all the Face places where focus is set correctly. Face Detection AF Shows the areas that the focus is correctly set in the display. SelfPortrait AF When the sound effect is heard at the time of self-shot, you can check the position of the subject’s face. • The available options may differ by Shooting mode. • When you set the AF/MF switch on the lens to MF, you can not change the AF area using the Shooting menu. • When you select the Multi AF function, the AF areas that are in focus appear in green. • You can select this function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode. 62 Setting the focus of the selected area In the shooting composition, a shot may be taken by setting the focus to the area desired by user. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Selection AF. 3 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. 4 In the Shooting mode, press [ ]. 5 Press [S/T/W/X] to move the focus area. 6 Adjust the size of focus area by using the dial. 7 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 8 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Focusing methods AF Zoom Move MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 AF Mode AF Area AF Priority MF Assist Drive Flash 3 Back Set Selection AF Multi AF Face Detection AF Self-Portrait AF AF Zoom Move63 Setting the MF Assist When the lens’ focus method is set to Manual Focus (MF), this function helps focus the subject by expending the screen automatically. 1 Set the focus method to Manual Focus. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → MF Assist 3 Select a desired option. Off Do not enlarge the subject on screen when it is in Manual focus mode. On Enlarge the subject on screen when you adjust the focus in Manual focus mode. MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 AF Mode AF Area AF Priority MF Assist Drive Flash 3 On Off On Back Set Focusing methods64 Face detection When you use the Face Detection AF function, you can set the focus around a person's face when taking a portrait shot. This function can also be useful when shooting a self-portrait. Normal face detection When you use the Face Detection AF option, the camera sets the auto focus based on the faces in the frame. When the shooting composition is set, the camera automatically detects as many as 10 faces and sets the focus and exposure. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Face Detection AF. • Face detection may not be effective when. - The subject is too far away - The light is too bright or dark - The subject is not facing the camera - When part of the face is hidden by an object like sunglasses. - Part of the subject's face is hidden by sunglasses or similar objects - The subject makes a large facial expression - The light or backlight on the subject's face is not uniform • Depending on the Picture Wizard option, the camera may not recognize the subject’s face • The options available may differ depending on the shooting mode. • This function is not available if you have selected such options as Manual Focus and Selection AF. • The face detection function works faster when the camera is closer to the subject. • When you use the Face Detection AF option, the white focus area is automatically set to focus. The focus frame is shown by white for the closest face and by gray for the rest of faces. 65 Self-portrait face detection With Self-Portrait AF on, the camera chirps rapidly when your face is in focus. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Self-Portrait AF. 3 Press [Shutter] if having an info sound of shooting. Check the focus of the subject in Shooting mode Face detection66 Brightness and color adjustment of picture Adjusting the exposure (brightness) The images can be taken bright or dark according to the amount of light. In this case, appropriate adjustment can be made by controlling the amount of light entered into the lens. S Applying - S 0 S Applying + 1 Check the accurate focus of subject in the shooting mode 2 To adjust the exposure value, hold down the [ ] button, and then rotate the dial. • The adjustment value of exposure can be checked from the viewfinder and display. 3 Press the [Shutter] button to take a picture. Exposure adjustment You can set the size of the exposure adjustment. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → EV Step → an option. 1/3 Change the exposure level by 1/3 step. 1/2 Change the exposure level by 1/2 step. • When fixing and using the exposure value being set, it may be excessively bright or dark according to the shooting environment. Please take a picture by adjusting the exposure value appropriate for the shooting environment. • When it is difficult to judge an appropriate value of exposure, please set the detailed setting of AE BKT (successive shots of exposure increase/decrease). This takes 3 pictures successively, including one step darker one and one step brighter one (p. 73). • The camera displays the exposure warning in red for each step beyond the ±3 range. Standard exposure index Exposure level display Decreased exposure (Darker) Increased exposure (Brighter) 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 Exposure warning 3 267 Changing the brightness measurement method If the composition of image is set, the camera measures the amount of light. At this time, the brightness and overall mood of the picture may vary depending on how the measurement is made. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3/ 3 ) → Metering → an option. Spot • Calculate the amount of light in the center. • This is suitable when taking a portrait shot where there is a strong backlight. • When the subject is not located in the center of the display, the subject can appear to be too bright or too dark. Centerweighted • This calculates the amount of light in the center portion of the shot and averages the result over the entire image. • This is suitable when the area of the subject is large when compared to the overall composition of the picture. Multi • Calculate the amount of light in multiple areas. • Suitable for normal pictures. Brightness and color adjustment of picture The function can be set directly by pressing [ ] in the shooting mode.68 Setting the white balance Different light sources will affect the resulting color of your picture. To take a picture with colors close to what is seen with our own eyes, please select the white balance appropriate for the light source or manually adjust the color temperature desired. In case of a light source that is difficult to take in to effect, the shot can be taken by adjusting the white balance manually according to the picture-taking situation. Auto Daylight Cloudy Incandescent bulb 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance → an option. Auto WB The camera automatically selects the optimal white balance settings. Daylight For shooting outdoors on a clear day. Cloudy For shooting outdoors on a cloudy day. Fluorescent White Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the white fluorescent light with the color temperature of about 4200K Fluorescent NW Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the daylight fluorescent lighting with the color temperature of about 5,000K Fluorescent Daylight Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the daylight-like fluorescent lighting with the color temperature of about 6,500K Tungsten For shooting under halogen lamps and standard, incandescent bulbs. Flash WB Suitable when using the built-in flash light Custom Set To create a custom white ballance setting. Color Temp. To set the color temperature manually. Brightness and color adjustment of picture The function can be set directly by pressing [WB] in the shooting mode.69 Fine adjustment of the white balance 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select a White Balance option, and then press [Fn]. 4 Adjust a desired white balance by using the dial or [S/T/W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to save. User setup method If the shot is taken after setting the composition of white paper, filled in full frame, an appropriate white balance value is set according to the measured light source. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select Custom Set, and then press [Fn]. 4 After setting the composition to show only the white paper, press [Shutter]. Brightness and color adjustment of picture White paper G: Green A: Amber M: Magenta B: Blue • • • • MENU 1 WB Adjust Back Reset70 Adjusting the color temperature You can change the white balance by adjusting the color temperature. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select the Color Temp. option, and then press [Fn]. 4 Set the color temperature by rotating the dial or pressing [W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to save. What is color temperature? Color temperature refers to the temperature that has expressed the color change of light in the absolute temperature (K). This can express cold sense with the rising color temperature and warm sense with the falling color temperature. Clear sky Fluorescent_H Cloudy Daylight Fluorescent_L Halogen lamp Incandescent bulb Candle light Brightness and color adjustment of picture MENU 1 K Adjust Back Reset 5500 K71 Color space You can set the color space the camera uses. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Color Space → an option. RGB sRGB Set the color space to sRGB. RGB Adobe RGB Set the color space to Adobe RGB. What is color space? The image In/Output devices such as digital camera, monitor and printer hold different ranges of reproducing each color. The possible range of color reproduction is referred to as color space. Several standards of color space are fixed for each device. This camera support sRGB and Adobe RGB. sRGB is diversely used in the devices like computer. It is recommended to use sRGB for regular images. sRGB standards for International standard of color space established by the IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). This is defined from color space for PC monitors and is also used as the standard color space for Exif. Adobe RGB is the color space recommended by Adobe Systems, Inc. for commercial printing and has wider range of color reproduction than sRGB. Adobe RGB covers most of the color range so colors only available when printed are not lost when editing images from a computer. When image is opened by non-compatible software, the colors look lighter. Brightness and color adjustment of picture • When you set the color space to Adobe RGB, the camera saves picture files in the "_SAMXXXX.JPG" format. • You can set the Color Space function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode.72 Smart range Smart Range automatically corrects for the loss of bright detail that can occur due to shading differences in the picture. ▲ Canceling smart range ▲ Use of smart range 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3) → Smart Range → an option. • When you turn on Smart Range, you cannot select the ISO 100 option. • The Smart range function is not available in some shooting modes, and it may automatically operate while you use the and shooting options. • You can set the Smart Range function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode. Brightness and color adjustment of picture73 Changing the shooting method It can be difficult to take a picture of a fast moving object, a quick facial expression, or the rapid motion of a person. In this case, please select the successive shooting option appropriate for the situation. Successive shooting method and timer setup You can select the successive shooting option appropriate for the situation. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Drive → an option. Drive mode button You can can set this option directly by pressing the [ ] in the Shooting mode. Single Take one photo shot whenever you press the shutter. Continuous Take shots successively while pressing and holding down the shutter, possible to take 3 shots per second Burst Press the shutter button and the camera takes up to 30 shots in a row. Timer Press the shutter button and the camera takes a picture within 2 to 30 seconds. AE BKT When you press the shutter, the camera takes 3 consecutive shots: the original, one a step darker, and one a step lighter. WB BKT When the shutter is pressed the camera will take 3 consecutive shots, the original and 2 more with different white balance settings. P Wiz BKT When the shutter is pressed, the camera will take 3 consecutive shots; all three will have different picture wizard settings. • The options may differ depending on the Shooting mode. • The WB BKT and P Wiz BKT functions correct the image after you take the shot. • If you set the photo quality to the RAW format, you can not use the bracketing options (WB BKT, P Wiz BKT). • When you select the Burst shooting option, you can not select the image size, and the image quality is fixed at 1472x976. Also, when you are shooting using the Burst option, the camera can take longer to save the images. • With the Burst shooting option, the camera can not save images in the RAW file format. Also, you can not set the ISO to 100. • Both the built-in and external flash do not fire when you use the Burst shooting option. • The shutter speed can be set to 1/30 Sec or faster when the Burst shooting option is in use. • This product supports Burst Shooting mode which takes up to 30 shots per second. The images taken in Burst Shooting can be saved with a little bit enlarged size.74 Detailed bracket setup The details for the exposure, white balance and picture wizard of bracket shot can be set. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3) → BKT Set → an option. 3 Select the detailed options. AE BKT Set When using the exposure BKT function, this allows setting the image shot sequence and exposure interval. BKT Order: Set the shooting orders BKT Area: Set the exposure steps WB BKT Set When using the WB BKT function, this allows setting the adjusted interval of white balance value. Example) MG-/+3 adjusts the Magenta value of 3 steps minus or plus. P Wiz BKT Set When using the picture wizard BKT function, this allows setting the shot order. MENU OK 3 BKT Set AE BKT Set WB BKT Set P Wiz BKT Set AB -/+3 Changing the shooting method Exit Change OK 3 P Wiz BKT Set Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Select Set75 Special effect/photo retouching Picture wizard The Picture Wizard function lets you select various looks and emotional moods for your pictures. T Example Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Cool Calm Classic 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Picture Wizard → an option. 3 Adjust the detailed items of picture wizard that were selected by using [S/T/W/X]. • You can control the color, saturation, sharpness and contrast. 4 Set to a desired value. • The option can be set directly by pressing the [ ] button of camera in the shooting mode. MENU Vivid P L F R Cool CA Color ■ 0 0 0 V Saturation Sharpness Contrast Exit Move76 Special effect/photo retouching Custom picture wizard setup You can choose the customize options and then save images in 3 different ways. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Picture Wizard → Custom → an option. 3 Adjust the Picture Wizard value by using [S/T/W/X] • You can control the color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast. 4 Set to a desired value. MENU Custom1 P L F R Cool CA C1 Color ■ 0 0 0 Saturation Sharpness Contrast Exit Move Classic77 Key Mapping Setting Key Mapping The function of camera button can be changed. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → Key Mapping → an option. AEL You can choose among three settings for the [AEL] button: - AEL, which executes the auto exposure lock function. - AFL, which executes the auto focus lock function. - AEL + AFL, which executes the auto exposure and focus lock functions together. Preview You can chose between two settings for the Depth Preview button: - One-Touch WB which executes the Custom White Balance function. - Optical Preview which executes the Depth of Field Preview function for the current aperture value. What is AEL function? The auto exposure lock (AEL) and auto focus lock (AFL) functions of the camera are the functions that maintain the settings until the shooting is completed by remembering the exposure value and focus when pushing the [AEL] button of camera. Reaction of the half-shutter release when the AEL button is set to the following status. Status of AEL setting Reaction of the half-shutter release AEL Auto focus AFL Exposure lock AEL+AFL None • While shooting a movie, push the [Depth Preview] button once to activate the AF function and once again to cancel the function. • Refer to the “Depth Preview” function. (p. 37) • The function of AEL button cannot be changed in the M(manual) mode.Playback/Editing Learn how to play back and edit photos/videos. Also, learn how to connect your camera to your computer, photo printer, TV, or HDTV. Play (picture/movie) …………………………………… 79 Picture editing ………………………………………… 87 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV ………………………… 91 Transferring files to your computer ………………… 93 Using the Samsung RAW Converter ………………… 99 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) ……… 10279 Viewing pictures in the play mode You can view saved pictures and movies. 1 Press [ ] • Shows most recently saved file. 2 View the pictures sequentially using [W/X]. • When the playback screen is selected more than once, the last shown picture or movie is selected to be shown during playback. Photo playback information screens The display information appears by pressing [DISP] in the play mode. 1 RAW file indicator 2 File that includes development info 3 Protected file indicator 4 File no. 5 Meta value of picture 6 Shutter speed info 7 Aperture value 8 ISO setup value info 9 File playing/total no. of files stored/battery information Play (picture/movie) 1/250 F5.1 ISO 100 00004/00009 100-0001 Mode Flash Focal Length White balance EVC Picture size Date 8 9 4 5 6 7 3 2 18mm 0.0 4592 X 3056 2010.01.01 RAW 180 1 Shot image 2 RGB histogram 3 Shooting mode, metering, flash, white balance, picture wizard, focal length 4 Shutter speed, aperture value, ISO, selected file/total number of files/ battery information Movie playback information screen 1 Volume control display 2 Protected file 3 File no. 4 Meta value of movie 5 Fast forward 6 Total play time of selected file 7 Current play time 8 Rewind Play (picture/movie) OK WWaWW WXaWW 100-0001 1280 X 720 2010.01.01 Video size Date 3 4 1 7 6 8 5 2 1/40 F3.5 ISO 100 00004/00009 0.0 4592 X 3056 2010.01.01 R G B 1 2 3 4 Y RAW 18mm Play Capture81 View files in the smart album by category The files can be classified and shown by the file, date (day), date (week), and type. 1 In Playback mode, press [ ]. 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select a desired playback method. Type Classify by the saved file form Date Classify by date recorded. Week Classify by week recorded. 4 You can view items by turning the dial or pressing [W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to return to the previous function. Converting to the thumbnail view Since several files can be shown on one display, files can be searched quickly. To have a thumbnail view of 9 images, press [ ] two times, or press [ ] three times to have a thumbnail view of 20 images. (Press [ ] to cancel) Play (picture/movie) When you start Smart Album or change the filter method, the time it takes for the camera to classify and display files depends on the number of files saved. Please wait a until Smart Album appears. MENU 2010. 1. 1 19 25 19 53 22 Filter MENU 2010. 1. 1 19 25 19 53 22 Type Date Week Filter 82 File protection You can protect files from accidental deletion. 1 Press [AEL] in the play mode. 2 appears on the display. 3 Press [AEL] to cancel. Deleting a file Files can be selected and deleted in the play mode. The function can be set by pressing [MENU] in the playback mode. Deleting one picture You can delete only one picture by selecting a desired file. 1 After selecting the file to be deleted in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 From the popup window, select Yes. Deleting selected file 1 After selecting the file to be deleted in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 From the popup window, select Multiple Delete. 3 After selecting a file to be deleted, press [ ]. • To cancel your selection, press [ ] again. 4 Press [ ] 5 From the popup window, select Yes. Play (picture/movie)83 Deleting all files All the files saved in the memory card can be deleted at once. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Delete → All. 3 From the popup window, select Yes. Auto rotate Show the pictures taken in the vertical frame by rotating them automatically while in playing. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Auto Rotate → On. High Light This informs the excessively bright part from the image taken. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → High Light → On. Play (picture/movie) If the photo shot is taken when the direction of the camera was aimed at the bottom, the direction of the image can be different in the playback mode.84 Enlargement/reduction A picture can be enlarged when searching in play mode. Enlargement Press [ ] to enlarge. (Press [ ] to reduce) Move enlargement on screen Press [S/T/W/X]. Trim the enlarged image Press the [Fn] button to select a portion of the image to be cut. See the slide show Pictures can be shown in a slide show by applying various effects and music. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU] → [ ]. 2 Select a desired option • To play without selecting an option, go to step 4. Images Select the pictures you want in the slide show. • All : Include all the saved pictures in the slide show. • Date : Include pictures taken on a specific date in the slide show. • Select : Select pictures and see them in the slide show Effect • Select the transition effects between pictures. • In order not to use the changing effect, select the off option. Interval • Select the scene changing time Music Execute the background music Play (picture/movie) OK Fn x1.7 Magnified part Magnification (The maximum magnification may differ by resolution) Full Image Trim85 3 Set to a desired option. 4 Select Slide Show → Play. • To play the slide show repeatedly, please select the repeat option. 5 Watch the slide show • To stop slide show, press [ ] and then press [W/X]. Pause/Play Press the [ ] button. View a movie While a movie is being played back, you are able to select and cut a desired part of the scene. 1 After selecting a desired movie in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 Enjoy movie. Rewind Press [W] Pause/Play Press [ ]. Fast rewind Press [X] Volume control Turn the dial to the left/right Stop Press [S] Play (picture/movie) OK WWaW[ PLAY WXaWW 100-0001 Pause Stop86 Capturing a picture You can capture a frame of the movie as a picture while playing back the movie. 1 Press [ ] in the play mode. 2 Press [ ] while playing a movie. 3 Press [T] in the pause state. Cutting part of a movie 1 Press [ ] in the play mode. 2 Select the start point to cut by pressing [ ] → [ ] while playing a movie. 3 Select the end point of cutting by pressing [ ] → [ ]. 4 From the popup window, press Yes. Play (picture/movie) • The resolution of the captured image is the same as the movie resolution. • The captured file is saved as a separate file under a new file name. • The cut file is saved by using a different file name.87 Picture editing Pictures can be edited in various ways by using the edit menu. The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode. Changing the resolution 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Image Edit → Resize. 3 Select desired image resolution. • The edited file is saved by using the different file name. Rotating 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Image Edit → Rotate. 3 Select a desired rotation state • The resolution to be changed will be limited according to the resolution of original picture. Depending on the size of the picture, when you rotate the original, the new file may be smaller compared to the original. Resize Rotate88 Red-eye fix 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Red-eye Fix. Adjusting the backlight 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Backlight. Picture style Selecting picture style allows you to express various moods of emotion in your picture. 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Photo Style Selector. 3 Set to a desired option. Face retouching 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Face Retouch. 3 Set to a desired option. • The level of face retouch gets better as the value becomes larger. Picture editing89 Setting the print info (DPOF) The size and number of copies to be printed can be designated for the picture. Since the designated information is saved in the MISC folder of memory card, it is convenient to print the designated size and number of copies while using the pictures of designated info simply by taking the memory card to a digital printing shop. 1 Press [MENU] → Playback [ ] → DPOF → Standard in the playback mode. 2 Select a desired option Select Printing selected pictures All Printing all Reset Initializing the standard print option 3 When having made the selections, press [Fn] after selecting the picture and number of copies to be printed by using the dial. • When having selected all, press [S/T] to select the number of copies to be printed and then, press [ ]. • The print info you enter can only be used for the digital printer or digital picture printing shop that supports the digital print order format (DPOF). • For pictures with a wide resolution, the left and right portion of the image may not be printed. When placing a print order, identify the wide resolution pictures. • The DPOF option is not available for RAW formatted images and the movie files. Picture editing90 4 Select [MENU] → DPOF → SIZE in the playback mode. 5 Select an option Select Select desired print size according to the picture. All Select the print size of all the pictures saved in the memory card. Reset Initializing the print size option 6 When having selected the select option, select the picture to be printed and press [Fn] after selecting the print size by using the dial. • When having selected all, press [S/T] and select the print size. Then, select the print size and press [ ]. Index printing 1 Press [MENU] → Playback [ ] → DPOF → Index in the playback mode. 2 From the popup window, press Yes. Picture editing The designated print size can only be applied onto the DPOF1.1 compatible printer. 91 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV Play back photos or videos by connecting your camera to a TV using the provided A/V cable. Viewing files on a regular TV 1 Select a video signal output according to your country or region. (p. 108) 2 Connect the TV and the camera using the A/V cable. 3 Make sure the TV and camera are turned on and select the video output mode of TV. 4 View the videos and pictures using the buttons of camera body. On some TVs, digital noise may occur or part of an image may not appear. Images may not appear centered on the TV screen depending on your TV settings. You cannot capture photos or videos while the camera is connected to a TV. • • • Video Audio92 Viewing files on an HDTV 1 Select a video signal output according to your country or region. (p. 108) 2 In Shooting or Playback mode, select [MENU] → Setting 3 ( 3 ) → HDMI Size → an option. 3 Connect the HDTV and the camera using the HDMI cable. 4 Make sure the HDTV and camera are turned on and select the HDMI mode of TV. • The HDTV screen shows the same display of the camera. 5 View the videos and pictures using the buttons of camera body. When using the HDMi cable, the user can connect the camera to an HDTV using the Anynet+(CEC) method. The Anynet+(CEC) functions allows you to control connected devices using the TV remote control. In the case that the HDTV supports Anynet+(CEC), the power of the TV is automatically turned on when used in conjunction with the caemra. When connected to an HDTV by an HDMI cable, the camera can not take a pictures or movies. When connected to an HDTV, some playback functions may not be available. • • • • Viewing files on a TV or HDTV HDMI cable If both A/V and HDMI cables are connected at the same time, the HDMI cable has the highest priority. We recommend you disconnect the A/V cable for better playback.93 Transferring files to your computer For Windows users Transfer files by connecting your camera to your PC. Installing programs Hardware and software requirements Item Requirements CPU Intel Pentium 4 3.2GHz or higher RAM 1GB or more (2 GB or more recommended) OS Windows XP SP2/Vista/7 Hard disk capacity 250 MB or more (1 GB or more recommended) Others USB port CD-ROM drive 1024 x 768 pixels, 16-bit color display compatible monitor (32-bit color display recommended) Microsoft Direct X 9.0c or later • • • • Programs contained on the CD Program Purpose Intelli-studio Edit photos and videos. Samsung RAW Converter Convert RAW files into the desired file format. Using a self-assembled PC or a PC and OS that are not supported may void your warranty. The programs may not work properly on 64-bit Edition of Windows XP, Vista and 7. • • Intelli-studio may not perform correctly on some computers, even when the computer meets the requirements. If your computer does not meet the requirements, videos may not play correctly or it may take longer to edit videos. Install DirectX 9.0c or above before you use the program. You must use Windows XP/Vista/7 or Mac OS 10.4 or later to connect the camera as a removable disk. • • • •94 Transferring files to your computer 1 Insert the installation CD in a compatible CDROM drive. 2 When the setup screen is displayed, click Samsung Digital Camera Installer to start installation. 3 Select programs to install, and follow the onscreen instructions. 4 Click Exit to complete the installation, and then restart your computer. Transferring files to your PC When you connect the camera to your PC, the PC recognizes the camera as a removable drive. 1 Connect your camera to your PC with the USB cable. You must plug the end of the cable with the correct connection plug into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data.95 2 Turn on the camera. • In the popup window, select Computer. 3 On your PC, select My Computer→ Removable Disk→DCIM→ "XXXPHOTO," or select "XXX_MMDD" folder. 4 Select the files you want, and then drag or save them to your PC. Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) The way to disconnect the USB cable for Windows 2000 and Vista is similar. 1 It the status lamp on your camera is blinking, it means the data transfer is in progress. Please wait until the status lamp stops blinking. 2 Click on the tool bar at the bottom right of your PC screen. 3 Click the pop-up message. 4 Remove the USB cable. Transferring files to your computer If the Folder Type is set to Date, the folder name appears as "XXX_MMDD." For example, if shot at January 1st, the folder name appears as "101_0101." • •96 For Mac users When you connect the camera to a Macintosh computer, the computer recognizes the camera automatically. You can transfer files directly from the camera to the computer without installing any programs. 1 Connect your camera to a Macintosh computer with the USB cable. 2 Turn on the camera. In the popup window, select Computer. 3 Double-click the removable disk icon. 4 Transfer photos or videos to the computer. • When using the USB cable, make sure to match the plugs on the cable to the USB jacks on the camera and computer. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Please use only the accessories that SAMSUNG provides. The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from the use of other manufacturer’s product. • • Mac OS 10.4 or later is supported. Transferring files to your computer97 Using Intelli-studio Once you have installed the Intelli-studio on your PC, the Intelli-studio starts automatically when a camera is connected with your PC. If the Intelli-studio does not start after you have connected the camera to your PC, double-click the Intelli-studio icon on your Windows desktop. The Intelli-studio allows you to play back and edit files. You can also upload files to websites, such as Flickr or YouTube. For details, select [Menu → Help] in the program. Transferring files to your computer You cannot edit files directly on the camera. Transfer files to a folder on your computer before editing. You cannot copy files in your computer to the camera. Intelli-studio supports the following formats: - Videos: AVI(MJPEG), MP4 (Video: H.264, Audio: AAC), WMV (WMV 7/8/9) - Photos: JPG, GIF, BMP, PNG, TIFF • • •98 Icon Description 1 Open menus 2 Display files in the selected folder 3 Change to the Photo edit mode 4 Change to the Video edit mode 5 Change to the Sharing mode (You can send files by email or upload files to websites, such as Flickr or YouTube.) 6 Enlarge or reduce the thumbnails in the list 7 Select a file type 8 View files of the selected folder on your computer 9 Show or hide files of the connected camera 10 View files of the selected folder on the camera 11 View files as thumbnails, in Smart Album, or on a map 12 Browse folders in the connected device 13 Browse folders in your computer 14 Move to the previous or next folder 15 Print files, view files on a map, store files in My Folder, or register faces Transferring files using Intelli-studio Intelli-studio will start automatically when you connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. 1 Connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. 2 Turn on the camera. The computer recognizes the camera automatically. 3 Select a folder on your computer to save new files. If your camera has no new files, the pop-up window for saving new files will not appear. 4 Select Yes. New files will be transferred to the computer. • • • Transferring files to your computer If the camera fails to connect, a pop-up window will appear. Select Computer. For Windows Vista, select Run Installer.exe from the AutoPlay window.99 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Using the Samsung RAW Converter, you can develop RAW files after editing them as you like. You can also edit JPEG or TIFF files in the same way you edit the RAW files. This software is only compatible with Windows XP, Vista and 7. To start the program, click [Start → All Programs → Samsung RAW Converter → Samsung RAW Converter]  Editing the RAW files Image edit functions are listed below. Ì Menu bar Í Image editing tools [Exposure bias]: Compensates the exposure value. [White balance]: Adjusts the white balance value. [Color]: Adjusts the color of the image. [Tone]: Changes the color tone. [Sharpness/ Noise reduction]: Adjusts the sharpness. [Development]: Previewing is available for the final output.  Highlight controller Adjusts the saturation and highlights of the selected image.  Histogram Displays the color layers of the selected image.  Preview window Displays the selected image. • Refer to the [Help] menu in the Samsung RAW Converter for further information. You can download the Samsung RAW Converter program for Macintosh from the Samsung website. • • ② ① ⑤ ③ ④100 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Correcting the exposure The main feature of the Samsung RAW Converter is that you can keep the best quality of the images as you make changes to the RAW files while editing. After making changes to the brightness or contrast, you can still obtain the same result no matter which you change first. The following images show how you can change the exposure on an image using the Samsung RAW Converter. You can adjust the exposure by using the menu option as shown in the picture below. You can see the results of the exposure adjustment in the histograms below: ▲ Original image P Mode, Aperture: f = 8, Shutter Speed: 1/15sec, ISO = 100 ▲ Changed image after correcting the exposure. ▲ Original image ▲ Changed image after correcting the exposure. Menu option for adjusting the exposure.101 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Handling the JPEG/TIFF files as you edit RAW files Using the Samsung RAW Converter, you can edit JPEG/TIFF files in the same way you edit RAW files. You can adjust the white balance, sharpness, and reducing the noise is also available. The following images show how to change the contrast on a TIFF image using the Samsung RAW Converter. You can adjust the contrast by using the menu option as shown in the picture. Saving the RAW files in JPEG or TIFF format You can save the RAW files in JPEG or TIFF format using the Samsung RAW Converter. 1. Choose the image you want to edit, and then select [File(F)] → [Development...]. 2. Select the type of file as JPEG or TIFF and then click [Save(S)]. - The selected file is saved as JPEG or TIFF format. ▲ Original image P Mode, Aperture: f = 8, Shutter Speed: 1/15sec, ISO = 100 ▲ Changed image after correcting the contrast. Menu option for adjusting the contrast102 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) Print photos with a PictBridge-compatible printer by connecting your camera directly to the printer. 1 With the printer on, connect your camera to the printer with a USB cable. 2 Turn on your camera. Select Printer in the popup window. 3 Press [W/X] to select a photo. Press [MENU] to set printing options. 4 Press [ ] to print. • • Configuring print settings Print MENU Exit 1 2 Images Size Layout Type Quality Date One Photo Auto Auto Auto Auto Auto Images Select whether to print the current photo or all photos. Size Specify the size of the print. Layout Create thumbnail prints. Type Select the type of paper. Quality Set the printing quality. Date Set to print the date. File Name Set to print the name of the file. Reset Reset the print options. If your printer has the mass storage feature, you must first set the USB mode to Printer in the settings menu. • Some options are not supported by some printers.Camera settings menu You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. Camera settings menu ……………………………… 104104 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting or play mode. 2 Select a desired setup menu 3 Select a desired item 4 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. Camera settings menu You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 Quickview Display Adjust Display Save Power Save Date&Time Sound 1sec 3min 1min 3 Setup menu items MENU OK 2 Sound System Volume AF Sound Button Sound Medium On On Exit Change Exit Change105 Sound System Volume You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. (Off, Low, Medium*, High) AF Sound Sets the sound the camera makes in AF mode on or off. (Off, On*) Button Sound Sets the sound the camera makes when you press buttons on or off. (Off, On*) Display Language Select the language the camera shows on the display. Display Adjust Adjust the display brightness, auto brightness setting, or display color. Display Brightness: You can adjust the display brightness using the [S/T] to one of five brightness levels. Auto Brightness: Adjust the brightness of screen. Display Color: Depending on whether the user uses the screen or the viewfinder, the display color can be adjusted by using the [S/T/W/X]. Display Save Sets the display off time. (Off, 0.5min*, 1min, 3min, 5min, 10min) Quickview This allows setting the quick view (view immediately upon a shot) time. (Off, 1sec*, 3sec, 5sec, Hold) Camera settings menu * Default value * Default value106 Normal setup 1( 1 ) Format This formats the memory card (deleting all the files including protected files). (Yes, No*) Error can occur if using a card formatted by another brand of camera, memory card reader or computer. Please use the card after formatting it from the camera. Reset This resets the setup menu and shooting options. (The date, time, language, and video output value are kept.) (Yes, No*) File Name This sets the method of designating filename. Standard* : SAM_XXXX.JPG(sRGB)/_SAMXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB) Date : MMDDXXXX.JPG(sRGB)/_MDDXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB, Jan. ~ Sep.)/ _ADDXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB, indicating A for Oct, B for Nov, C for Dec) For example, the image taken by setting Jan 01 sRGB is saved in "0101xxxx.jpg". File Number This sets the method of designating file number. (Series*, Reset) • The folder name that has taken pictures for the first time becomes 100PHOTO and the filename will be SAM_0001 (when the color space is sRGB). • The filename number is increased by 1 in the range of SAM_0001~ SAM_9999. • File name numbers are increased by 1 from SAM_0001 to SAM_9999. • Folder numbers are increased by 1 from 100PHOTO to 999PHOTO. • The maximum number of files that can be saved in one folder is 9999. • File names are assigned according to DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) specifications. • If you change a file name (for example, on a computer), the camera will not be able to play the file. Folder Type This sets the type of folder. Standard* : XXXPHOTO Date : XXX_MMDD * Default value Camera settings menu107 Power Save This sets the power turned off automatically if not being used for a while. (0.5 min, 1min*, 3min, 5min, 10min, 30min) • The camera retains the power-off time setting even if you replace the battery. • Power Save may not work if the camera is connected to a computer, TV, or printer, playing a slide show or movie. Date & Time This sets the date and time. (Type, Date, Time Zone, Time, Imprint) • Only the date is shown on the lower right side of the picture in play. • When printing a picture, the date may not be printed appropriately from certain manufacturer or printer model. Camera settings menu * Default value Normal setup 2( 2 ) 108 Display Select Auto Select* : Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display : The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF : The screen will be shown only through EVF Video Out Select the video output signal appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or TV. NTSC* : US, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc. PAL (supporting only the BDGHI method) : Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Holland, Finland, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc. Anynet+ (HDMICEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote controller (p. 91). On* : You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. Off : You can NOT control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. HDMI Size The resolution on an HDTV can be changed when using an HDMI cable. (In case of NTSC method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 480p) (In case of PAL method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 576p) If the connected HDTV does not support the selected resolution, you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower. Firmware Update Displays the firmware version of the camera body and lens, and upgrades the firmware. Body Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the camera body. Lens Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the lens. • You can upgrade the firmware by downloading it from www.samsung.com. • You can not run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged the battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade or attach the adaptor to provide power (optional). • After upgrading the firmware, the user customized options are reset to the default value. (The date, time, language, and video output values are kept.) Camera settings menu * Default value Normal setup 3( 3 ) Display Select Auto Select* : Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display : The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF : The screen will be shown only through EVF Video Out Select the video output signal appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or TV. NTSC* : US, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc. PAL (supporting only the BDGHI method) : Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Holland, Finland, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc. Anynet+ (HDMICEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote controller (p. 91). On* : You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. Off : You can NOT control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. HDMI Size The resolution on an HDTV can be changed when using an HDMI cable. (In case of NTSC method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 480p) (In case of PAL method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 576p) If the connected HDTV does not support the selected resolution, you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower. Firmware Update Displays the firmware version of the camera body and lens, and upgrades the firmware. Body Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the camera body. Lens Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the lens. • You can download firmware upgrades from www.samsungimaging.co.kr or www.samsung.com. • You can not run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged the battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade or attach the adaptor to provide power (optional). • After upgrading the firmware, the user customized options are reset to the default value. (The date, time, language, and video output values are kept.)Appendixes Refer to error messages, specifications, and maintenance tips. Error messages ……………………………………… 110 Camera maintenance ………………………………… 111 Before contacting a service center …………………… 115 Camera specifications ………………………………… 118 Lens specifications …………………………………… 122 Accessories (optional items) ………………………… 123 Index …………………………………………………… 125110 Error message Suggested remedies Card Error Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. Remove your memory card, and then insert it again. Format your memory card. (p. 106) • • • Card Locked Unlock the memory card. DCF Full Error File names do not match the DCF standard. Transfer the files on the memory card to your computer and format the card. (p. 106) File Error Delete the damaged file or contact a service center. Low Battery Insert a charged battery or recharge the battery. Memory Full Delete unnecessary files or insert a new memory card. No Image File Take photos or insert a memory card that has some photos. Check the lens. Check whether dust or foreign substances between Lens contacts and Lens mount index. Remove either dust or foreign substances if dirt or foreign substances are appeared. Please be care for avoid getting dirt foreign substances inside the camera. Error 00 Turn off the camera, remove the lens, and then mount the lens again. Error 01/02 Turn off the camera, remove the battery, and then insert it again. Error messages When the following error messages appear, try these remedies.111 Cleaning your camera Camera lens and display Use a blower brush to remove dust and wipe the lens gently with a soft cloth. If any dust remains, apply lens cleaning liquid to a piece of lens cleaning paper and wipe gently. About dust in the image sensor Depending on the different shooting conditions, dust may appear in the photo images because the image sensor can be exposed to the external environment. This is not a problem of the product, and the exposure to dust can occur in everyday use of camera. When using the dust blower, do not insert the blower through the lens mount, the camera may malfunction. In that case, please contact to the service center. Camera body Wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. Camera maintenance Never use benzene, thinners, or alcohol to clean the device. These solutions can damage the camera or cause it to malfunction. •112 About memory cards Memory cards you can use You can use SD (Secure Digital) and SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity) memory cards. Terminal Label (front) Write-protect switch You can prevent files from being deleted by using the write-protect switch on the SD or SDHC card. Slide the switch down to lock or slide it up to unlock. Lock the card to prevent deletions. Unlock the card when shooting. Memory card capacity The memory capacity may vary depending on the scenes you shoot or the shooting conditions. These capacities are based on a 1GB SD card: Size Super Fine Fine Normal RAW RAW+SF RAW+F RAW+N Photos 14M (3:2) 142 278 408 35 28 31 32 10M (3:2) 197 382 724 - 32 34 36 6M (3:2) 322 615 1128 - 36 38 39 2M (3:2) 738 1334 2238 - 41 42 43 12M (16:9) 168 328 630 - 30 33 35 8M (16:9) 234 454 860 - 34 36 37 5M (16:9) 381 727 1334 - 38 39 40 2M (16:9) 872 1573 2638 - 42 43 43 Burst 1201 2092 3320 - - - - Size HQ Normal *Movies (30fps) 1280 (16:9) Approx. 15mins Approx. 22mins 640 (4:3) Approx. 44mins Approx. 66mins 320 (4:3) Approx. 145mins Approx. 210mins * The time available for recording may differ if you use the zoom. Several movies were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. Camera maintenance113 About the battery Use only Samsung-approved batteries. Battery specifications Mode BP1310 Type Lithium-ion battery Cell capacity 1300 mAh Voltage 7.4 V Charging time (When fully discharged) Approx. 150 min Battery life Shooting mode Number of photos Photos Approx. 200 min/Approx. 400 photos Videos Approx. 130 min The figures above are measured by Samsung’s standards and may differ depending on actual usage. The shooting time may change depending on the shooting environment and shot intervals. Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. • • • Camera maintenance114 Notes about charging the battery If the charging indicator light does not light, make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. If the indicator light blinks in red or does not illuminate, reconnect the adaptor cable, or remove the battery and insert it again. If you charge the battery when it is warm, the indicator light may turn orange. Charging will start when the battery cools down. When using the battery, please keep the following guidelines. Failure to follow these guidleline may cause excessive heat, fire, or explosion. If the battery is bulging or distorted, contact a Samsung service center. It may present a physical danger. It may present physical dangers. Use only the recommended battery charger. Do not place the product close to any high temperature source. Do not insert the product into a microwave. Do not place the product inside a car during the summer. Do not place the product in a hot, humid environment. Do not place the camera on a carpet, comforter, or electronic mattress for a long time. Do not leave the product turned on where there is little or no air circulation. Do not let accessories like necklaces, coins, keys, watches, etc., come in contact with the battery chamber. • • • - - - - - - - - - - - Use Advanced Lithium Batteries with a guarantee from the manufacturing company Do not disassemble the battery or perforate the battery with a pin. Do not subject the battery or camera to high pressure. Do not drop or strike the camera or battery, or subject either to rough handling or sudden shocks. Do not expose the battery or camera to temperatures over 60ºC (140ºF) degree. Do not expose the product to water or humidity. Battery shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like. Guidelines of disposal Follow the disposal instructions and properly dispose of the used battery. Do not dispose of the battery by throwing it in a fire. Disposal instructions may differ depending on your country or specifi c region. Follow the disposal instructions of your country, state, etc. Guideline of recharging the battery. Do not recharge the battery using a method that differs from the method detailed in this users manual. Failure to follow these instruction may cause a fire or explosion. - - - - - - - - - - - - Camera maintenance115 Before contacting a service center If you are having trouble with your camera, try these troubleshooting procedures before contacting a service center. If you have attempted the troubleshooting solution and are still having problems with your device, contact your local dealer or authorized Samsung service center. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot turn on the camera Make sure that the battery is inserted. Make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. Charge the battery. • • • The power turns off suddenly Charge the battery. Your camera may be in Power save mode. (p. 107) The power automatically turns off to preven the camera from malfunctoning in the case that the unit overheats. • • • The camera is losing battery power quickly The battery may lose power more quickly in low temperatures (below 0° C). Keep the battery warm by putting it into your pocket. Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Recharge if needed. The ability of a Lithium battery to hold a charge dimishes over time. If your battery looses its charge rapidly on a regular basis, purchase a new battery. • • • Cannot take photos There is no space on the memory card. Delete unnecessary files or insert a new card. Format the memory card. (p. 106) The memory card is defective. Get a new memory card. The memory card is locked. Unlock the card. (p. 112) Make sure that the camera is switched on. Charge the battery. Make sure that the batte ry is inserted correctly. When you use the AF Priority function, you cannot take a picture without adjusting the focus on the subject correctly. Disable the AF Priority function, or set the focus accurately. • • • • • • • • The camera freezes Remove the battery, and then insert it again. The flash does not work The flash option may be set to Off. (p. 55) You cannot use the flash in the mode, or some modes. • • The flash fires unexpectedly The flash may fire due to static electricity. This is not a malfunction of the camera.116 Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The date and time are incorrect Set the date and time in the Setting2 ( 2 ) menu. The display or buttons do not work Remove the battery, and then insert it again. The memory card has an error The memory card has not been reset. Format the card. (p. 106) Cannot play back files If you change the name of a file, your camera may not be able to play the file (the name of the file should meet the DCF standard). If you encounter this situation, play back files on your computer. The photo is blurry If the subject is out of focus, the photo may be blurry. Make a change to the shooting condition. If the camera is shaken while shooting, the photo may be blurry. Use a tripod to avoid camera shake. Make sure that the lens is clean. If not, clean the lens. (p. 111) • • • The colors in the photo do not match the actual scene An incorrect white balance can create unrealistic color. Select the proper white balance option to suit the light source. (p. 68) The photo is too bright Your photo is overexposed. Adjust the exposure value. (p. 66) Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. (p. 41) Turn off the flash. (p. 55) Adjust the ISO speed. (p. 59) • • • • The photo is too dark Your photo is underexposed. Adjust the exposure value. Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. Turn on the flash. Adjust the ISO speed. • • • • The photo is distorted The wide-angle lens may distort the image. This is a normal feature of the wide-angle lens.117 Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The TV does not display your photos Make sure that the camera is correctly connected to the TV with the A/V and HDMI cable. Make sure that your memory card contains photos. • • Your computer does not recognize your camera Make sure that the USB cable is connected correctly. Make sure that your camera is switched on. Make sure that you are using a supported operating system. • • • Your computer disconnects the camera while transferring files The fi le transmission may be interrupted by static electricity. Disconnect the USB cable, and then connect it again.118 Camera specifications Specification Image Sensor Type CMOS Sensor size 23.4×15.6mm Effective Pixel Approx. 14.6 Mega-pixels Total Pixel Approx. 15.1 Mega-pixels Color Filter RGB primary color filter Lens Mount Samsung NX Mount Usable Lens Samsung Lenses Image Stabilization Type Lens Shift (depends on Lens) Display Type LCD Size 3.0” Resolution QVGA (320x240). Approx. 230K dots Live view Field of view : Approx. 98% Viewfinder Type EVF Resolution QVGA Class (300X220). Approx. 201K dots equiv. Field of View Approx. 98% Magnification Approx. 0.83x (APS-C, 50mm, -1m-1) Eyepoint About 17 mm Diopter Adjustment Approx. -4.0 ~ +1.0m-1 Specification Focusing Type Contrast AF Focusing point Selection : 1point (Free selection) Multi : Normal 15points, Close Up 35points Face Detection : Max. 10faces Modes Single AF, Continuous AF, MF AF-assist lamp Yes (Green LED) Shutter Type Electronically controlled vertical-run focal plane shutter Speed Auto:1/4000sec. ~ 30sec. Manual:1/4000sec. ~ 30sec. (1/3EV or 1/2EV step) Bulb (Limit time : 8 min) Exposure Metering System TTL 247 (19x13) Block segment Metering : Multi, Centerweighted, Spot Metering range : EV0 ~ 18 (ISO100·30mm F2.0) Compensation ±3 EV (1/2EV, 1/3EV step) AE Lock AEL button ISO Equivalent Auto, 100, 200, 400, 800, 1600, 3200 (1EV step)119 Camera specifications Specification Drive Mode Modes Single, Continuous, Burst, Self-timer, Bracket (AE, WB, PW) Continuous JPEG : 3fps up to 10shots, Burst mode : 30fps, 30shots by 1 released RAW : 3fps up to 3shots Bracket Auto Exposure Bracket (±3EV), White Balance Bracket (±3step), Picture Wizard Bracket (Selectable 3modes) Self-timer 2-30sec. (1sec. step) Remote controller Wired : SR9NX01 (Optional) Specification Flash Type TTL Auto Pop-up flash Modes Smart Flash, Auto, Auto + Red-eye reduction, Fill-in, Fill-in + Red-eye reduction, 1 st Curtain, 2nd Curtain, OFF Guide Number 11 (at ISO 100) Angle of View Coverage 28mm wide-angle (Equivalent to 35mm) Sync. Speed Less than 1/180sec. Flash Compensation -2 - +2EV (0.5EV step) External Flash Samsung External Flash available (SEF42A, SEF20A) (optional) Synchro (Flash attachment) Hot Shoe White Balance Modes Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Fluorescent (W, N, D), Tungsten, Flash, Custom, K(Manual) Micro adjustment Each 7steps in Amber / Blue / Green / Magenta axis Picture Wizard Modes Standard, Vivid, Portrait, Landscape, Forest, Retro, Cool, Calm, Classic, Custom (1-3) Parameter Contrast, Sharpness, Saturation, Color tone120 Camera specifications Specification Shooting Modes Smart Auto, Program, Shutter Priority AE, Aperture Priority AE, Manual, Night, Portrait, Landscape, Scene, Movie Scene Mode Beauty shot, Children, Close Up, Text, Sunset, Dawn, Backlight, Fireworks, Beach & Snow Image Size JPEG (3:2): 14M (4592x3056), 10M (3872x2592), 6M (3008x2000), 2M (1920x1280), 1.4M (1472x976): Burst mode only JPEG (16:9): 12M (4592x2584), 8M (3872x2176), 5M (3008x1688), 2M (1920x1080) RAW: 14M (4592x3056) Quality Super fine , Fine, Normal RAW Format SRW Color Space sRGB, Adobe RGB Specification Movie Format MP4 (H.264) Compression Movie : H.264 , Sound : AAC Movie Clip With Audio or without Audio (user selectable, recording time : 25 minutes) Image size 1280x720 , 640x480 , 320x240 Frame rate 30fps Sound Mono Sound Movie Editing Still Image Capture, Time Trimming Image Play Type Single image, Thumbnails (3/9/20 images), Slide show, Movie Highlight Warning Available Editing Red eye fix, Back light comp., Photo Style Selector, Resize, Rotate, Face Retouch Photo Style Selector Soft, Vivid, Forest, Autumn, Misty, Gloomy, Classic121 Camera specifications Specification Storage Media External memory card(optional): SD card (up to 4GB guaranteed), SDHC card (up to 8GB guaranteed) File Format RAW (SRW), JPEG (EXIF 2.21), DCF, DPOF 1.1, PictBridge 1.0 Capacity (1GB) 14M : RAW 35 14M : Super Fine 142, Fine 278, Normal 408 10M : Super Fine 197, Fine 382, Normal 724 6M : Super Fine 322, Fine 615, Normal 1128 2M : Super Fine 738, Fine 1334, Normal 2238 Burst (1.4M) : Super Fine 1201, Fine 2092, Normal 3320 12M(W) : Super Fine 168, Fine 328, Normal 630 8M(W) : Super Fine 234, Fine 454, Normal 860 5M(W) : Super Fine 381, Fine 727, Normal 1334 2M(W) : Super Fine 872, Fine 1573, Normal 2638 Movie : 1280x720 : High Quality 15min., Normal 22min. 640x480 : High Quality 44min., Normal 66min. 320x240 : High Quality 145min., Normal 210min. ※ These figures are measured under the Samsung standard Specification Direct Printing PictBridge Interface Digital Output Connector USB 2.0 (HI-SPEED) Video output NTSC, PAL (user selectable) HDMI 1.3 : (1080i, 720P, 576P / 480P) External Release Yes DC power input connector DC 9.0V, 1.5A (100 ~ 240V) Power Source Type Rechargeable battery : BP1310 (1300mAh) Charger: BC1310 AC Adaptor : AD9NX01 (Optional) * Included battery may vary depending on sales region Physical Specification Dimensions (WxHxD) 123×87×39.8mm (excluding the projecting parts of the camera) Weight 345g (without batteries and card) Operating Temperature 0 ~ 40 °C Operating Humidity 5 ~ 85% Software Application Intelli-studio, Samsung RAW Converter * Specifications are subject to change without prior notice * All trademarks are the property of their respective owners122 The lens provided may differ by the model. Lens specifications Lens Name SAMSUNG 30mm F2 SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS SAMSUNG 50-200mm F4-5.6 ED OIS Focal Length 30mm (equivalent to 46.2mm in 35mm format) 18 - 55mm (equivalent to 27.7-84.7mm in 35mm format) 50 - 200mm (equivalent to 77-308mm in 35mm format) Elements in Groups 5 elements in 5 groups (1 Aspherical lens included) 12 elements in 9 groups (1 Aspherical lens included) 17 elements in 13 groups (2 Extra-low Dispersion lens included) Angle of View 50.2° 75.9°- 28.7° 31.4°- 8.0° Aperture F2 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) F3.5 - 5.6 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) F4 - 5.6 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) Mount Type Samsung NX Mount Samsung NX Mount Samsung NX Mount Optical Image Stabilizer No Yes Yes Minimum Focus Distance 0.25m ~ Ğ 0.28m ~ Ğ 0.98m ~ Ğ Maximum Magnification Approx. 0.16X Approx. 0.22X Approx. 0.2X Lens Hood Optional Included Included Filter Size 43mm 58mm 52mm Max. Diameter x Length 61.5 x 21.5mm 63 x 65.1mm 70 x 100.5mm Weight Approx. 85g (without hood) Approx. 198g (without hood) Approx. 417g (without hood) Operating Temperature 0 ~ 40°C 0 ~ 40°C 0 ~ 40°C Operating Humidity 5 ~ 85% 5 ~ 85% 5 ~ 85%123 Accessories (optional items) Lens Make better pictures with a 30mm, 18-55mm, or 50-200mm lens made exclusively for the Samsung NX-series camera. Memory card In this camera, the memory cards such as SD (Secure Digital) and SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity) may be used. A/V cable The camera can be connected to an external device by using an A/V cable. Shutter release This product minimizes the possible shaking of camera when taking pictures by using a tripod or taking pictures at a low shutter speed. Adaptor The power needed in the camera can be supplied by connecting to a power socket using this adaptor.124 Accessories(optional items) Strap Straps can be purchased separately. Camera bag Camera bag can be purchased separately. Filter Optional filters can be purchased and attached to the lens. Flash Optional flash(SEF20A or SEF42A) can be purchased for your various shooting experience. HDMI Cable You can view high-quality and uncompressed photos or videos on an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) using the optional HDMI cable. Battery pack Battery pack can be purchased separately. The image of components or optional parts can differ from that of actual products. Please refer to the user's manual of the optional items.125 Index A Adjusting exposure 5 Automatic focus 34 Aperture priority mode 41 Aperture value 41 AF Priority 60 AF assist light 61 AE BKT 73 AEL function 77 AF Sound 105 Anynet+ 108 Appendixes 109 Accessories (optional items) 123 B Background 7 Bulb exposure 44 Bracket setup 74 Backlight adjustment 88 Button sound 105 Battery 18, 115 C Composition 7 Close-up 39 Continuous AF 60 Center-weighted metering 67 Color temperature 70 Color space 71 Changing the shooting method 73 Continuous shooting 73 Camera maintenance 111 Camera specifications 118 D Direction keys 5 Diopter adjustment dial 16 Display type 28 Depth of field 37 Depth Preview 37 Deleting a file 82 Display 105 Display Select 108 Date&Time 107 E Eye sensor 15 Eye-cup 16 EV button 43 External flash 58 Error message 110 F Fn 27 Flash popup button 55 Focusing methods 60 Face detection 64 File protection 82 Face retouching 88 Format 106 File name 106 File number 106 Folder type 106 Firmware update 108 H Half-shutter 32 HDTV 92 HDMI Size 108 I ISO sensitivity 59 Icons 25 Image stabilization 32 Index printing 90 Intelli-studio 97 J JPEG 101 K Key mapping 77 L Lens 17 Landscape mode 45 Language 105 Lens specifications 122 M Mounting/dismounting the lens 21 Manual focus 33 Manual mode 43 Multi AF 61 MF Assist 63 Multi-metering 67126 Mac users 96 Memory card 112 N Night mode 45 Noise reduction 53 O Option/menu selection method 26 OIS 35 P Program mode 40 Portrait mode 45 P Wiz BKT 73 Picture wizard 75 Playback 79 Picture editing 87 Picture style 88 Print info 89 Photo printer 102 PictBridge 102 Power save 107 Q Quality 52 Quickview 105 R Recording a movie 48 Resolution 51 Red-eye reduction 56 Rotating 87 Red-eye fix 88 Regular TV 91 RAW 101 Reset 106 S Shooting mode 5 Subject 7 Status lamp 16 Strap 22 Sound 29 Screen display 30 Smart Auto mode 39 Shutter Priority mode 42 Shutter speed 42 Scene mode 46 Setting the flash option 55 Single AF 60 Selection AF 61 Self-portrait face detection 65 Spot metering 67 Smart range 72 Shooting method 73 Smart album 81 Slide show 84 Samsung Raw Converter 99 System volume 105 T Title and role of each part 14 Turning on the power 23 Tips 32 Timer 54 Thumbnail view 81 U Unpacking 13 Using the dial 26 User display 29 V View a movie 85 Video Out 108 W Wind Cut 49 White balance 68 Windows users 93 WB BKT 73 Z Zoom 34 1st Curtain 58 2nd Curtain 58 IndexCorrect Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment) (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take these items for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. Correct disposal of batteries in this product (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate battery return systems) This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to human health or the environment. To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through your local, free battery return system. This Class [B] digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Planet First Planet First represents Samsung Electronics' commitment to the sustainable development and social responsibility through eco-driven business and management activities.Please refer to the warranty that came with your product or visit our website http://www.samsungimaging.com for after-sales service or inquiries. I9105P www.samsung.com Consultez le mode d’emploi complet de votre appareil pour obtenir davantage d’informations. Pour savoir comment accéder au mode d’emploi, reportez-vous à la section « Afficher le mode d’emploi » du présent Guide de prise en main rapide. Guide de prise en main rapide2 www.sar-tick.com Ce produit est conforme aux limites nationales DAS (Débit d’Absorption Spécifique) fixées à une valeur maximale de 2,0 W/kg. Les valeurs DAS maximales sont indiquées à la section Informations sur la certification DAS de ce Guide de prise en main rapide. Lorsque vous transportez ce produit ou lorsque vous l’utilisez près du corps, portez-le à une distance d’au moins 1,5 cm de votre corps afin de respecter les exigences en matière de radiofréquences. Cet appareil vous permet de communiquer et d’accéder à des divertissements de haute qualité, basés sur les critères de qualité et la technologie de Samsung. • Le contenu de ce guide de prise en main rapide peut différer par rapport au produit ou à votre version logicielle, et faire l’objet de modifications sans préavis. • Les éléments fournis avec l’appareil et les accessoires disponibles peuvent varier en fonction de votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur.3 • Les accessoires fournis ont été spécifiquement conçus pour cet appareil et peuvent ne pas fonctionner avec d’autres appareils. • Vous pouvez acheter d’autres accessoires auprès de votre revendeur Samsung. Avant tout achat, assurez-vous qu’ils sont compatibles avec votre appareil. • Certains accessoires, autres que ceux fournis, peuvent ne pas être compatibles avec votre appareil. • Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des problèmes de performance ou des incompatibilités découlant de la modification des paramètres de registre par l’utilisateur. Toute tentative de personnalisation du système d’exploitation peut entraîner des problèmes de fonctionnement de votre appareil ou de ses applications.4 Icônes Avertissement : situations susceptibles de vous blesser ou de blesser autrui. Attention : situations susceptibles d’endommager votre appareil ou d’autres équipements. Remarque : remarques, conseils d’utilisation ou informations complémentaires. Droits d’auteur Copyright © 2013 Samsung Electronics Ce mode d’emploi est protégé par les lois internationales sur les droits d’auteur. Il est interdit de reproduire, distribuer, traduire ou transmettre sous quelque forme et par quelque moyen que ce soit, électronique ou mécanique, notamment par photocopie, enregistrement ou stockage dans un système de stockage et de recherche documentaire, tout ou partie de ce document, sans le consentement préalable écrit de Samsung Electronics.5 Marques • SAMSUNG et le logo SAMSUNG sont des marques déposées de Samsung Electronics. • Les logos Android, Google ™, Google Maps ™, Google Mail ™, YouTube ™, Google Play ™ Store et Google Talk ™ sont des marques de Google, Inc. • Bluetooth® est une marque déposée de Bluetooth SIG, Inc. • Wi-Fi ®, Wi-Fi Protected Setup ™, Wi-Fi Direct ™, Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ et le logo Wi-Fi sont des marques déposées de Wi-Fi Alliance. Votre appareil utilise une fréquence non harmonisée. Il est conçu pour fonctionner dans tous les pays européens. Au sein de l’Union Européenne, le réseau Wi-Fi peut fonctionner sans restriction en intérieur, mais pas en extérieur. • Toutes les autres marques et droits d’auteur demeurent la propriété de leurs propriétaires respectifs.6 Démarrage Présentation de l’appareil Touche Retour Microphone Capteur de proximité/ luminosité Connecteur à fonctions multiples Microphone pour haut-parleur Touche Menu Écouteur Écran tactile Touche Accueil Touche de volume Objectif avant7 Démarrage Prise audio 3,5 mm Objectif arrière Haut-parleur Antenne GPS Flash Touche Marche/Arrêt Antenne principale Cache arrière Ne couvrez pas la zone autour de l’antenne avec vos mains ou tout autre objet. Cela pourrait entraîner des problèmes de connectivité ou décharger la batterie.8 Démarrage Touches Touche Fonction Marche/ Arrêt • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour allumer ou éteindre l’appareil. • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pendant 8 à 10 secondes pour réinitialiser l’appareil en cas d’erreur fatale, ou s’il ne répond plus ou mal. • Appuyer sur cette touche pour verrouiller ou déverrouiller l’appareil. Lorsque l’écran s’éteint, l’appareil passe en mode Verrouillage. Menu • Appuyer sur cette touche pour ouvrir la liste des options disponibles dans l’écran actuel. • Depuis l’écran d’accueil, maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour lancer l’application de recherche Google. Accueil • Appuyer sur cette touche pour revenir à l’écran d’accueil. • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour ouvrir la liste des applications récentes. Retour • Appuyer sur cette touche pour revenir à l’écran précédent.9 Démarrage Touche Fonction Volume • Appuyer sur cette touche pour régler le volume de l’appareil. Installer la carte SIM ou USIM et la batterie Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM fournie par votre opérateur, ainsi que la batterie. 1 Retirez le cache arrière. Veillez à ne pas abîmer vos ongles en retirant le cache arrière.10 Démarrage 2 Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM, puce orientée vers le bas. Le compartiment pour carte SIM de votre appareil ne convient qu’aux cartes SIM. Insérer une carte microSIM avec un support inadapté peut endommager le compartiment pour carte SIM de votre appareil. 3 Insérez la batterie. 2 111 Démarrage 4 Remettez le cache arrière en place. 1 2 Charger la batterie Vous devez charger la batterie avant d’utiliser l’appareil pour la première fois lorsque vous ne l’avez pas utilisé depuis un certain temps. Utilisez uniquement des chargeurs, des batteries et des câbles de connexion PC homologués par Samsung. L’utilisation de chargeurs ou de câbles non homologués peut provoquer l’éclatement de la batterie ou endommager l’appareil.12 Démarrage Branchez la fiche micro-USB du chargeur sur le connecteur à fonctions multiples de l’appareil et l’autre extrémité sur une prise de courant. Un branchement incorrect du chargeur peut sérieusement endommager l’appareil. Les dégâts résultant d’une mauvaise utilisation ne sont pas couverts par la garantie. Lorsque la batterie est complètement chargée, déconnectez l'appareil du chargeur. Pour ce faire, débranchez d’abord le chargeur de l’appareil, puis de la prise de courant. Ne retirez jamais la batterie avant d’avoir débranché le chargeur. Ceci pourrait endommager l’appareil. Pour économiser l’énergie, débranchez le chargeur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. Le chargeur n’étant pas muni d’un bouton Marche/Arrêt, vous devez le débrancher de la prise de courant pour couper l’alimentation. L’appareil doit rester à proximité de la prise en cours de chargement.13 Démarrage Vérifier la charge de la batterie Lorsque vous chargez la batterie et que l’appareil est éteint, les icônes suivantes indiquent l’état du chargement : Chargement en cours Chargement terminé Allumer et éteindre l’appareil Si vous allumez l’appareil pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à sa configuration. Pour allumer et éteindre l’appareil, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée pendant quelques secondes.14 Fonctions de base Notifications Des icônes de notification peuvent apparaître dans le volet des raccourcis afin de vous signaler les appels manqués, les nouveaux messages, les événements à venir, le statut de l’appareil, et plus encore. Ouvrez le volet des raccourcis, puis affichez le statut de l'appareil, ainsi que les options disponibles. Pour ouvrir le volet des raccourcis, faites glisser la barre d’état de haut en bas. Pour fermer le volet des raccourcis, faites glisser la barre d’état de bas en haut. La disponibilité des options dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.15 Fonctions de base Passer un appel ou y répondre Découvrez comment utiliser les fonctions d’appel de votre appareil : passer un appel, répondre à un appel, utiliser les options disponibles en cours d’appel ou personnaliser les autres fonctions. Passer un appel Composez le numéro à l’aide du clavier, puis appuyez sur . Répondre à un appel Lorsque vous recevez un appel, faites glisser votre doigt sur l’icône . Gérer les contacts Pour tous vos contacts, vous pouvez enregistrer des numéros de téléphone, des adresses e-mail, et plus encore. Vous pouvez créer des groupes de contacts et également envoyer leurs coordonnées à d’autres personnes ou les partager.16 Fonctions de base Envoyer des messages Vous pouvez envoyer des messages texte (SMS) ou multimédia (MMS). L’envoi ou la réception de messages en dehors de la zone couverte par votre opérateur peut occasionner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre à laquelle vous avez souscrite. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. Utiliser les applications La liste des applications affiche les icônes de toutes vos applications, y compris celles récemment installées. Pour ouvrir une application, ouvrez la liste des applications et appuyez sur l’icône correspondante. Appuyez sur pour fermer les applications.17 Fonctions de base Accéder à Internet Connectez-vous à Internet à l’aide de la fonction Wi-Fi ou de votre connexion de données. Ouvrez l’application Internet et naviguez sur les pages Web. L’accès au Web et le téléchargement de contenu multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre souscrite auprès de votre opérateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. Utiliser la fonction NFC Votre appareil est équipé d’une fonction qui permet de lire les tags NFC (Near Field Communication) contenant des informations relatives aux produits. Grâce à cette fonction, vous pouvez également effectuer des paiements et acheter des tickets de transport ou de spectacle après avoir téléchargé les applications correspondantes. La batterie comporte une antenne NFC intégrée. Manipulez-la avec précaution afin de ne pas endommager l’antenne NFC.18 Fonctions de base Afficher le mode d’emploi Le mode d’emploi vous fournit des informations complètes sur le fonctionnement de votre appareil. L’accès au Web et le téléchargement de contenu multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre souscrite auprès de votre opérateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. À partir de votre appareil 1 Ouvrez l’application Internet. 2 Appuyez sur pour ouvrir la liste des favoris. 3 Sélectionnez le favori correspondant au mode d’emploi. Pour accéder plus facilement au mode d’emploi, placez un raccourci vers le mode d’emploi sur l’écran d’accueil. Selon votre navigateur ou votre opérateur, le mode d’emploi peut ne pas être disponible dans les favoris. À partir de l’ordinateur Accédez au site www.samsung.com, puis recherchez le mode d’emploi à l’aide du nom de modèle de votre appareil.19 Consignes de sécurité Ces consignes de sécurité concernent l’ensemble des appareils mobiles. Il est possible qu’elles ne soient pas toutes applicables à votre appareil. Avant d’utiliser cet appareil, lisez les consignes de sécurité afin d’éviter de vous blesser ou de blesser autrui, ou d’endommager l’appareil. Avertissement: évitez les décharges électriques, le feu et les explosions N’utilisez pas de prises et de cordons d’alimentation endommagé(e)s ou de prises électriques mal fixées Ne touchez pas le cordon d’alimentation avec les mains mouillées ou ne déconnectez pas le chargeur en tirant sur le cordon Ne tordez pas ou n’endommagez pas le cordon d’alimentation N’utilisez pas votre appareil avec les mains mouillées ou lorsque celui-ci est en cours de chargement Ne provoquez pas de court-circuit avec le chargeur ou l’appareil Ne laissez pas tomber le chargeur ou l’appareil et ne les exposez pas aux chocs Ne rechargez pas la batterie avec un chargeur non approuvé par le fabricant N’utilisez pas votre appareil pendant un orage L’appareil peut mal fonctionner et les risques de décharge électrique peuvent augmenter. Ne manipulez pas la batterie Lithium Ion (Li-Ion) lorsque celle-ci coule ou est endommagée Pour une mise au rebut en toute sécurité de la batterie Li-Ion, contactez le centre de service après-vente le plus proche de chez vous.20 Consignes de sécurité Manipulez et jetez l’appareil et le chargeur avec précaution • Utilisez exclusivement une batterie et un chargeur homologués par Samsung et spécialement conçus pour votre appareil. L’utilisation d’une batterie et d’un chargeur incompatibles peut provoquer des blessures graves ou endommager votre appareil. • Ne jetez jamais la batterie ou l’appareil au feu. Respectez la réglementation en vigueur dans votre pays concernant la mise au rebut des batteries ou des appareils usagés. • Ne posez jamais la batterie ou l’appareil à l’intérieur ou au-dessus d’appareils chauffants, tels que des fours à micro-ondes, des cuisinières ou des radiateurs. En cas de surchauffe, ils pourraient exploser. • N’écrasez ou ne perforez jamais l’appareil. Évitez d’exposer l’appareil à une pression externe élevée qui risquerait d’entraîner un court-circuit interne et une surchauffe. Protégez l’appareil, la batterie et le chargeur de tout dommage • Évitez d’exposer l’appareil et la batterie à des températures très basses ou très élevées. • Ne soumettez pas l’appareil à des températures extrêmes, car cela pourrait l’endommager, ou réduire la capacité de chargement et la durée de vie de l’appareil et de la batterie. • Évitez que la batterie entrent en contact avec des objets métalliques, car cela risquerait de provoquer un court-circuit entre les bornes + et – de la batterie et de l’endommager de manière temporaire ou permanente. • N’utilisez jamais une batterie ou un chargeur endommagé(e). Attention: respectez tous les avertissements de sécurité et les réglementations en vigueur lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil dans un endroit où son utilisation est réglementée N’utilisez pas votre appareil à proximité d’autres appareils électroniques La plupart des appareils électroniques utilisent des signaux de radiofréquence. Il est possible que votre appareil cause des interférences avec d’autres appareils électroniques.21 Consignes de sécurité N’utilisez pas votre appareil à proximité d’un stimulateur cardiaque • Maintenez une distance minimale de 15 cm entre votre appareil et un stimulateur cardiaque pour éviter toute interférence. • Pour minimiser les risques d’interférence avec un stimulateur cardiaque, utilisez l’appareil sur le côté opposé à l’implant. N’utilisez pas votre appareil dans un hôpital ou à proximité d’équipements médicaux en raison des interférences qu’il pourrait produire Si vous utilisez un équipement médical, contactez son fabricant avant d’utiliser votre appareil afin de vous assurer que votre équipement ne sera pas affecté par les radiofréquences émises par l’appareil. Si vous utilisez une prothèse auditive, contactez votre fabriquant afin d’obtenir plus d’informations sur les interférences Les radiofréquences émises par votre appareil peuvent causer des interférences avec certaines prothèses auditives. Avant d’utiliser votre appareil, contactez le fabricant de la prothèse afin de vous assurer que son fonctionnement ne sera pas altéré par les radiofréquences émises par l’appareil. Éteignez l’appareil dans les lieux présentant des risques d’explosion • Éteignez l’appareil dans les lieux présentant des risques d’explosion. • Respectez toujours les consignes, les instructions et la signalétique d’utilisation dans un environnement explosif. • N’utilisez pas votre appareil dans des zones de ravitaillement en carburant (station-service), à proximité d’usines chimiques ou dans des zones de dynamitage. • Ne transportez et ne stockez jamais de liquides inflammables, de gaz ou de matériaux explosifs dans le même habitacle que l’appareil, ses composants ou ses accessoires. Éteignez votre appareil lorsque vous vous trouvez dans un avion Votre appareil peut provoquer des interférences avec les instruments de navigation électroniques.22 Consignes de sécurité Votre appareil peut provoquer des interférences avec les équipement automobiles Les équipements électroniques à bord de votre véhicule peuvent présenter des dysfonctionnements en raison des interférences radio émises par votre appareil. Contactez le constructeur pour obtenir plus d’informations. Respectez toutes les consignes de sécurité et réglementations relatives à l’utilisation de votre appareil lorsque vous vous trouvez au volant d’un véhicule Votre responsabilité principale est avant tout de conduire votre véhicule sans prendre de risques. N’utilisez jamais votre appareil au volant, si cela est interdit par la loi. Pour votre propre sécurité et celle d’autrui, faites preuve de bon sens et gardez à l’esprit les conseils suivants : • Apprenez à connaître les fonctions pratiques de votre appareil, comme par exemple la numérotation rapide et la fonction de rappel automatique. Ces fonctions vous permettent de gagner du temps et de rester concentré lorsque vous passez ou recevez des appels sur votre appareil. • Gardez votre appareil à portée de main. Assurez-vous de pouvoir atteindre votre appareil mobile sans quitter la route des yeux. Si vous recevez un appel entrant à un moment inopportun, laissez votre messagerie vocale répondre à votre place. • Interrompez tout appel en cas d’embouteillages ou de conditions météorologiques dangereuses. La pluie, la neige, le verglas et une circulation dense sont des facteurs dangereux. • Ne prenez pas de notes ou ne recherchez pas de numéros de téléphone. Noter une liste de tâches à effectuer ou parcourir votre répertoire détourne votre attention de votre responsabilité principale qui consiste à conduire sans prendre de risques. • Composez des numéros de manière raisonnable et évaluez l’état de la circulation. Passez vos appels lorsque vous êtes immobilisé ou avant de vous insérer dans la circulation. Essayez de passer vos appels de préférence lorsque votre véhicule est stationné.23 Consignes de sécurité • Ne poursuivez pas de conversations stressantes ou émotionnelles qui pourraient vous distraire. Informez vos interlocuteurs que vous êtes au volant et interrompez toute conversation susceptible d’altérer votre attention sur la route. • Utilisez votre appareil pour demander de l’aide. En cas d’incendie, d’accident de la route ou d’urgence médicale, composez le numéro d’urgence local. • Utilisez votre appareil pour aider d’autres personnes en situation d’urgence. Si vous êtes témoin d’un accident, d’une agression ou de toute autre situation d’urgence mettant des vies en jeu, contactez les services d’urgence locaux. • Appelez un service d’assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d’assistance, si cela s’avère nécessaire. Si vous croisez un véhicule endommagé ne présentant pas de danger immédiat, si vous constatez un feu rouge cassé, un accident de la route sans gravité où personne ne semble blessé ou encore un véhicule que vous savez volé, appelez un service d’assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d’assistance autre que les services d’urgence. Pour entretenir et bien utiliser votre appareil Conservez votre appareil au sec • L’humidité et les liquides peuvent endommager les pièces ou les circuits électroniques de votre appareil. • N’allumez pas votre appareil s’il présente des marques d’humidité. Si votre appareil est déjà allumé, éteignez-le, puis retirez immédiatement la batterie (si vous n’arrivez pas à l’éteindre ou à retirer la batterie, laissez votre appareil tel quel). Essuyez-le ensuite à l’aide d’une serviette et confiez-le à un centre de service après-vente Samsung. • Les liquides modifient la couleur de l’étiquette indiquant que l’intérieur de l’appareil a été endommagé. L’eau peut endommager votre appareil et entraîner l’annulation de la garantie du fabricant.24 Consignes de sécurité Cet appareil ne doit pas être utilisé ou stocké dans des zones où la concentration de poussières ou de microparticules en suspension dans l’atmosphère est élevée La poussière ou les microparticules peuvent provoquer des dysfonctionnements de l’appareil et entraîner des incendies ou des chocs électriques. Posez toujours votre appareil sur des surfaces planes Si votre appareil tombe, il peut être endommagé. N’entreposez pas votre appareil dans des endroits extrêmement chauds ou froids. Il est recommandé d’utiliser cet appareil à des températures comprises entre 5 °C et 35 °C • Votre appareil peut exploser si vous le laissez dans un véhicule fermé, la température intérieure pouvant monter jusqu’à 80 °C. • N’exposez pas votre appareil à la lumière directe du soleil de manière prolongée (comme par exemple sur le tableau de bord d’une voiture). • Conservez la batterie à des températures comprises entre 0 °C et 45 °C. N’entreposez pas votre appareil à proximité d’objets métalliques, comme par exemple des pièces, des clés ou des colliers • Votre appareil pourrait être rayé ou subir des dysfonctionnements. • Les bornes de la batterie peuvent causer des incendies si elles sont mises en contact avec des objets métalliques. Ne conservez pas votre appareil à proximité de champs magnétiques • Lorsqu’il est exposé à des champs magnétiques, votre appareil peut subir des dysfonctionnements ou la batterie peut se décharger. • Les cartes à piste, comme par exemple les cartes de crédit, les cartes de téléphone et les cartes d’embarquement peuvent être endommagées par les champs magnétiques. • N’utilisez pas de housses ou d’accessoires équipés de fermetures aimantées et évitez toute exposition prolongée de votre appareil à des champs magnétiques.25 Consignes de sécurité Ne conservez pas votre appareil à proximité ou à l’intérieur de radiateurs, de fours à micro-ondes, d’équipements de cuisine chauffants ou de conteneurs à haute pression • La batterie peut couler. • Votre appareil peut surchauffer et causer un incendie. Ne laissez pas tomber votre appareil et ne l’exposez pas aux chocs • L’écran de votre appareil pourrait être endommagé. • Votre appareil peut être endommagé ou certaines pièces peuvent subir des dysfonctionnements si vous le tordez ou le déformez. En cas de surchauffe de l’appareil, n’utilisez pas ce dernier ainsi que ses applications pendant quelques temps Un contact prolongé de votre peau avec un appareil en surchauffe peut entraîner des symptômes de brûlure faible, tels que des points rouges et de pigmentation. Si l’appareil photo de votre appareil est équipé d’un flash, ne l’utilisez pas à proximité des yeux des personnes ou des animaux Utiliser un flash à proximité des yeux peut causer des lésions oculaires ou une perte temporaire de la vue. Prenez des précautions lorsque vous êtes exposé aux lumières artificielles • Lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil, ne laissez pas la pièce dans laquelle vous vous trouvez dans l’obscurité et ne rapprochez pas trop l’écran de vos yeux. • L’exposition à la luminosité de l’écran lors du visionnage prolongé de vidéos ou de jeux peut entraîner des malaises. En cas de sensations d’inconfort, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil.26 Consignes de sécurité Réduisez les risques de lésions musculaires dus aux mouvements répétitifs Lorsque vous effectuez des actions répétitives, comme taper sur les touches, dessiner des caractères sur un écran tactile ou jouer à des jeux, vous pouvez ressentir une sensation d’inconfort au niveau des mains, de la nuque, des épaules ou de toute autre partie du corps. Si vous utilisez votre appareil sur des périodes prolongées, tenez-le sans trop le serrer, appuyez doucement sur les touches et faites des pauses fréquentes. En cas de sensations d’inconfort, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil et consultez un médecin. Préservez la durée de vie de la batterie et du chargeur • Évitez de laisser l’appareil en charge pendant plus d’une semaine, car une surcharge pourrait réduire la durée de vie de la batterie. • Lorsqu’il n’est pas utilisé pendant une durée prolongée, votre appareil se décharge progressivement et devra être rechargé avant toute utilisation. • Débranchez le chargeur de la prise secteur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. • Utilisez uniquement la batterie dans le cadre de l’utilisation prévue. Utilisez des batteries, des chargeurs, des accessoires et des fournitures homologués • L’utilisation d’une batterie ou d’un chargeur générique peut réduire la durée de vie de votre appareil ou provoquer des dysfonctionnements. • Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la sécurité de l’utilisateur si celui-ci utilise des accessoires ou des éléments non homologués par Samsung. Ne mordez et ne portez pas à votre bouche l’appareil ou la batterie • Vous pourriez endommager l’appareil ou provoquer une explosion. • Assurez-vous que les enfants manipulent l’appareil de façon appropriée s’ils doivent l’utiliser. Ne mettez pas votre appareil ou ses accessoires dans vos yeux, vos oreilles ou votre bouche Vous pourriez vous étouffer ou vous blesser gravement.27 Consignes de sécurité Lorsque vous utilisez l’appareil : • Tenez l’appareil droit, comme vous le feriez avec un téléphone traditionnel. • Parlez directement dans le microphone. • Ne touchez pas l’antenne interne de l’appareil. Cela pourrait entraîner une dégradation de la qualité de l’appel ou provoquer l’émission de niveaux de radiofréquences (RF) inattendus. Protégez votre oreille lorsque vous utilisez un casque ou des écouteurs • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé peut endommager votre audition. • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé lorsque vous êtes au volant peut détourner votre attention et provoquer un accident. • Diminuez toujours le volume avant de connecter des écouteurs à une source audio et réglez le volume minimum nécessaire vous permettant d’entendre votre conversation ou la musique. • Dans les environnements secs, les casques et écouteurs sont propices à la formation d’électricité statique. Évitez alors d’utiliser votre casque ou vos écouteurs et touchez un objet métallique pour vous décharger de toute électricité statique avant de brancher le casque/les écouteurs sur l’appareil. Restez prudent lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil en marchant ou en bougeant • Restez toujours conscient de votre environnement afin d’éviter de vous blesser ou de blesser d’autres personnes. • Assurez-vous de ne pas accrocher le cordon du casque avec vos bras ou avec des objets à proximité.28 Consignes de sécurité Ne placez pas votre appareil dans vos poches arrières ou à votre ceinture Vous pourriez vous blesser ou endommager votre appareil en cas de chute. Ne démontez pas, ne modifiez pas ou ne réparez pas vous-même votre appareil • Toute modification ou tout changement effectué(e) sur votre appareil peut entraîner l’annulation de la garantie du fabricant. Si votre appareil doit être réparé, confiez-le à un service après-vente Samsung. • Ne démontez pas ou ne perforez pas la batterie, car ceci peut causer une explosion ou un incendie. Ne peignez jamais votre appareil et n’y apposez jamais d’autocollants La peinture et les autocollants risquent de bloquer les pièces mobiles de l’appareil et perturber son fonctionnement. Si vous êtes allergique à la peinture ou aux pièces métalliques de l’appareil, vous pouvez souffrir de démangeaisons, d’eczéma ou de toute autre réaction cutanée. Si ces symptômes apparaissent, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil et consultez un médecin. Pour nettoyer votre appareil: • Essuyez votre appareil ou le chargeur avec un chiffon ou une gomme. • Nettoyez les bornes de la batterie avec un morceau de coton ou un chiffon. • N’utilisez pas de produits chimiques ou de détergents. N’utilisez pas l’appareil si son écran est fissuré ou cassé Le verre ou l’acrylique brisé risque de vous blesser à la main ou au visage. Confiez votre appareil à un service après-vente Samsung afin de le faire réparer. Utilisez votre appareil uniquement pour vous servir des fonctions auxquelles il est destiné Évitez de déranger votre entourage lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil dans un lieu public Ne laissez pas les enfants utiliser votre appareil Cet appareil n’est pas un jouet. Ne laissez pas les enfants jouer avec, car ils pourraient se blesser ou blesser autrui, et endommager l’appareil.29 Consignes de sécurité Installez l’appareil et ses accessoires avec précaution • Veillez à la bonne fixation de votre appareil mobile et de ses accessoires dans votre véhicule. • Évitez de placer votre appareil ou ses accessoires à proximité de la zone de déploiement des airbags. Si l’équipement mobile n’est pas installé correctement, le déclenchement de l’airbag risque de provoquer des blessures graves. Toute réparation doit être réalisée par un technicien agréé Le recours aux services d’un technicien non agréé risque d’entraîner des dégâts sur l’appareil et d’annuler la garantie du fabricant. Manipulez les cartes SIM et les cartes mémoire avec soin • Ne retirez pas une carte lorsque l’appareil y enregistre ou y lit des informations, car vous risqueriez de perdre des données et/ou d’endommager la carte ou l’appareil lui-même. • Protégez les cartes contre les chocs violents, les décharges électrostatiques et les interférences émises par d’autres appareils. • Ne touchez pas les contacts dorés de la carte avec vos doigts ou avec des objets métalliques. Si la carte est sale, nettoyez-la avec un chiffon doux. Assurez l’accès aux services d’urgence Dans certaines zones ou dans certaines circonstances, il peut être impossible de joindre les numéros d’urgence avec votre appareil. Avant de vous rendre dans des régions isolées ou non couvertes, prévoyez un autre moyen pour contacter les services d’urgence. Protégez vos données importantes • Lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil, assurez-vous de sauvegarder vos données importantes. Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la perte de données. • Lors de la mise au rebut de votre appareil, sauvegardez l’ensemble de vos données, puis réinitialisez votre appareil afin d’éviter tout usage abusif de vos données personnelles. • Veuillez lire attentivement les données d’autorisation lors du téléchargement d’applications. Soyez particulièrement vigilant lors de l’utilisation d’applications ayant accès à de nombreuses fonctions ou à un volume important de données personnelles.30 Consignes de sécurité • Vérifiez régulièrement vos comptes afin de détecter toute utilisation non autorisée ou suspecte. Si vous identifiez des signes indiquant un usage abusif de vos informations personnelles, contactez votre opérateur pour supprimer ou modifier les informations relatives à votre compte. • Si vous avez perdu votre appareil ou s’il vous a été volé, modifiez les mots de passe de vos comptes afin de protéger vos informations personnelles. • Évitez d’utiliser des applications provenant de sources inconnues et verrouillez votre appareil à l’aide d’un modèle, d’un mot de passe ou d’un code PIN. Ne transmettez pas d’éléments protégés par des droits d’auteur Ne transmettez pas d’éléments protégés par des droits d’auteur sans la permission des détenteurs de ces droits. Dans le cas contraire, vous seriez en infraction avec la législation sur les droits d’auteur. Le fabricant n’est en aucun cas responsable de l’utilisation frauduleuse des éléments protégés par les droits d’auteur. Informations sur la certification DAS CET APPAREIL MOBILE EST CONFORME AUX DIRECTIVES INTERNATIONALES SUR L’EXPOSITION AUX RADIOFRÉQUENCES Cet appareil mobile est un émetteur-récepteur radio. Il a été conçu pour ne pas dépasser les limites d’exposition aux radiofréquences (RF) recommandées par les directives internationales et en vigueur en France. Ces directives, développées par un organisme scientifique indépendant (ICNIRP), tiennent compte d’une marge importante de sécurité permettant d’assurer la sécurité des personnes, quels que soient leur âge et leur état de santé. La valeur utilisée dans le cadre de ces directives est le DAS, ou débit d’absorption spécifique. Pour les appareils mobiles, la valeur DAS maximale autorisée est de 2,0 watts par kilogramme (W/Kg). Le DAS est mesuré en utilisant l’appareil mobile dans des conditions de fonctionnement standard et en balayant l’ensemble des fréquences. Valeurs DAS maximales pour ce modèle, conformément aux directives ICNIRP :31 Consignes de sécurité Valeurs DAS maximales pour ce modèle DAS au niveau de la tête 0,327 W/Kg DAS au niveau du corps 0,326 W/Kg Lorsque l’appareil est en fonctionnement, le niveau de DAS réel de cet appareil est généralement beaucoup plus faible que les valeurs indiquées ci-dessus. En effet, pour des raisons d’efficacité du système et pour réduire les interférences au niveau du réseau, la puissance utile de votre appareil mobile est automatiquement réduite lorsque la transmission du signal ne nécessite pas une pleine puissance. Des essais DAS ont été réalisés avec ce produit porté à une distance de 1,5 cm du corps. Afin de respecter les exigences en matière d’exposition aux radiofréquences, cet appareil doit être positionné à une distance de 1,5 cm du corps. Cependant, quelques dispositions simples peuvent contribuer à diminuer le niveau d’exposition aux radiofréquences. Ainsi, afin de réduire au maximum la puissance d’émission de votre appareil mobile, veillez à l’utiliser dans des conditions de réception optimales, l’indicateur de puissance du signal affiché à l’écran comportant alors un nombre suffisant de barres. En général, plus vous êtes proche d’un relais, plus la puissance utilisée par l’appareil mobile est faible. Les informations scientifiques actuelles n’indiquent en rien que l’utilisation des appareils mobiles exige de prendre de quelconques précautions spéciales. Cependant, des organismes tels que l’Organisation Mondiale de la Santé et la Food and Drug Administration recommandent aux personnes souhaitant minimiser leur exposition aux radiofréquences de réduire la durée d’utilisation de l’appareil ou d’utiliser autant que possible un kit mains-libres permettant d’éloigner l’appareil mobile de leur tête et de leur corps durant son utilisation. Cependant, on veillera dans ce cas à éloigner le téléphone du ventre des femmes enceintes et du bas ventre des enfants et des adolescents. Pour plus d’informations, visitez le site www.samsung.com/sar et recherchez votre appareil à l’aide du numéro de modèle.32 Consignes de sécurité Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets d’équipements électriques et électroniques) (Applicable aux pays disposant de systèmes de collecte séparés) Ce symbole sur le produit, ses accessoires ou sa documentation indique que ni le produit, ni ses accessoires électroniques usagés (chargeur, casque audio, câble de connexion, etc.), ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets ménagers. La mise au rebut incontrôlée des déchets présentant des risques environnementaux et de santé publique, veuillez séparer vos produits et accessoires usagés des autres déchets. Vous favoriserez ainsi le recyclage de la matière qui les compose dans le cadre d’un développement durable. Les particuliers sont invités à contacter le magasin leur ayant vendu le produit ou à se renseigner auprès des autorités locales pour connaître les procédures et les points de collecte de ces produits en vue de leur recyclage. Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit et ses accessoires ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets professionnels et commerciaux.33 Consignes de sécurité Élimination de la batterie de ce produit (Applicable aux pays disposant de systèmes de collecte séparés) Le symbole sur la batterie, le manuel ou l’emballage indique que la batterie de ce produit ne doit pas être éliminée en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. L’indication éventuelle des symboles chimiques Hg, Cd ou Pb signifie que la batterie contient des quantités de mercure, de cadmium ou de plomb supérieures aux niveaux de référence stipulés dans la directive CE 2006/66. Si la batterie n’est pas correctement éliminée, ces substances peuvent porter préjudice à la santé humaine ou à l’environnement. Afin de protéger les ressources naturelles et d’encourager la réutilisation du matériel, veillez à séparer la batterie des autres types de déchets et à la recycler via votre système local de collecte gratuite des piles et batteries. Limitation de responsabilité Les contenus et les services accessibles par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil appartiennent dans leur intégralité à des tiers et sont protégés par les lois sur les droits d’auteur, les brevets, les marques et/ou d’autres lois sur la propriété intellectuelle. Ces contenus et services sont fournis uniquement pour votre usage personnel et non pour une utilisation commerciale. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser ces contenus ou services d’une manière qui n’a pas été autorisée par le propriétaire des contenus ou le fournisseur des services. Sans que cela ne limite ce qui précède, sauf autorisation expresse du propriétaire de contenus ou du fournisseur de services concerné, il vous est interdit de modifier, de copier, de republier, de transférer, de diffuser, de transmettre, de traduire, de vendre, d’exploiter ou de distribuer, d’une quelconque manière et sur quelque support que ce soit, des contenus ou des services affichés par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil ou d’en créer des dérivés.34 Consignes de sécurité LES CONTENUS ET SERVICES DE TIERS SONT FOURNIS “ EN L’ÉTAT “. DANS TOUTE LA MESURE PERMISE PAR LA LOI LOCALE, SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS LES CONTENUS OU LES SERVICES AINSI FOURNIS, EXPRESSÉMENT OU IMPLICITEMENT, À QUELQUE FIN QUE CE SOIT. SAMSUNG EXCLUT EXPRESSÉMENT TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, SANS QUE CELA SOIT LIMITATIF, LES GARANTIES DE QUALITÉ MARCHANDE ET D’ADÉQUATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER. SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS L’EXACTITUDE, LA VALIDITÉ, L’ACTUALITÉ, LA LÉGALITÉ OU L’EXHAUSTIVITÉ DES CONTENUS OU DES SERVICES FOURNIS PAR L’INTERMÉDIAIRE DE CET APPAREIL, ET SAMSUNG NE SERA RESPONSABLE EN AUCUN CAS, Y COMPRIS EN CAS DE NÉGLIGENCE, QUE CE SOIT AU TITRE DE LA RESPONSABILITÉ CONTRACTUELLE OU DÉLICTUELLE, DES DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCESSOIRES, SPÉCIAUX OU CONSÉCUTIFS, DES HONORAIRES D’AVOCAT, DES FRAIS OU DE TOUT AUTRE DOMMAGE DÉCOULANT DE L’UTILISATION DE TOUT CONTENU OU SERVICE PAR VOUS-MÊME OU PAR UN TIERS (OU DE TOUTE INFORMATION FIGURANT DANS LEDIT CONTENU OU SERVICE), MÊME SI SAMSUNG A ÉTÉ INFORMÉ DE L’ÉVENTUALITÉ DE TELS DOMMAGES. DANS LA MESURE OÙ CERTAINS PAYS N’AUTORISENT PAS L’EXCLUSION DES GARANTIES IMPLICITES OU LA LIMITATION DES DROITS LÉGAUX DU CONSOMMATEUR, IL EST POSSIBLE QUE CES EXCLUSIONS ET LIMITATIONS NE VOUS SOIENT PAS APPLICABLES. Les services tiers peuvent être suspendus ou interrompus à tout moment, et Samsung ne garantit pas qu’un contenu ou un service restera disponible pendant une certaine période. Les contenus et les services sont transmis par des tiers au moyen de réseaux et d’équipements de transmission qui échappent au contrôle de Samsung. Sans que cela ne limite le caractère général du présent avis, Samsung décline expressément toute responsabilité en cas d’interruption ou de suspension de tout contenu ou service fourni par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil. Samsung n’est pas responsable du service client lié aux contenus et aux services. Toute question ou demande de service portant sur les contenus ou les services doit être adressée directement aux fournisseurs de contenus et de services concernés.Déclaration de conformité Informations détaillées Pour le produit suivant Produit : Appareil mobile GSM WCDMA Bluetooth/WiFi Modèle(s) : GT-I9105P Déclaration et normes applicables Nous déclarons par la présente que le produit ci-dessus est conforme aux exigences essentielles de la directive R&TTE (1999/5/CE) en application des normes suivantes : Sécurité EN 60950-1 : 2006 + A12 : 2011 DAS EN 50360 : 2001 / AC 2006 EN 62479 : 2010 EN 62311 : 2008 EN 62209 - 1 : 2006 EN 62209 - 2 : 2010 CEM EN 301 489-01 V1.9.2 (09-2011) EN 301 489-07 V1.3.1 (11-2005) EN 301 489-24 V1.5.1 (10-2010) EN 301 489-03 V1.4.1 (08-2002) EN 301 489-17 V2.1.1 (05-2009) Radio EN 301 511 V9.0.2 (03-2003) EN 301 908-2 V5.2.1 (07-2011) EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (10-2006) EN 300 440-1 V1.6.1 (08-2010) EN 302 291-1 V1.1.1 (07-2005) EN 301 908-1 V5.2.1 (05-2011) EN 301 893 V1.6.1 (11-2011) EN 300 440-2 V1.4.1 (08-2010) EN 302 291-2 V1.1.1 (07-2005) et de la directive (2011/65/UE) sur la restriction d’utilisation de certaines substances dangereuses dans un équipement électrique et électronique. La procédure de déclaration de conformité, définie dans l’article 10, puis reprise à l’alinéa [IV] de la directive 1999/5/EC a été conduite sous contrôle de l’organisme suivant : TÜV SÜD BABT, Forsyth House, Churchfield Road, Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK* Numéro d’identification : 0168 Représentant pour l’union européenne Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab. Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way, Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK* 2012.11.16 Joong-Hoon Choi / Directeur de laboratoire (lieu et date de parution) (nom et signature du responsable dûment habilité) * Il ne s’agit pas de l’adresse du service après-vente de Samsung. Pour obtenir l’adresse ou le numéro de téléphone du service après-vente de Samsung, reportez-vous au certificat de garantie ou contactez le revendeur auprès duquel vous avez acheté ce produit.Printed in Korea GH68-37985A French. 01/2013. Rev. 1.0 En fonction de votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur, certains contenus peuvent différer par rapport à votre appareil. À propos de Samsung Kies Samsung Kies est un logiciel qui permet de gérer et de synchroniser vos bibliothèques multimédia et vos contacts avec des appareils Samsung. Téléchargez la dernière version de Samsung Kies à partir du site Web Samsung (www.samsung.com/kies) et installez-la sur votre ordinateur. Protégez votre oreille lorsque vous utilisez un casque ou des écouteurs • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé peut endommager votre audition. • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé lorsque vous êtes au volant peut détourner votre attention et provoquer un accident. • Diminuez toujours le volume avant de connecter des écouteurs à une source audio et réglez le volume minimum nécessaire vous permettant d’entendre votre conversation ou la musique. • Dans les environnements secs, les casques et écouteurs sont propices à la formation d’électricité statique. Évitez alors d’utiliser votre casque ou vos écouteurs et touchez un objet métallique pour vous décharger de toute électricité statique avant de brancher le casque/les écouteurs sur l’appareil. SCX-3200 Series Multi-Functional Mono Printer User’s Guide imagine the possibilities Thank you for purchasing a Samsung product. Copyright_ 2 copyright © 2010 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. All rights reserved. This user’s guide is provided for information purposes only. All information included herein is subject to change without notice. Samsung Electronics is not responsible for any direct or indirect damages, arising from or related to use of this user’s guide. • Samsung and the Samsung logo are trademarks of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. • PCL and PCL 6 are trademarks fo Hewlett-Packard Company. • Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows Server 2008 R2 are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. • PostScript 3 is a trademark of Adobe System, Inc. • USFT® and MicroType™ are registed trademarks of Monotype Imaging Inc. • iPad, iPhone, iPod touch, TrueType, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S and other countries. AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple Inc. • LaserWriter is a trademark of Apple Inc. • All other brand or product names are trademarks of their respective companies or organizations. Refer to the 'LICENSE.txt' file in the provided CD-ROM for the open source license information. REV. 1.01Safety information_ 3 safety information These warnings and precautions are included to prevent injury to you and others, and to prevent any potential damage to your machine. Be sure to read and understand all of these instructions before using the machine. Use common sense for operating any electrical appliance and whenever using your machine. Also, follow all warnings and instructions marked on the machine and in the accompanying literature. After reading this section, keep it in a safe place for future reference. IMPORTANT SAFETY SYMBOLS This section explains the meanings of all icons and signs in the user's guide. These safety symbols are in order, according to the degree of danger. Explanation of all icons and signs used in the user’s guide: Warning Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in severe personal injury or death. Caution Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in minor personal injury or property damage. Do not attempt. Do not disassemble. Do not touch. Unplug the power cord from the wall socket. Make sure the machine is grounded to prevent electric shock. Call the service center for help. Follow directions explicitly. OPERATING ENVIRONMENT Warning Do not use if the power cord is damaged or if the electrical outlet is not grounded. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Do not bend, or place heavy objects on the power cord. ► Stepping on or allowing the power cord to be crushed by a heavy object could result in electric shock or fire. Do not place anything on top of the machine (water, small metal or heavy objects, candles, lit cigarettes, etc.). ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Do not remove the plug by pulling on the cord; do not handle the plug with wet hands. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Safety information_ 4 Caution During an electrical storm or for a period of non-operation, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. If the plug does not easily enter the electrical outlet, do not attempt to force it in. ► Call an electrician to change the electrical outlet, or this could result in electric shock. Be careful, the paper output area is hot. ► Burns could occur. Do not allow pets to chew on the AC power, telephone or PC interface cords. ► This could result in electric shock or fire and/or injury to your pet. If the machine has been dropped, or if the cabinet appears damaged, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. If the machine does not operate properly after these instructions have been followed, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. If the machine exhibits a sudden and distinct change in performance, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. OPERATING METHOD Caution Do not forcefully pull the paper out during printing. ► It can cause damage to the machine. When printing large quantities, the bottom part of the paper output area may get hot. Do not allow children to touch. ► Burns can occur. Be careful not to put your hand between the machine and paper tray. ► You may get injured. When removing jammed paper, do not use tweezers or sharp metal objects. ► It can damage the machine. Do not block or push objects into the ventilation opening. ► This could result in elevated component temperatures which can cause damage or fire. Do not allow too many papers to stack up in the paper output tray. ► It can damage the machine. Be care when replacing paper or removing jammed paper. ► New paper has sharp edges and can cause painful cuts. This machine's power interception device is the power cord. ► To switch off the power supply, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet. If the machine gets overheated, it releases smoke, makes strange noises, or generates an odd odor, immediately turn off the power switch and unplug the machine. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Safety information_ 5 INSTALLATION / MOVING Warning Do not place the machine in an area with dust, humidity or water leaks. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Caution Before moving the machine, turn the power off and disconnect all cords. Then lift the machine: •If the machine weighs under 20 kg (44.09lb), lift with 1 person. • If the machine weighs 20 kg (44.09lb) - 40kg (88.18lb), lift with 2 people. • If the machine weighs more than 40 kg (88.18lb), lift with 4 or more people. ► The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage. Do not put a cover over the machine or place it in an airtight location, such as a closet. ► If the machine is not well-ventilated, this could result in fire. Do not place the machine on an unstable surface. ► The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage. Make sure you plug the power cord into a grounded electrical outlet. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. The machine should be connected to the power level which is specified on the label. ► If you are unsure and want to check the power level you are using, contact the electrical utility company. Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords. ► This can diminish performance, and could result in electric shock or fire. Use only No.26 AWGa a. AWG: American Wire Gauge or larger, telephone line cord, if necessary. ► Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine. Use the power cord supplied with your machine for safe operation. If you are using a cord which is longer than 2 meters (6 feet) with a 140V machine, then the gauge should be 16 AWG or larger. ► Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine, and could result in electric shock or fire. MAINTENANCE / CHECKING Caution Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning the inside of the machine. Do not clean the machine with benzene, paint thinner or alcohol; do not spray water directly into the machine. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Keep cleaning supplies away from children. ► Children could get hurt.Safety information_ 6 SUPPLY USAGE Caution Do not disassemble the toner cartridge. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. When storing supplies such as toner cartridges, keep them away from children. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. Do not burn any of the supplies such as toner cartridge or fuser unit. ► This could cause an explosion or uncontrollable fire. Using recycled supplies, such as toner, can cause damage to the machine. ► In case of damage due to the use of recycled supplies, a service fee will be charged. When changing the toner cartridge or removing jammed paper, be careful not to let toner dust touch your body or clothes. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. When toner gets on your clothing, do not use hot water to wash it. ► Hot water sets toner into fabric. Use cold water. When you are working inside the machine replacing supplies or cleaning the inside, do not operate the machine. ► You could get injured. Do not disassemble, repair or rebuild the machine by yourself. ► It can damage the machine. Call a certified technician when the machine needs repair. Keep the power cable and the contact surface of the plug clean from dust or water. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. To clean and operate the machine, strictly follow the user's guide provided with the machine. ► Otherwise, you could damage the machine. Do not remove any covers or guards that are fastened with screws. ► The machine should only be repaired by a Samsung service technician. Fuser units should only be repaired by a certified service technician. ► Repair by non-certified technicians could result in fire or electric shock. Regulatory information_ 7 regulatory information This machine is designed for a normal work environment and certified with several regulatory statements. LASER SAFETY STATEMENT The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for Class I(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1:1993 + A1:1997 + A2:2001. Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance or prescribed service condition. • Wavelength: 800 nm • Beam divergence - Paraller: 13 degrees - Perpendicular: 35 degrees • Maximum power or energy output: 12 mW WARNING Never operate or service the printer with the protective cover removed from Laser/Scanner assembly. The reflected beam, although invisible, can damage your eyes. When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons: OZONE SAFETY During normal operation, this machine produces ozone. The ozone produced does not present a hazard to the operator. However, it is advisable that the machine be operated in a well ventilated area. If you need additional information about ozone, contact your local Samsung dealer.Regulatory information_ 8 POWER SAVE This printer contains advanced energy conservation technology that reduces power consumption when it is not in active use. When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of time, power consumption is automatically lowered. ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are registered U.S. marks. For more information on the ENERGY STAR program see http://www.energystar.gov. RECYCLING Recycle or dispose of the packaging material for this product in an environmentally responsible manner. CHINA ONLY CORRECT DISPOSAL OF THIS PRODUCT (WASTE ELECTRICAL & ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT) (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems) This marking shown on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household wastes at the end of its working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, separate this from other types of wastes and recycle it responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take this item for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. RADIO FREQUENCY EMISSIONS FCC Information to the User This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: • This device may not cause harmful interference, and • This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:Regulatory information_ 9 • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or experienced radio TV technician for help. Change or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Canadian Radio Interference Regulations This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class B limits for radio noise emissions from digital apparatus as set out in the interference-causing equipment standard entitled “Digital Apparatus”, ICES-003 of the Industry and Science Canada. Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe B prescrites dans la norme sur le matériel brouilleur: “Appareils Numériques”, ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada. UNITED STATES OF AMERICA Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Intentional emitter per FCC Part 15 Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system. This section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label to verify the presence of wireless devices. Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the United States of America if an FCC ID number is on the system label. The FCC has set a general guideline of 20 cm (8 inches) separation between the device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body (this does not include extremities). This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are on. The power output of the wireless device (or devices), which may be embedded in your printer, is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the FCC. This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Operation of this device is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to use it. Contact manufacturer for service. FCC Statement for Wireless LAN use: While installing and operating this transmitter and antenna combination the radio frequency exposure limit of 1m W/cm2 may be exceeded at distances close to the antenna installed. Therefore, the user must maintain a minimum distance of 20cm from the antenna at all times. This device cannot be colocated with another transmitter and transmitting antenna. TURKEY ONLY GERMANY ONLYRegulatory information_ 10 RUSSIA ONLY REPLACING THE FITTED PLUG (FOR UK ONLY) Important The mains lead for this machine is fitted with a standard (BS 1363) 13 amp plug and has a 13 amp fuse. When you change or examine the fuse, you must re-fit the correct 13 amp fuse. You then need to replace the fuse cover. If you have lost the fuse cover, do not use the plug until you have another fuse cover. Contact the people from you purchased the machine. The 13 amp plug is the most widely used type in the UK and should be suitable. However, some buildings (mainly old ones) do not have normal 13 amp plug sockets. You need to buy a suitable plug adaptor. Do not remove the moulded plug. If you cut off the moulded plug, get rid of it straight away. You cannot rewire the plug and you may receive an electric shock if you plug it into a socket. Important warning: You must earth this machine. The wires in the mains lead have the following color code: • Green and Yellow: Earth • Blue: Neutral • Brown: Live If the wires in the mains lead do not match the colors marked in your plug, do the following: You must connect the green and yellow wire to the pin marked by the letter “E” or by the safety ‘Earth symbol’ or colored green and yellow or green. You must connect the blue wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “N” or colored black. You must connect the brown wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “L” or colored red. You must have a 13 amp fuse in the plug, adaptor, or at the distribution board. DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (EUROPEAN COUNTRIES) Approvals and Certifications The CE marking applied to this product symbolizes Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Declaration of Conformity with the following applicable 93/68/EEC Directives of the European Union as of the dates indicated: SCX-3200 Series: Low Voltage Directive (2006/95/EC), EMC Directive (2004/108/EC) SCX-3205W(K): R&TTE Directive (1999/5/EC) The declaration of conformity may be consulted at www.samsung.com/printer, go to Support > Download center and enter your printer (MFP) name to browse the EuDoC. January 1, 1995: Council Directive 2006/95/EC Approximation of the laws of the member states related to low voltage equipment. January 1, 1996: Council Directive 2004/108/EC (92/31/EEC), approximation of the laws of the Member States related to electromagnetic compatibility. March 9, 1999: Council Directive 1999/5/EC on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment and the mutual recognition of their conformity. A full declaration, defining the relevant Directives and referenced standards can be obtained from your Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. representative.Regulatory information_ 11 EC Certification Certification to 1999/5/EC Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive (FAX) This Samsung product has been self-certified by Samsung for pan-European single terminal connection to the analogue public switched telephone network (PSTN) in accordance with Directive 1999/5/EC. The product has been designed to work with the national PSTNs and compatible PBXs of the European countries: In the event of problems, you should contact the Euro QA Lab of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. in the first instance. The product has been tested against TBR21. To assist in the use and application of terminal equipment which complies with this standard, the European Telecommunication Standards Institute (ETSI) has issued an advisory document (EG 201 121) which contains notes and additional requirements to ensure network compatibility of TBR21 terminals. The product has been designed against, and is fully compliant with, all of the relevant advisory notes contained in this document. European Radio Approval Information (for products fitted with EU-approved radio devices) Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system which is intended for home or office use. This section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label to verify the presence of wireless devices. Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the European Union or associated areas if a CE mark with a Notified Body Registration Number and the Alert Symbol is on the system label. The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in you printer is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the European Commission through the R&TTE directive. European States qualified under wireless approvals: EU Austria, Belgium, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France (with frequency restrictions), Germany, Greece, Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, The Netherlands, Poland, Portugal, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden and the U.K. EEA/EFTA countries Iceland, Liechtenstein, Norway and Switzerland European States with restrictions on use: EU In France, the frequency range is restricted to 2446.5-2483.5 MHz for devices above 10 mW transmitting power such as wireless EEA/EFTA countries No limitations at this time REGULATORY COMPLIANCE STATEMENTS Wireless Guidance Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system. The following section is a general overview of considerations while operating a wireless device. Additional limitations, cautions, and concerns for specific countries are listed in the specific country sections (or country group sections). The wireless devices in your system are only qualified for use in the countries identified by the Radio Approval Marks on the system rating label. If the country you will be using the wireless device in, is not listed, contact your local Radio Approval agency for requirements. Wireless devices are closely regulated and use may not be allowed. The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in your printer is well below the RF exposure limits as known at this time. Because the wireless devices (which may be embedded into your printer) emit less energy than is allowed in radio frequency safety standards and recommendations, manufacturer believes these devices are safe for use. Regardless of the power levels, care should be taken to minimize human contact during normal operation. As a general guideline, a separation of 20 cm (8 inches) between the wireless device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body (this does not include extremities) is typical. This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are on and transmitting. This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Some circumstances require restrictions on wireless devices. Examples of common restrictions are listed below: Radio frequency wireless communication can interfere with equipment on commercial aircraft. Current aviation regulations require wireless devices to be turned off while traveling in an airplane. IEEE 802.11 (also known as wireless Ethernet) and Bluetooth communication devices are examples of devices that provide wireless communication.Regulatory information_ 12 OPENSSL LICENSE Copyright (c) 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)". 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without Prior written permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org. 5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project. 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)". THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT "AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). ORIGINAL SSLEAY LICENSE Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved. This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL. This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are adhered to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. In environments where the risk of interference to other devices or services is harmful or perceived as harmful, the option to use a wireless device may be restricted or eliminated. Airports, Hospitals, and Oxygen or flammable gas laden atmospheres are limited examples where use of wireless devices may be restricted or eliminated. When in environments where you are uncertain of the sanction to use wireless devices, ask the applicable authority for authorization prior to use or turning on the wireless device. Every country has different restrictions on the use of wireless devices. Since your system is equipped with a wireless device, when traveling between countries with your system, check with the local Radio Approval authorities prior to any move or trip for any restrictions on the use of a wireless device in the destination country. If your system came equipped with an internal embedded wireless device, do not operate the wireless device unless all covers and shields are in place and the system is fully assembled. Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to use it. Contact manufacturer for service. Only use drivers approved for the country in which the device will be used. See the manufacturer System Restoration Kit, or contact manufacturer Technical Support for additional information.Regulatory information_ 13 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement: "This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)" The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the routines from the library being used are not cryptographic related. 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement: "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)". THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. The licence and distribution terms for any publicly available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.Regulatory information_ 14 CHINA ONLYAbout this user’s guide_ 15 about this user’s guide This user’s guide provides information about basic understanding of the machine as well as detailed explanation on each step during actual usage. It is a valuable resource for both novice and professional users for the proper installation and use of the machine. • Read the safety information before using the machine. • If you have a problem using the machine, refer to the troubleshooting chapter (See "Troubleshooting" on page 77). • Terms used in this user’s guide are explained in the glossary chapter (See "Glossary" on page 96). • Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models. • The procedures in this user’s guide are mainly based on Windows XP. CONVENTION Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below: • Document is synonymous with original. • Paper is synonymous with media, or print media. • Machine refers to printer or MFP. The following table offers the conventions of this guide: CONVENTION DESCRIPTION EXAMPLE Bold For texts on the display or button names on the machine. Power Note Provides additional information or details for the machine function and feature. The date format may differ from country to country. Caution Contains information you can use to protect the machine from possible mechanical damage or malfunction. Do not touch the surface of the drum located in the toner cartridge or imaging unit. Footnote Provides additional information on certain words or a phrases. a. pages per minute (“Cross-reference”) Refers you to additional detailed information. (See "Finding more information" on page 16).About this user’s guide_ 16 FINDING MORE INFORMATION You can find information about setting up and using your machine in the following resources, either as a print-out or on screen. MATERIAL NAME DESCRIPTION Quick Installation Guide This guide provides information on setting up your machine. This guide is provided in the box with the printer. User’s Guide This guide provides you with step-by-step instructions for using your machine’s full features, maintaining your machine, troubleshooting, and replacing supplies. Machine Driver Help This help provides you with information about the printer driver and instructions for setting up the options for printing (See "Using help" on page 56). Samsung website If you have Internet access, you can get help, support, machine drivers, manuals, and order information from the Samsung website, www.samsung.com/printer. Downloadable software You can download useful software programs from the Samsung website. • Samsung AnyWeb Print: helps personal users to screen-capture the website screen in Windows Internet Explorer easily. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com/personal/anywebprint) • SyncThru™ Web Admin Service: provides convenient tools for network administrators who need to manage many machines simultaneously. This program is for network model only. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com, See "Features by Models" on page 18)Features of your new product_ 17 features of your new product Your new machine is equipped with a number of special features that improve the quality of the documents you print. SPECIAL FEATURES Print with excellent quality and speed • You can print with a resolution of up to 1200 x 1200 dpi effective output. • Your machine prints A4-sized paper at up to 16 ppm and letter-sized paper at up to 17 ppm. Handle many different types of printable material • The 150-sheet tray supports plain paper in various sizes, letterhead, envelopes, labels, custom-sized media, postcards, and heavy paper. Create professional documents • Print Watermarks. You can customize your documents with words, such as “Confidential” (See "Using watermarks" on page 57). • Print Posters. The text and pictures of each page of your document are magnified and printed across the sheet of paper and can then be taped together to form a poster (See "Printing posters" on page 56). • You can use preprinted forms and letterhead with plain paper (See "Using overlays" on page 58). Save time and money • To save paper, you can print multiple pages on one single sheet of paper (See "Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper" on page 56). • This machine automatically conserves electricity by substantially reducing power consumption when not in use. • To save paper, you can print on both sides of the paper manually (See "Printing on both sides of the paper (Manual)" on page 56). Print in various environments • You can print with various operating systems such as Windows, Linux, and Macintosh OS systems. • Your machine is equipped with a Hi-Speed USB 2.0 interface. • Your machine comes with a built-in network interface, Ethernet 10/100 BaseTX. SCX-3205W(K) only) • Your machine comes with a built-in network interface 802.11 b/g/n wireless LAN. (SCX-3205W(K) only) For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Copy the original in high quality • You can copy the original and print them in enhanced image quality and size. Scan the originals • Scan in color and use the precise compressions of BMP, JPEG, TIFF and PDF formats. • Use one button to scan your original to the connected computer. Eco Print • You can reduce toner and paper usage (See "Eco Print button" on page 22). IPv6 (SCX-3205W(K) only) • The machine supports IPv6 (See "IPv6 Configuration" on page 34). AirPrint AirPrint allows you to wirelessly print directly from iPhone, iPad and iPod touch running iOS 4.2 or later.Features of your new product_ 18 FEATURES BY MODELS The machine is designed to support all of your document needs from printing to more advanced networking solutions for your business. Features by models include: FEATURES SCX-3200 SERIES SCX-3205W(K) SERIES Print ● ● Eco Print ● ● Duplex (2-sided) printing (manual) ● ● Copy ● ● Scan ● ● Hi-Speed USB 2.0 ● ● Print Screen ● IPv6 ● Network Interface Ethernet 10/100 Base TX wired LAN ● Network Interface 802.11b/g/n wireless LANa a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN card may not be available. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your machine. ● SyncThru™ Web Service ● (●: Included, Blank: Not included) Introduction_ 19 1.introduction This chapter gives you an overview of your machine: This chapter includes: • Machine overview • Control panel overview • Understanding the status LED • Introducing the useful buttons MACHINE OVERVIEW Front view 3 6 1 10 11 12 9 7 8 5 4 2 13 14 This illustration may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 Scanner lid 6 Front door 11 Inner cover 2 Scanner glass 7 Tray 12 Toner cartridge 3 Control panel 8 Paper length guide 13 Toner cartridge handle 4 Output tray (face down) 9 Paper width guide 14 Toner cartridge drum 5 Output support 10 Scan unitIntroduction_ 20 Rear view 1 2 3 This illustration may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 USB port 2 Power cord receptacle 3 Network porta a.SCX-3205W(K) onlyIntroduction_ 21 CONTROL PANEL OVERVIEW This control panel may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13 12 1 Power ( ) Allows you to turn the power on or off (See "Power button" on page 23). 2 Eco Print Turn the Eco mode on or off (See "Eco Print button" on page 22). 3 Scan to Sends scanned data (See "Scanning originals and sending to your computer (Scan to PC)" on page 64). 4 ID Copy Allows you to copy both sides the ID card like a driver’s license to a single side of paper (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 5 Front LED When the LED lights on, place the front side of an ID card facing down on the scanner glass (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 6 Back LED When the LED lights on, place the back side of an ID card facing down on the scanner glass (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 7 Display Shows the number of pages you want to copy. 8 +/- Buttons Allows you to increase/decrease the number of page you want to copy (See "+/- buttons" on page 22). 9 Print Screen (SCX-3200 only) Prints the displayed screen of your monitor (See "Print Screen button (SCX-3200 only)" on page 22). WPS (SCX-3205W(K) only) Allows you to turn on or off the wireless network connection (See "WPS button (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 22). 10 Stop/Clear ( ) Stops an operation at any time and there are more functions (See "Stop/Clear button" on page 23). 11 Start ( ) Begins a printing, copying or scanning job depending on which function you are using. 12 Wireless LED (SCX-3205W(K) only) Shows the current status of the wireless network connection (See "Understanding the status LED" on page 22). 13 Status LED Shows the status of your machine (See "Understanding the status LED" on page 22).Introduction_ 22 UNDERSTANDING THE STATUS LED Status LED The color of the LED indicates the machine's current status. STATUS LED DESCRIPTION Off • The machine is off-line. • The machine is in sleep mode. Green On • The machine is in ready mode or warming up. Blinking • When the LED blinks slowly, the machine is receiving data from the computer or printing documents. • When the LED blinks rapidly, the machine is operating special functions. Red On • The inner cover is opened. Close the inner cover completely. • There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in the tray. • The machine has stopped due to a major error. • Your system has some problems. If this problem occurs, contact a service representative. • A toner cartridge has almost reached its estimated cartridge lifea a.Estimated cartridge life means the expected or estimated toner cartridge life, which indicates the average capacity of print-outs and is designed pursuant to ISO/IEC 19752. The number of pages may be affected by operating environment, percentage of image area, printing interval, media type, and media size. Some amount of toner may remain in the cartridge even when red LED is on and the printer stops printing. . It is recommended to replace the toner cartridge (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). Blinking • A small amount of toner is left in the cartridge. The estimated cartridge lifea of toner is close. Prepare a new cartridge for replacement. You may temporarily increase the printing quality by redistributing the toner (See "Redistributing toner" on page 77). • The machine is printing in manual feed mode or in manual duplex mode. Orange On A paper jam has occurred (See "Clearing paper jams" on page 78). Samsung does not recommend using a non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge such as one that is refilled or remanufactured. Samsung cannot guarantee a non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge's quality. Service or repair required as a result of using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridges will not be covered under the machine warranty. All printing errors will appear in the Smart Panel program window. If the problem persists, contact a service representative. Wireless LED (SCX-3205W(K) only) WIRELESS LED STATUS DESCRIPTION Blue Off ( ) Wireless network is disconnected. On ( ) Wireless network is connected. Slowly blinks ( ) The machine starts connecting to a wireless network. Fast blinks ( ) • The machine is connecting to access point (or wireless router). • Wireless network connection is being disconnected. INTRODUCING THE USEFUL BUTTONS Print Screen button (SCX-3200 only) If you press Print Screen button for less than two seconds, the green light blinks fast on the Status LED, and then the machine prints the whole screen displayed in the monitor. If you press Print Screen button for more than two seconds, the Status LED lights on green, and then the machine prints an active screen displayed in the monitor. • The page will be printed on the default page like A4 or Letter. • Print Screen can only be used in the Windows and Macintosh operating systems. • You can only use this function with a USB-connected machine. • You can use this function only when the Smart Panel program is installed and running. • You can only use this function in Eco Print mode off. Eco Print button You can turn the Eco Print mode on or off by simply pressing the button. If you set the Eco Print mode on, the machine automatically sets the 2-UP and Toner Save option on and print with those options. 1. Press Eco Print button on the control panel. 2. Eco Print LED lights on. Then, Eco Print mode is on. To turn off Eco Print mode, press Eco Print button one more time. +/- buttons You can determine the number of copies (up to 99 copies) you want to copy by pressing +/- buttons. The default setting value is 1. • If you press +/- buttons briefly, the number of copies increases/decreases by single digits. • If you press +/- buttons long, the number of copies increases/decreases by ten-fold. WPS button (SCX-3205W(K)) This feature automatically detects which WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup™) mode your access point uses. By pushing a button on the wireless LAN router/access point and the machine, you can setup the wireless network and security settings (See "Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 36).Introduction_ 23 Stop/Clear button By pressing Stop/Clear button, you can do the following functions. FUNCTION DESCRIPTION Printing a configuration report In ready mode, press and hold this button long enough (about two seconds) until the Status LED blinks slowly, and release the button (See "To print a configuration report" on page 24). Printing a network configuration report (SCX-3205W(K) only) In ready mode, press and hold this button for four seconds until the Status LED blinks fast, and release the button (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). Supplies information report In the ready mode, press and hold this button for about 6 seconds until the Status LED is on, and release (See "To print a supplies information report" on page 24). Canceling print job Press Stop/Clear button during a operation. The print job is cleared from both the machine and the computer and then the machine returns to ready mode. This may take some time depending on the size of the print job. Power button By pressing Power button, you can turn the machine on or off. Turning on the machine 1. Plug in the power cord. 2. Press Power button on the control panel. When the machine is powered on, you can see LED looping on the display. Then, the machine is in ready mode. If you want to turn the power off, press and hold this button for about two seconds.Getting started_ 24 2.getting started This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the USB connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Setting up the hardware • Printing a report • Supplied software • System requirements • Installing USB connected machine’s driver • Sharing your machine locally SETTING UP THE HARDWARE This section shows the steps to set up the hardware, as is explained in the Quick Installation Guide. Make sure you read the Quick Installation Guide first and follow the steps below: Location 1. Select a stable location. Select a level, stable place with adequate space for air circulation. Allow extra space for opening cover(s) and tray(s). The area should be well ventilated and away from direct sunlight or sources of heat, cold, and humidity. Do not set the machine close to the edge of your desk or table. Printing is suitable for altitudes under 1,000 m (3,281 ft). Refer to the altitude setting to optimize your printing (See "Altitude adjustment" on page 46). Place the machine on a flat, stable surface so that there is no incline greater than 2 mm (0.08 inch). Otherwise, printing quality may be affected. 2mm (0.08 in) 2mm (0.08 in) 2. Unpack the machine and check all the enclosed items. 3. Remove tape holding the machine securely. 4. Install the toner cartridge. 5. Load paper (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 6. Make sure that all cables are connected to the machine. 7. Turn the machine on (See "Turning on the machine" on page 23). This machine will not operate when the power main fails. PRINTING A REPORT Print a configuration or supplies information page to make sure that the machine is operating properly. To print a configuration report In the ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about two seconds) until the Status LED blinks slowly, and release. For SCX-3205W(K), you can print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). To print a supplies information report In the ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for about six seconds until the Status LED lights on, and release. SUPPLIED SOFTWARE After you have set up your machine and connected it to your computer, you must install the printer software. If you are a Windows or Macintosh OS user, install the software from the supplied CD and if you are a Linux OS user, download the software from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/printer) and install. Machine software is occasionally updated for reasons like the release of new operating system and etc. If needed, download the latest version from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/printer).OS CONTENTS Windows • Printer driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • Scanner driver: TWAIN and Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) drivers are available for scanning documents on your machine. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • SmarThrua : a.Allows you to edit a scanned image in various ways using a powerful image editor and to send the image by email. You can also open another image editor program such as Adobe Photoshop, from SmarThru. For details, refer to the on-screen help supplied on the SmarThru program (See "SmarThru" on page 70). This program is the accompanying Windows-based software for your multifunctional machine. • Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out about Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program information and installed scan driver's condition. • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Macintosh • Printer Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • Scanner driver: TWAIN driver is available for scanning documents on your machine. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out about Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program information and installed scan driver's condition. • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Linux • Unified Linux Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • SANE: Use this driver to scan documents. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Getting started_ 25 SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS Before you begin, ensure that your system meets the following requirements: Windows Your machine supports the following Windows operating systems. OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENT (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACE Windows® 2000 Intel® Pentium® II 400 MHz (Pentium III 933 MHz) 64 MB (128 MB) 600 MB Windows® XP Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (256 MB) 1.5 GB Windows Server® 2003 Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (512 MB) 1.25 GB to 2 GB Windows Server® 2008 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GB Windows Vista® Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz 512 MB (1 GB) 15 GB Windows® 7 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32-bit or 64-bit processor or higher 1 GB (2 GB) 16 GB • Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory (to enable the Aero theme). • DVD-R/W Drive Windows Server® 2008 R2 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (x86) or 1.4 GHz (x64) processors (2 GHz or faster) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GB • Internet Explorer® 5.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all Windows operating systems. • Windows Terminal Services is compatible with your machine. Macintosh OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACE Mac OS X 10.3 ~ 10.4 • Intel® Processors • PowerPC G4/ G5 • 128 MB for a PowerPC based Mac (512 MB) • 512 MB for a Intel-based Mac (1 GB) 1 GBGetting started_ 26 Linux ITEM REQUIREMENTS Operating system RedHat® Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64 bit) Fedora 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 (32/64 bit) SuSE Linux 10.0, 10.1 (32 bit) OpenSuSE® 10.2, 10.3, 11.0, 11.1, 11.2 (32.64 bit) Mandriva 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2009.1 (32/64 bit) Ubuntu 5.04, 5.10, 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04, 8.10, 9.04, 9.10 (32/64 bit) SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11 (32/64 bit) Debian 4.0, 5.0 (32/64 bit) CPU Pentium IV 2.4 GHz (Intel Core™2) RAM 512 MB (1 GB) Free HDD space 1 GB (2 GB) INSTALLING USB CONNECTED MACHINE’S DRIVER A locally connected machine is a machine directly connected to your computer by a USB cable. Only use a USB cable no longer than 3 m (10 ft.). Windows You can install the machine software using the typical or custom method. The following steps are recommended for most users who use a machine directly connected to your computer. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the computer and powered on. If the “Found New Hardware Wizard” window appears during the installation procedure, click Cancel to close the window. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window will appear. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM Drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM Drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control window. 3. Select Install now. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. • For SCX-3205W(K), you can access the Wireless Setting and Installation menu. The menu allows you to install a wireless network to connect to the machine with an USB cable (See "Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 36). • The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom Installation and Install Software Only. The Custom Installation allows you to select the machine’s connection and choose individual component to install. The Install Software Only allows you to install the supplied software, such as Smart Panel. Follow the instruction on the window. 4. Read the License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. The software searches for the machine. If your machine is not connected to the computer, the following Mac OS X 10.5 • Intel® Processors • 867 MHz or faster Power PC G4/ G5 512 MB (1 GB) 1 GB Mac OS X 10.6 • Intel® Processors 1 GB (2 GB) 1 GB OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACEGetting started_ 27 window will appear. • After connecting the machine, click Next. • Check if you want to install the software without connection of the printer. - Check this option to install the software without a machine connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be skipped, and completes the installation. • Search again When you press this button, the firewall notice window appears. - Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Windows operating system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall, and inactivate this option. - Turn off the firewall from the third party's program beside the operating system. Refer to the manual provided by individual programs. • Direct Input The Direct Input allows you to search a specific machine on the network. - Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host name. Then click Next. To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). - Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next. • Help - This help button gives you the detailed information about how to connect the machine. 5. The searched machines will be shown on the screen. Select the one you wish to use and click Next. If the software searched only one machine, the confirmation window appears. 6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 8. 7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 8. If you want to register your machine on Samsung web site, click On-line Registration. If your machine is not connected yet to the network or computer, click How to connect?. How to connect? gives detailed information about how to connect the machine. Follow the instructions in the window. 9. Click Finish. If the printer driver does not work properly, follow the steps below to repair or reinstall the driver. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your machine and powered on. b) From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Uninstall. c) Select the option you wish to execute, then follow the instruction on the window. Macintosh 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 6. Enter the password and click OK. 7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 8. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 10.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to install. 11.When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, click Continue. 12.Select Typical installation for a network printer for a network printer and then click OK. 13.After the installation is finished, click Restart. 14.Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 15.Click Add on the Printer List. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, click the “+” icon; a display window will pop up. 16.For Mac OS X 10.3, select the USB tab. • For Mac OS X10.4, click Default Browser and find the USB connection. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, click Default and find the USB connection. 17.For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name. • For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Select a driver to use... and your machine name in Print Using. Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default machine. 18.Click Add.Getting started_ 28 If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. c) Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. d) Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. e) Double-click the Installer OS X icon. f) Enter the password and click OK. g) The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. h) Read the license agreement and click Continue. i) Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. j) Select Uninstall and click Uninstall. k) When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, Click Continue. l) When the uninstall is done, click Quit. Linux You need to download Linux software packages from the Samsung website to install the printer software. Follow the steps below to install the software. Installing the Unified Linux Driver 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Unified Linux Driver package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Unified Linux Driver package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > autorun. 6. When the welcome screen appears, click Next. 7. When the installation is complete, click Finish. The installation program added the Unified Driver Configurator desktop icon and the Unified Driver group to the system menu for your convenience. If you have any difficulties, consult the on screen help that is available through your system menu or from the driver package Windows applications, such as Unified Driver Configurator. Installing the Smart Panel 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Smart Panel package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Smart Panel package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > Linux > smartpanel > install.sh. Installing the Printer Settings Utility 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Printer Settings Utility package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Printer Settings Utility package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > Linux > psu > install.sh. If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow the steps below steps to uninstall the driver for Linux. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) When the Administrator Login window appears, type in “root” in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to uninstall the printer driver. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. c) Click the icon at the bottom of the desktop. When the Terminal screen appears, type in: [root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/ [root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh d) Click Uninstall. e) Click Next. f) Click Finish.Getting started_ 29 SHARING YOUR MACHINE LOCALLY Follow the steps below to set up computers to share your machine locally. If the Host computer is directly connected to the machine by a USB cable and is also connected to the local network environment, the client computer connected to the local network can use the shared machine through the host computer to print. 2 1 1 Host computer A computer which is directly connected to the machine by USB cable. 2 Client computers Computers which use the machine shared through the host computer. Windows Setting up a host computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s driver" on page 26). 2. Click the Windows Start menu. 3. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printers and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 4. Right-click the printer icon. 5. For Windows XP/Vista/Server 2003/Server 2008, press Properties. For Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select the Printer properties. If Printer properties item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. 6. Select the Sharing tab. If you are a Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2 user, check the Change Sharing Options. 7. Check the Share this printer checkbox. 8. Fill in the Share Name field. Click OK. Setting up a client computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s driver" on page 26). 2. Click the Windows Start menu. 3. Select All programs > Accessories > Windows Explorer. 4. Enter the IP address of the host computer in the address bar and press Enter in your keyboard. In case host computer requires a User name and Password, fill in User ID and password of the host computer account. 5. Right-click the printer icon you want to share and select Connect. 6. If a set up complete message appears, click OK. 7. Open the file you want to print and start printing. Macintosh The following steps are for Mac OS X 10.5~10.6. Refer to Mac Help for other OS versions. Setting up a host computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Macintosh" on page 27). 2. Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 3. Select the printer to share in the Printers list. 4. Select Share this printer. Setting up a client computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Macintosh" on page 27). 2. Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 3. Click the “+” icon. A display window showing the name of your shared printer appears. 4. Select your machine and click Add. Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 30 3.network setup (scx-3205w(k) only) This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the network connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Network environment • Introducing useful network programs • Using a wired network • Installing network connected machine’s driver • IPv6 Configuration NETWORK ENVIRONMENT You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your network machine. You can set up the basic network settings through the network setting programs. The following table shows the network environments supported by the machine. ITEM REQUIREMENTS Network interface • Ethernet 10/100 Base-TX • 802.11b/g/n Wireless LANa a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN card may not be available. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your machine. Network operating system • Windows 2000/Server 2003 /Server 2008/XP/Vista/7/Server 2008 R2 • Various Linux OS • Mac OS X 10.3 ~ 10.6 Network protocols • TCP/IPv4 • DHCP, BOOTP • DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP • Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR, IPP • SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP • TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR, SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP) (See "IPv6 Configuration" on page 34.) Wireless security • Authentication: Open System, Shared Key, WPA Personal, WPA2 Personal (PSK) • Encryption: WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES INTRODUCING USEFUL NETWORK PROGRAMS There are several programs available to setup the network settings easily in network environment. For the network administrator especially, managing several machines on the network is possible. Before using the programs below, set the IP address first. SyncThru™ Web Service Web server embedded on your network machine, which allows you to do the following tasks. • You can configure the network parameters necessary for the machine to connect to various network environments. • You can customize machine settings (See "Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only)" on page 69). SyncThru™ Web Admin Service Web-based machine management solution for network administrator. SyncThru™ Web Admin Service provides you with an efficient way of managing network devices and lets you remotely monitor and troubleshoot network machines from any site with corporate internet access. • Download this program from http://solution.samsungprinter.com. SetIP This utility program allows you to select a network interface and manually configure the IP addresses for use with the TCP/IP protocol. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Windows)" on page 31. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh)" on page 31. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Linux)" on page 32. TCP/IPv6 is not supported by this program. USING A WIRED NETWORK You must set up the network protocols on your machine to use it on your network. This chapter will show you how this is easily accomplished. You can use network after connecting network cable to a corresponding port on your machine. Printing a network configuration report You can print a network configuration report from the machine’s control panel that will show the current machine’s network settings. This will help you to set up a network and troubleshoot problems.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 31 1. Press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 Setting IP address First, you have to set up an IP address for network printing and managements. In most cases a new IP address will be automatically assigned by a DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server located on the network. In a few situations the IP address must be set manually. This is called a static IP and is often required in corporate Intranets for security reasons. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report. • Static IP assignment: Use SetIP program to change the IP address from your computer. If your machine has a control panel, you can also change IP address using the machine's control panel. In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set IP address for you. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Windows) This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your machine using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A MAC address is the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration Report. Before using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall by performing the following steps. 1. Open Control Panel. 2. Double-click Security Center. 3. Click Windows Firewall. 4. Disable the firewall. Installing the program 1. Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM provided with your machine. When the driver CD runs automatically, close that window. 2. Start Windows Explorer and open the X drive (X represents your CD-ROM drive). 3. Double-click Application > SetIP. 4. Double-click Setup.exe to install this program. 5. Select a language, then click Next. 6. Follow the instructions in the window and complete the installation. Starting the program 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turn on the machine. 3. From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung Printers > SetIP > SetIP. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address). • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print the Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. 7. Click Exit to close the SetIP program. 8. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh) For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following. 1. Open System Preferences. 2. Click Security. 3. Click the Firewall menu. 4. Turn firewall off. The following instructions may vary from your model. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Insert the Installation CD-ROM, and open the disk window, select MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPapplet.html. 3. Double-click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select Trust. The browser will open the SetIPapplet.html page that shows the printer’s name and IP address information. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 32 For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address). • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically print the configuration report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation CD-ROM. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have successfully changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Linux) SetIP program should be automatically installed during the printer driver installation. 1. Print the machine’s network configuration report to find your machine’s MAC address. 2. Open the /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/. 3. Double-click the SetIPApplet.html file. 4. Click to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the network card’s MAC address, IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, and then click Apply. When you enter the MAC address, enter it without a colon(:). 6. The machine prints the network information. Confirm all the settings are correct. 7. Close the SetIP program. Network parameter setting You can also set up the various network settings through the network administration programs such as SyncThru™ Web Admin Service and SyncThru™ Web Service. Restoring factory default settings You may need to reset the machine to the factory default settings when machine that you are using is connected to new network environment. Restoring factory default settings using SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari or Firefox and enter your machine’s new IP address in the browser window. For example: 2. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service. 3. Click Login on the upper right of the website. The Login window appears. 4. Type in the ID and Password, and then click Login. If it is your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the below default ID and password. • ID: admin • Password: sec00000 5. Click Settings > Network Settings. 6. Click Restore Default on the left pane of the website. 7. Click Clear. 8. Click Yes when the confirmation window appears. 9. Click OK when the success window appears. 10.Turn off and restart machine to apply settings. INSTALLING NETWORK CONNECTED MACHINE’S DRIVER Windows You can set up the machine driver, follow the steps below. This is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and powered on. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appears. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control windows. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Yes in the User Account Control windows. 3. Select Install Now. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. • For SCX-3205W(K), you can access Wireless Setting and Installation menu. The Wireless Setting and Installation allows you to install a wireless network to connect to the machine with a USB cable (See "Setting a wireless network with USB cable" on page 38). • The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom Installation and Install Software Only. The Custom Installation allows you to select the machine’s connection and choose individual component to install. The Install Software Only allows you to install the supplied software such as the Smart Panel. Follow the instruction on the window. 4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. The program searches for the machine. If your machine is not found in the network or locally, the error Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 33 message appears. • Check if you want to install the software without connection of the printer. - Check this option to install this program without a machine connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be skipped, and completes the installation. • Search again When you press this button, the firewall notice window appears. - Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Windows operating system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall, and inactivate this option. - Turn off the firewall from the third party's program beside the operating system. Refer to the manual provided by individual programs. • Direct Input The Direct Input allows you to search a specific machine on the network. - Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host name. Then click Next. To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). - Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next. • Help If your machine is not connected to the computer or network, this help button gives detailed information about the how to connect the machine. 5. The searched machine will be shown on the screen. Select the one you wish to use and click Next. If the driver searched only one machine, the confirmation window appears. 6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and go to step 8. 7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 8. If you want to register your machine on Samsung website, click On-line Registration. If your machine is not connected yet to the network, click How to connect?. How to connect? gives you the detailed information about the how to connect the machine. Follow the instructions in the window. 9. Click Finish. • After the driver setup is completed, you may enable firewall. • If your printer driver does not work properly, follow the step below to repair or reinstall the driver. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your machine and powered on. b) From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Uninstall. c) Select the option as you wish, follow the instruction on the window. Macintosh 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 6. Enter the password and click OK. 7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 8. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 10.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to install. 11.When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears. Click Continue. 12.Select Typical installation for a network printer for a network printer and then click OK. 13.The SetIP program automatically runs. If the machine has already configured network information, close the SetIP program. 14.Click OK to continue the installation. 15.After the installation is finished, click Restart. 16.Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 17.Click Add on the Printer List. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click the “+” icon. A display window will pop up. 18.For Mac OS X 10.3, select the IP Printing tab. • For Mac OS X 10.4, click IP Printer. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click IP. 19.Select HP Jetdirect - Socket in Protocol. When printing a document containing many pages, printing performance may be enhanced by choosing Socket for Printer Type option. 20.Enter the machine’s IP address in the Address input field.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 34 21.Enter the queue name in the Queue input field. If you cannot determine the queue name for your machine server, try using the default queue first. 22.For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name. • For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, choose Select Printer Software and your machine name in Print Using. Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default machine. 23.Click Add. If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. c) Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. d) Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. e) Double-click the Installer OS X icon. f) Enter the password and click OK. g) The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. h) Read the license agreement and click Continue. i) Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. j) Select Uninstall and click Uninstall. k) When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, click Continue. l) When the uninstall is done, click Quit. Linux Install Linux Driver and add network Printer 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set. 2. Download the Unified Linux Driver package from the Samsung website. 3. Extract the UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz file and open the new directory. 4. Double-click the Linux folder. 5. Double-click the install.sh icon. 6. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 7. The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next. 8. Select Network printer and click Search button. 9. The Printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field. 10.Select your machine and click Next. 11.Input the printer description and Next 12.When the add printer is done, click Finish 13.When the install is done, click Finish Add network Printer 1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator. 2. Click Add Printer… 3. The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next. 4. Select Network printer and click the Search button. 5. The printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field. 6. Select your machine and click Next. 7. Input the printer description and Next 8. When the add printer is done, click Finish. IPV6 CONFIGURATION TCP/IPv6 is supported properly only in Windows Vista or higher. If the IPv6 network seems to not be working, set all the network setting to the factory defaults and try again (See "Restoring factory default settings" on page 32). In the IPv6 network environment, follow the next procedure to use the IPv6 address. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turn on the machine. 3. Print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control panel that will check IPv6 addresses (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). 4. Select Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printer > Add Printer. 5. Click Add a local printer on the Add Printer windows. 6. Follow the instruction on the window. 7. The Add Printer Wizard window appears. Follow the instruction on the window. If the machine does not work in the network environment, activate IPv6. Refer to the next section followed by. Printing a network configuration report You can print a network configuration report from the machine’s control panel that will show the current machine’s network settings. This will help you to set up a network and troubleshoot problems. 1. In ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 Setting IPv6 addresses Machine supports the following IPv6 addresses for network printing and managements. • Link-local Address: Self-configured local IPv6 address (Address starts with FE80). • Stateless Address: Automatically configured IPv6 address by a network router. • Stateful Address: IPv6 address configured by a DHCPv6 server. • Manual Address: Manually configured IPv6 address by a user.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 35 Manual address configuration 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6 addressing as a URL (See "Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only)" on page 69). For IPv4, enter the IPv4 address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address field and press the Enter key or click Go. 2. When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network Settings. 3. Click TCP/IPv6. 4. Enable the Manual Address In the TCP/IPv6 section. 5. Select the Address/Prefix and click the Add button, then the router prefix will automatically be entered into the address field. Enter the rest of address. (ex: 3FFE:10:88:194::AAAA. “A” is the hexadecimal 0 through 9, A through F.) 6. Click the Apply button. Installing printer driver Driver installation for network printer in IPv6 network environment is same as TCP/IPv4 (See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32). Select TCP/IP Port and when the list of machines are displayed, simply select your machine's IPv6 address. Using SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6 addressing as a URL. 2. Select one of the IPv6 addresses (Link-local Address, Stateless Address, Stateful Address, Manual Address) from Network Configuration Report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). 3. Enter the IPv6 addresses (ex: http://[FE80::215:99FF:FE66:7701]). Address must be enclosed in '[ ]' brackets.Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 36 4.wireless network setup (scx-3205w(k)) This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the wireless network connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Setting a wireless network with the WPS button • Using a wireless network from the computer • Setting a wireless network with USB cable • Setting a wireless network with network cable • Completing the installation • Troubleshooting For more information about the network environment, network programs, and installing network connected machine’s driver, refer to the following chapters. • See "Network environment" on page 30. • See "Introducing useful network programs" on page 30. • See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32. SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH THE WPS BUTTON You can install a wireless network with the WPS ( ) button. After compleleting the wireless network connection, you need to install a machine driver to print from an application (See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32). Setting a wireless network with the WPS button If your machine and an access point (or wireless router) support Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS), you can easily configure the wireless network settings by pressing the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. If you want to use the wireless network using the infrastructure mode, make sure that the network cable is disconnected from the machine. Using the WPS (PBC) button or entering the PIN number from the computer to connect to the Access Point varies depending on the access point (or wireless router) you are using. Refer to the user's guide of the access point (or wireless router) you are using. Items to prepare You need to ensure you have the following items ready to use: • Check if the access point (or wireless router) supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS). • Check if your machine supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS). • Networked computer (PIN mode only) Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Choosing your network connection There are two methods to connect your machine to a wireless network using the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. The Push Button Configuration (PBC) method allows you to connect your machine to a wireless network by pressing both the WPS ( ) button on the control panel of your machine and the WPS (PBC) button on a Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS)-enabled access point (or wireless router) respectively. The Personal Identification Number (PIN) method helps you connect your machine to a wireless network by entering the supplied PIN information on a Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS)-enabled access point (or wireless router). Factory default in your machine is PBC mode, which is recommended for a typical wireless network environment. Connecting to a wireless network in PBC mode To connect your machine to the wireless network in PBC mode, follow the following steps: You need to check the status of the wireless LED. 1. Press and hold the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for about 2 - 4 seconds until the status LED blinks quickly. • : The light blinks slowly on wireless LED. The machine starts connecting to the wireless network. The LED blinks slowly for up to two minutes until you press the PBC button on access point (or wireless router). 2. : Press the WPS (PBC) button on the access point (or wireless router). The wireless LED blinks in the order below: a) : The light blinks fast on the wireless LED. The machine is connecting to the access point (or wireless router). b) : When the machine is successfully connected to the wireless network, the wireless LED light stays on. Connecting to the wireless network in PIN mode To connect your machine to the wireless network, follow the following steps: You need to check the status of the wireless LED. 1. The network configuration report including PIN number must be printed. In ready mode, press and hold the Stop/Clear button on the control panel for about 5 seconds. You can find your machine’s PIN number. 2. Press and hold the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for more than 4 seconds until the status LED on. • : The light blinks slowly on the wireless LED. The machine starts connecting to access point (or wireless router). 3. You need to enter eight-digit PIN number within two minutes to the computer which is connected to the access point (or wireless router). The LED blinks slowly for up to two minutes until you enter the eight-digit PIN number The wireless LED blinks in the order below: a) : The light blinks fast on the wireless LED. The machine is Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 37 connecting to the access point (or wireless router). b) : When the machine is successfully connected to the wireless network, the wireless LED light stays on. Re-connecting to the wireless network When the wireless function is off, the machine automatically tries to re-connect to the access point (or wireless router) with the previously used wireless connection settings and address. In the following cases, the machine automatically re-connects to the wireless network: • The machine is turned off and on again. • The access point (or wireless router) is turned off and on again. Canceling a wireless network connection process To cancel the wireless network connection function when the machine is connecting to the wireless network, press and release the Stop/Clear button on the control panel. You need to wait 2 minuites to re-connect the wireless network. Disconnecting a wireless network connection To disconnect the wireless network connection, press the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for more than two seconds. • When the Wi-Fi Network is in idle mode: The machine is immediately disconnected from the wireless network, and the wireless LED is off. • When the Wi-Fi Network is being used: While the machine waits until the current job is finished, the light blinks fast on the wireless LED. Then, the wireless network connection is automatically disconnected. The wireless LED is off. When the Wi-Fi Network is disconnected, press the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. The Wi-Fi network is on and the setting a wireless network begins. USING A WIRELESS NETWORK FROM THE COMPUTER Choosing your network connection Typically, you can only have one connection between your computer and the machine at a time. There are types of network connections to consider. • Wireless network without access point (Ad-Hoc mode) • Wireless network with an access point (Infrastructure mode) How to print a network configuration report You can identify the network settings of your machine by printing a network configuration report. To print the report: 1. In ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 IP addresses Every device in a network has a unique numerical address called an IP Address. Your machine came with a Default IP address of 192.0.0.192, which you can verify by printing out a Network Configuration Report or Configuration Report. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report. • Static IP assignment: Use the SetIP program to change the IP address from your computer (See "Setting IP address" on page 31). In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set this address for you. Wireless network name and network key Wireless networks require higher security, so when an access point is first set up, a network name (SSID), the type of security used, and a Network Key are created for the network. Locate this information before proceeding with the machine installation. Infrastructure mode This is an environment generally used for homes and SOHOs. This mode uses an access point to communicate with the wireless machine. • See "Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Windows)" on page 38. • See "Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Macintosh)" on page 40. Ad-Hoc mode This mode does not use an access point. The wireless computer and wireless machine communicates directly. • See "Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Windows)" on page 39. • See "Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Macintosh)" on page 41. After choosing your configuration, follow the simple directions for your computer operating system, but first locate the software CD supplied with the machine before proceeding. Installing a wireless network with cables You can install a wireless network to connect to the machine with either a USB cable or a network cable. For most users, we recommend using a USB cable with the program provided in the supplied software CD. The following are two ways to install a wireless network with cables. • With a USB cable: You can simply set up a wireless network using the program in the supplied software CD. Only Windows and Macintosh operating system are supported (See "Setting a wireless network with USB cable" on page 38). You can also install a wireless network in Printer Settings Utility with USB cable after installing driver. (Windows and Macintosh operating system are supported.) • With a network cable: You can set up a wireless network using the SyncThru™ Web Service program (See "Setting a wireless network withWireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 38 network cable" on page 42). SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH USB CABLE Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Windows) Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless interface • USB cable Creating the infrastructure network in Windows When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer, access point and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appears. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control windows. 4. Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. • Install Now: First you must configure the wireless network settings of your printer to print through wireless. • Wireless Setting and Installation: Configure the wireless network settings of your printer with a USB cable then install the printer driver. Press this button to set up the wireless connection if you have not set up the wireless connection before. 5. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. 6. The software searches the wireless network. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 7. After searching, the window shows the wireless network devices. Select the name (SSID) of access point you are using and click Next. If you cannot find out the network name you want to choose, or if you want to set the wireless configuration manually, click Advanced Setting. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type the SSID of access point you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Infrastructure. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. WPA Personal or WPA2 Personal: Select this option to authenticate the print server based on WPA Pre-Shared Key. This uses a shared secret key (generally called Pre Shared Key pass phrase) which is manually configured on the access point and each of its clients. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES, TKIP AES) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window does appear when the access point has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. The window may differ according to its security mode, WEP or WPA. • In case of WEP Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and enter WEP security key. Click Next. WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. • In case of WPA Enter the WPA shared key and click Next. WPA authorizes and identifies users based on a secret key that changes automatically at regular intervals. WPA also uses TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) and AES (Advanced Encryption Standard) for data encryption. 8. The window shows the wireless network setting and check if settings are right. Click Next. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the window. However, if it shows Static, click Change Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 39 TCP/IP to change the assignment method to DHCP. • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer is set to DHCP, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 9. When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. Click Next. 10. Wireless Network Setting Complete window appears. Then, click Next. Select Yes if you accept the current settings and continue the setup procedure. Select No if you want to return to the beginning screen. Then, click Next. 11.Click Next when the Confirm Printer Connection window appears. 12.Select the components to be installed. Click Next. After selecting the components, you can also change the machine name, set the machine to be shared on the network, set the machine as the default machine, and change the port name of each machine. Click Next. 13.After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 15. 14.If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 15.To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from Samsung, click On-line Registration. 16.Click Finish. Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Windows) If you do not have an access point (AP), you may still connect the machine wirelessly to your computer by setting up an Ad-Hoc wireless network by following the simple steps below. Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Wireless network computer • Software CD provided with your machine • Wireless network machine • USB cable Creating the Ad-Hoc network in Windows When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer and the wireless network machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appear. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control windows. 4. Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. • Install Now: First you must configure the wireless network settings of your printer to print through wireless. • Wireless Setting and Installation: Configure the wireless network settings of your printer with a USB cable then install the printer driver. Press this button to set up the wireless connection if you have not set up the wireless connection before. 5. Read the License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. 6. The software searches the wireless network. If the software has failed to search the network, check if the USB cable is connected properly between the computer and machine, and follow the instruction on the window. 7. After searching the wireless network, a list of wireless network your machine has searched appears. If you want to use the Samsung default ad-hoc setting, select the last wireless network on the list, which Network Name(SSID) is airportthru and Signal is Printer Self Network. Then, click Next. If you want to use other ad-hoc settings, select other wireless network from the list. If you want to change ad-hoc settings click the Advanced Setting button. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type in the SSID Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 40 name you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Ad-hoc. • Channel: Select the channel. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window appears when the ad-hoc network has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and click Next. • WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. 8. The window which shows the wireless network setting appears. Check the settings and click Next. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer’s network configuration is set to DHCP, the wireless network setting should also be DHCP. Likewise, if the computer’s network configuration is set to Static, the wireless network setting should also be Static. If your computer is set to DHCP and you want to use Static wireless network setting, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to Receive IP address automatically (DHCP). • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 9. When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. Click Next. If the Change PC Network Setting window appears, follow the steps on the window. Click Next if you are finished the computer’s wireless network settings. If you set the computer’s wireless network as DHCP, it will take several minutes to receive the IP address. 10.The Wireless Network Setting Complete window appears. Select Yes if you accept the current settings and continue the setup procedure. Select No if you want to return to the beginning screen. Then, click Next. 11.Click Next when the Confirm Printer Connection window appears. 12.Select the components to be installed. Click Next. After selecting the components, you can also change the machine name, set the machine to be shared on the network, set the machine as the default machine and change the port name of each machine. Click Next. 13.After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 15. 14.If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 15.To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from Samsung, click On-line Registration. 16.Click Finish. Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Macintosh) Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • USB cable Creating the infrastructure network in Macintosh When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer, access point and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 4. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 5. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 6. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 7. Enter the password and click OK. 8. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 9. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 10.Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 11.Select Easy Install and click Install.Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 41 Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual operations will be installed. 12.Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. 13.The software searches the wireless network. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 14.After searching, the window shows the wireless network devices. Select the name (SSID) of access point you are using and click Next. When you set the wireless configuration manually, click Advanced Setting. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type the SSID of access point you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Infrastructure. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. WPA Personal or WPA2 Personal: Select this option to authenticate the print server based on WPA Pre-Shared Key. This uses a shared secret key (generally called Pre Shared Key pass phrase) which is manually configured on the access point and each of its clients. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES, TKIP AES) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window does appear when the access point has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. The window may differ according to its security mode, WEP or WPA. • In case of WEP Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and enter WEP security key. Click Next. WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. • In case of WPA Enter the WPA shared key and click Next. WPA authorizes and identifies users based on a secret key that changes automatically at regular intervals. WPA also uses TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) and AES (Advanced Encryption Standard) for data encryption. 15.The window shows the wireless network setting and check if settings are right. Click Next. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to DHCP. • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer is set to DHCP, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 16.The wireless network is connecting according to the network configuration. 17.When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. 18.After the installation is finished, click Restart. Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Macintosh) If you do not have a access point (AP), you may still connect the machine wirelessly to your computer by setting up an Ad-Hoc wireless network by following these simple directions. Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Wireless network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • USB cable Creating the Ad-Hoc network in Macintosh When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 4. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 5. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 6. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 7. Enter the password and click OK. 8. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 9. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 10.Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 11.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual operations will be Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 42 installed. 12.Click Wireless Setting and Installation. 13.The software searches the wireless network devices. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 14.After searching the wireless network, a list of wireless network your machine has searched appears. If you want to use the Samsung default ad-hoc setting, select the last wireless network on the list, which Network Name(SSID) is airportthru and Signal is Printer Self Network. Then, click Next. If you want to use other ad-hoc settings, select other wireless network from the list. If you want to change ad-hoc settings click the Advanced Setting button. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type in the SSID name you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Ad-hoc. • Channel: Select the channel. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window appears when the ad-hoc network has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and click Next. • WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. 15.The window which shows the wireless network setting appears. Check the settings and click Next. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer’s network configuration is set to DHCP, the wireless network setting should also be DHCP. Likewise, if the computer’s network configuration is set to Static, the wireless network setting should also be Static. If your computer is set to DHCP and you want to use Static wireless network setting, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to Receive IP address automatically (DHCP). • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 16.The wireless network is connecting according to the network configuration. 17.When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. 18.After the installation is finished, click Restart. SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH NETWORK CABLE Your machine is a network compatible machine. To enable your machine to work with your network you will need to perform some configuration procedures. Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Preparing items Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • Network cable Setting IP address Firstly, you have to set up an IP address for network printing and managements. In most cases a new IP address will be automatically assigned by a DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server located on the network. In a few situations the IP address must be set manually. This is called a static IP and is often required in corporate Intranets for security reasons. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report (See "How to print a network configuration report" on page 37). • Static IP assignment: Use SetIP program to change the IP address Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 43 from your computer. In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set this address for you. IP setting using SetIP Program (Windows) This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your machine using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A MAC address is the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration Report. For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following: 1. Open Start > All programs > Control Panel. 2. Double-click Security Center. 3. Click Windows Firewall. 4. Disable the firewall. Installing the program 1. Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM provided with your machine. When the driver CD runs automatically, close that window. 2. Start Windows Explorer and open the X drive. (X represents your CD-ROM drive.) 3. Double-click Application > SetIP. 4. Double-click Setup.exe to install this program. 5. Click OK. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. 6. Follow the instructions in the window and complete the installation. Starting the program 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turned on the machine. 3. From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung Printers > SetIP > SetIP. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address.) • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print the Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. 7. Click Exit to close the SetIP program. 8. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. IP setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh) For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following: The path and UIs may differ by Mac OS version. Refer to the Mac OS manual. 1. Open System Preferences. 2. Click Security. 3. Click the Firewall menu. 4. Turn firewall off. The following instructions may vary for your model. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Insert the Installation CD-ROM, and open the disk window, select MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPApplet.html. 3. Double-click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select Trust. The browser will open the SetIPApplet.html page that shows the printer’s name and IP address information. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address.) • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically print the configuration report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation CD-ROM. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have successfully changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway. Configuring the machine’s wireless network Before starting you will need to know the network name(SSID) of your wireless network and the network key if it is encrypted. This information was set when the access point (or wireless router) was installed. If you do not know about your wireless environment, please ask the person who has set up your network. To configure wireless parameters, you can use SyncThru™ Web Service. Using SyncThru™ Web Service Before starting wireless parameter configuration, make sure cable connection status. Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 44 1. Check whether the network cable is connected to the machine. If not, connect the machine with a standard network cable. 2. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari or Firefox and enter your machine’s new IP address in the browser window. For example, 3. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website. The Login window appears. 4. Type in the ID and Password then click Login. If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the below default ID and password. • ID: admin • Password: sec00000 5. When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network Settings. 6. Click Wireless > Wizard. Wizard will help you setup the wireless network configuration. However, if you want to set the wireless network directly, select Custom. 7. Select the one Network Name(SSID) in the list. • SSID: SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a wireless network. access points and wireless devices attempting to connect to a specific wireless network must use the same SSID. The SSID is case-sensitive. • Operation Mode: Operation Mode refers to the type of wireless connections (See "Wireless network name and network key" on page 37). - Ad-hoc: Allows wireless devices to communicate directly with each other in a peer-to-peer environment. - Infrastructure: Allows wireless devices to communicate with each other through an access point. If your network’s Operation Mode is Infrastructure, select the SSID of the access point. If the Operation Mode is Ad-hoc, select the machine’s SSID. Note that “airportthru” is the default SSID of your machine. 8. Click Next. If wireless security setting window appears, enter the registered password (network key) and click Next. 9. The confirmation window appears, please check your wireless setup. If the setup is right, click Apply. Disconnect the network cable (standard or network). Your machine should then start communicating wirelessly with the network. In case of Ad-hoc mode, you can use a wireless LAN and wired LAN simultaneously. COMPLETING THE INSTALLATION After you have installed your Samsung wireless network printer, print another copy of the Network Configuration Report and keep it for future reference. You are now ready to use your new Samsung wireless printer on your network. TROUBLESHOOTING Solve problems that might occur during wireless setting and installing the machine driver. Wireless network problems If problems occur while using the machine on a network, check the followings. Printers Not Found • Your machine may not be turned on. Turn on your computer and the machine. • USB cable is not connected between your computer and machine. Connect machine to your computer using the USB cable. • The machine does not support wireless network. Check the machine's user's guide included on the software CD supplied with your machine and prepare a wireless network machine. Connecting Failure - Not found SSID • The machine is unable to search network name (SSID) which you have selected or typed in. Check the network name (SSID) on your access point and try connecting again. • Your access point is not turned on. Turn on your access point. Connecting Failure - Invalid Security • You configured security incorrectly. Check the configured security on your access point and machine. Connecting Failure - General Connection Error • Your computer is not receiving a signal form your machine. Check the USB cable and your machine power. • When Temporal Key Integrity Protocol(TKIP) security is set up for the access point, connection might fail. Change the access point settings. Connecting Failure - Connected Wired Network • Your machine is connected with wired network cable. Remove the wired network cable from your machine. PC Connection Error • The configured network address is unable to connect between your computer and machine. - For DHCP network environment The print receives the IP address automatically (DHCP) when computer is configured to DHCP. - For Static network environment The machine uses the static address when computer is configured to static address. If you computer has following addresses, - IP address: 192.168.1.100 - Subnet address: 255.255.255.0 - Gateway address: 192.168.1.1 Type in the following address for your machine, - IP address: 192.168.1.101 - Subnet address: 255.255.255.0 - Gateway address: 192.168.1.1Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 45 Solving other problems If problems occur while using the machine on a network, check the followings. For information on access point (or wireless router), refer to its own user's guide. • Your computer, access point or machine may not be turned on. • Check the wireless reception around the machine. If the reception is far from the machine or there is an obstacle, you might have difficulty receiving the signal. • Cycle the power for access point (or wireless router), machine and computer. Sometimes cycling the power can recover network communication. • Check whether firewall software (V3 or Norton) is blocking the communication. If the computer and the machine is connected on a same network it cannot be searched, firewall software might be blocking the communication. Refer to the user's guide for the software to turn it off and try searching the machine again. • Check whether the machine's IP address is allocated correctly. You can check the IP address by printing the network configuration report. • Check whether access point (or wireless router) has a configured security (password). If it has a password, refer to the access point (or wireless router) administrator. • Check whether the machine's IP address. Reinstall the machine driver and change the settings to connect to the machine on the network. Due to the characteristics of DHCP, the allocated IP address could change if the machine is not used for a long time or if the access point has been reset. • Check the wireless environment. You might not be able to connect to the network in the infrastructure environment where you need to type in a user's information before connecting to access point (or wireless router). • This machine only supports IEEE 802.11 b/g/n and Wi-Fi. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Other wireless communication (Bluetooth) is not supported. • When using the Ad-hoc mode, for operating systems such as Windows Vista, you might need to set the wireless connection setting every time you use the wireless machine. • You cannot use infrastructure mode and Ad-hoc mode at the same time for Samsung wireless network machine. • The machine is within the range of the wireless network. For most networks, the machine should be within 30 meters (100 feet) of the wireless access point (or wireless router). • The machine is located away from obstacles that could block the wireless signal. Remove any large metal objects between the access point (or wireless router) and the machine. Make sure the machine and wireless access point (or wireless router) are not separated by poles, walls, or support columns containing metal or concrete. • The machine is located away from other electronic devices that may interfere with the wireless signal. Many devices can interfere with the wireless signal, including baby monitors, motors, cordless phones, security system cameras, other wireless networks, and some Bluetooth devices.Basic setup_ 46 5.basic setup After installation is complete, you may want to set the machine’s default settings. Refer to the next section if you would like to set or change values. This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the machine. This chapter includes: • Altitude adjustment • Setting the default tray and paper • Using the power saving feature • Changing font setting ALTITUDE ADJUSTMENT The print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure, which is determined by the height of the machine above sea level. The following information will guide you on how to set your machine to the best print quality or best quality of print. Before you set the altitude value, determine the altitude where you are. 0 4,000 m (13,123 ft) 3,000 m (9,842 ft) 2,000 m (6,561 ft) 1,000 m (3,280 ft) 4 3 2 1 1 High 1 2 High 2 3 High 3 4 Normal You can altitude adjustment in Printer Settings Utility. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Setting > Altitude Adjustment. Select necessary options from the drop-down list. 4. Click the Apply button. If your machine is connected to a network, SyncThru™ Web Service screen appears automatically. This can be also adjusted via SyncThru™ Web Service. SETTING THE DEFAULT TRAY AND PAPER You can select the tray and paper you would like to keep using for printing job. From your computer Windows 1. Click the Windows Start menu. 2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printer and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 3. Right-click on your machine. 4. For Windows XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista, press Printing Preferences. For Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select the Printing Preferences. If Printing Preferences item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. 5. Click Paper tab. 6. Select tray and its options, such as paper size and type. 7. Press OK. If you want to use special-sized paper such as a billing paper, select Edit... in the Paper tab in the Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). Macintosh Macintosh does not support this function. Macintosh users need to change the default setting manually each time they want to print using other settings. 1. Open a Macintosh application and select the file you want to print. 2. Open the File menu and click Print. 3. Go to Paper Feed pane. 4. Set appropriate tray from which you want to print. 5. Go to Paper pane. 6. Set paper type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from which you want to print. 7. Click Print to print. Linux 1. Open Terminal Program. 2. When the Terminal screen appears, type in the following: [root@localhost root]# lpr Basic setup_ 47 3. Select Printer and click Properties… 4. Click on the Advanced tab. 5. Select the tray (source) and its options, such as paper size and type. 6. Press OK. USING THE POWER SAVING FEATURE When you will not be using the machine for a while, you can use this feature to save power. You change power save in Printer Settings Utility. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Setting > Power Save. Select the appropriate value from the drop-down list, and then click Apply. CHANGING FONT SETTING Your machine has preset font setting depending on your region or country. If you want to change the font or set the font for special condition, such as the DOS environment, you can change the font setting as follows: 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Emulation. 4. Confirm if PCL is selected in Emulation Setting. 5. Click Setting. 6. Select your preferred font in the Symbol set list. 7. Click Apply. Following information shows the proper font list for corresponding languages. • Russian: CP866, ISO 8859/5 Latin Cyrillic • Hebrew: Hebrew 15Q, Hebrew-8, Hebrew-7 (Israel only) • Greek: ISO 8859/7 Latin Greek, PC-8 Latin/Greek • Arabic & Farsi: HP Arabic-8, Windows Arabic, Code Page 864, Farsi, ISO 8859/6 Latin Arabic • OCR: OCR-A, OCR-BMedia and tray_ 48 6.media and tray This chapter provides information on how to load print media into your machine. This chapter includes: • Loading originals • Selecting print media • Changing the tray size • Loading paper in the tray • Printing on special media • Using the output support LOADING ORIGINALS You can use the scanner glass to load an original for copying or scanning. On the scanner glass Using the scanner glass, you can copy or scan originals. You can get the best scan quality, especially for colored or gray-scaled images. 1. Lift and open the scanner lid. 2. Place the original face down on the scanner glass. Align it with the registration guide at the top left corner of the glass. 3. Close the scanner lid. • Leaving the scanner lid open while copying may affect copy quality and toner consumption. • Dust on the scanner glass may cause black spots on the printout. Always keep it clean (See "Cleaning the scan unit" on page 75). • If you are copying a page from a book or magazine, lift the scanner lid until its hinges are caught by the stopper and then close the lid. If the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm, start copying with the scanner lid open. • Be careful not to break the scanner glass. You may get hurt. • Do not put hands while closing the scanner lid. The scanner lid may fall on your hands and get hurt. • Do not look the light from inside of the scanner while copying or scanning. It is harmful to eyes. SELECTING PRINT MEDIA You can print on a variety of print media, such as plain paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies. Always use print media that meets the guidelines for use with your machine and from the appropriate tray. Guidelines for selecting the print media Print media that does not meet the guidelines outlined in this user’s guide may cause the following problems: • Poor print quality • Increased paper jams • Premature wear on the machine. • Permanent fuser damage, not covered under warranty. Properties, such as weight, composition, grain, and moisture content, are important factors that affect the machine’s performance and the output quality. When you choose print materials, consider the following: • The type, size and weight of the print media for your machine are described in print media specifications (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Desired outcome: The print media you choose should be appropriate for your project. • Brightness: Some print media are whiter than others and produce sharper, more vibrant images. • Surface smoothness: The smoothness of the print media affects how crisp the printing looks on the paper. • Some print media may meet all of the guidelines in this section and still not produce satisfactory results. This may be the result of the sheets characteristics, improper handling, unacceptable temperature and humidity levels, or other variables over which cannot be controlled. • Before purchasing large quantities of print media, ensure that it meets the specifications in this user’s guide and that it meets your output requirements. • Using print media that does not meet these specifications may cause problems, requiring repairs. Such repairs are not covered by Media and tray_ 49 the warranty or service agreements. The amount of paper put into the tray may differ according to media type used (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Using inflammable print media can cause a fire. • Use designated print media (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). The use of inflammable media or foreign materials left in the printer may lead to overheating of the unit and, in rare cases may cause a fire. Media sizes supported in each mode MODE SIZE TYPE SOURCE Copy mode Letter, A4, Legal, Oficio, US Folio, Executive, JIS B5, A5 For details about paper type, click the following link ("Print media specifications" on page 93). Tray Simplex printing For details about paper size, click the following link ("Print media specifications" on page 93). For details about paper type, click the following link ("Print media specifications" on page 93). Tray Duplex printing (Manual)a a.75 to 90 g/m2 (20~24 lbs bond) only (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). Letter, A4, Legal, US Folio, Oficio Plain, Color, Preprinted, Recycled, Bond, Archive Manual feeding in the tray CHANGING THE TRAY SIZE The tray is preset to Letter or A4 size, depending on your country. To change the size, you need to adjust the paper guides. 3 1 2 1 Tray 2 Paper length guide 3 Paper width guide 1. Open front door and pinch the paper length guide and pull it out to extend the tray. Because the machine is very light, it can move when you open and close the tray or install and remove the toner cartridge. Be careful not to move the machine when performing these tasks. 2. Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before loading the paper. Insert the paper into the tray. 3. Load paper with the print side facing up. Make sure that all four corners are flat in the tray. Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper capacity mark on the inside of the tray.Media and tray_ 50 4. Pinch the paper length guide to adjust the guide so that it is flush up against the rear edge of the paper; then pinch the paper width guides so they are flush against the sides of the paper. • Do not push the paper width guide too far causing the media to warp. • Do not use a paper with more than 6 mm (0.24 inch.) curl. • If you do not adjust the paper width guides, it may cause paper jams. LOADING PAPER IN THE TRAY Tray 1. Open the front door, pinch the paper length guide and pull it out to extend the tray. Then, adjust the tray size to the media size you are loading (See "Changing the tray size" on page 49). 2. Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before loading papers. 3. Place the paper with the side you want to print facing up. When you print a document, set the paper type and size for the tray. For information about setting the paper type and size on the control panel (See "Setting the default tray and paper" on page 46). • If you experience problems with paper feeding, check whether the paper meets the media specifications. Then, try placing one sheet at a time in tray (See "Print media specifications" on page 93, and "Printing on special media" on page 51). • The settings made from the machine driver override the settings on the control panel. Manual feeding in the tray The tray can hold special sizes and types of print material, such as postcards, note cards, and envelopes. It is useful for single page printing on letterhead or colored paper. Tips on using the manual feeding method • If you select Paper > Source > Manual Feeder from your printer driver, you need to press Start button each time you print a page. Load only one type, size and weight of print media at a time in the tray. • To prevent paper jams, do not add media while printing. • Print media should be loaded face up with the top edge going into the tray first and be placed in the center of the tray. • Always load the use recommended print media to avoid paper jams and print quality problems (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Flatten any curl on postcards, envelopes, and labels before loading them into the tray. 1. Load the paper in the tray. • When printing on special media, you must follow the loading guideline (See "Printing on special media" on page 51). • When paper does not feed well while printing, gently push the paper in manually until it starts feeding automatically. 2. Squeeze the tray paper width guides and adjust them to the width of the paper. Do not force them too much, or the paper will bend resulting in a paper jam or skew. 3. Open the output tray and support. 4. To print from an application, open the application and open the print menu. 5. Open Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 6. Click on the Paper tab in Printing Preferences, and select an appropriate paper type. For example, if you want to use a label, set the paper type to Label. 7. Select Manual Feeder in paper source, then press OK. 8. Start printing.Media and tray_ 51 If you are printing multiple pages, load the next sheet after the first page prints out, and press Start button. Repeat this step for every page to be printed. PRINTING ON SPECIAL MEDIA The table below shows the available special media for printing. When printing on a special media, we recommend you feed one paper at a time. Check the maximum input number of media for tray (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). TYPES TRAY MANUAL FEEDING IN TRAYA a.Load one paper at a time. Plain ● ● Thick ● ● Thin ● ● Cotton ● Color ● Preprinted ● Recycled ● ● Envelope ● Transparency ● Labels ● CardStock ● Bond ● Archive ● ● (●: supported, Blank: Not supported) The following media types are shown in the Printing Preferences. This paper type option allows you to set the type of paper to be loaded in the tray. Selecting the appropriate media will let you get the best printout quality. Selecting inappropriate media can result in poor or unfused print quality; and/or cause jamming problems. • Plain: Normal plain paper. Select this type if your printing on 60 to 120 g/m2 (16 to 32 lbs bond). • Thick: 90 to 163 g/m2 (24 to 43 lbs bond) thick paper. • Thin: 60 to 70 g/m2 (16 to 19 lbs bond) thin paper. • Cotton: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond) cotton paper. • Color: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond) color-back grounded paper. • Preprinted: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond) preprinted/letterhead paper. • Recycled: 60 to 90 g/m2 (16 to 24 lbs bond) recycled paper. When you use recycled paper, printouts might be wrinkled and/or jamming may occur due to excessive curl. • CardStock: 105 to 163 g/m2 (28 to 43 lbs bond) cardstock. • Envelope: 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond) envelope. • Transparency: 138 to 146 g/m2 (37 to 39 lbs bond) transparency paper. • Labels: 120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lbs bond) labels. • Bond: 105 to 120 g/m2 (28 to 32 lbs bond) bond. • Archive: 70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lbs bond) If you need to keep the print-out for a long time, such as for archives. Envelopes Successful printing on envelopes depends upon the quality of the envelopes. To print on an envelope, the stamp area should be on the left side and the end of the envelope with the stamp area should enter the printer first in the center of the tray. • When selecting envelopes, consider the following factors: - Weight: The weight of the envelope paper should not exceed 90 g/m2 otherwise, jams may occur. - Construction: Prior to printing, envelopes should lie flat with less than 6 mm ( 0.24 inch.) of curl, and should not contain air. - Condition: Envelopes should not be wrinkled, nicked, either damaged. - Temperature: Use envelopes that are compatible with the heat and pressure of the machine during operation. • Use only well-constructed envelopes with sharp-and well-creased folds. • Do not use stamped envelopes. • Do not use envelopes with clasps, snaps, windows, coated lining, self-adhesive seals, or other synthetic materials. • Do not use damaged or poorly made envelopes. • Be sure the seam at both ends of the envelope extends all the way to the corner of the envelope. 1 Acceptable 2 Unacceptable • Envelopes with a peel-off adhesive strip or with more than one flap that folds over to seal must use adhesives compatible with the machine’s fusing temperature about 170°C (338 °F) for 0.1 second. The extra flaps and strips might cause wrinkling, creasing, or jams, and may even damage the fuser. • For the best print quality, position margins no closer than 15 mm ( 0.59 inch.) from the edges of the envelope. • Avoid printing over the area where the envelope’s seams meet.Media and tray_ 52 Transparencies To avoid damaging the machine, use only transparencies designed for laser printers. • Transparencies used in the machine must be able to withstand machine’s fusing temperature. • Place them on a flat surface after removing them from the machine. • Do not leave unused transparencies on the paper tray for long periods of time. Dust and dirt may accumulate on them, resulting in spotty printing. • To avoid smudging caused by fingerprints, handle transparencies carefully. • To avoid fading, do not expose printed transparencies to prolonged sunlight. • Ensure that transparencies are not wrinkled, curled, or have any torn edges. • Do not use transparencies that separate from the backing sheet. • To prevent transparencies from sticking to each other, do not let the printed sheets stack up as they are begin printed out. Labels To avoid damaging the machine, use only labels designed for laser machines. • When selecting labels, consider the following factors: - Adhesives: The adhesive material should be stable at your machine’s fusing temperature (about 170°C (338 °F)). - Arrangement: Only use labels with no exposed backing between them. Labels can peel off sheets that have spaces between the labels, causing serious jams. - Curl: Prior to printing, labels must lie flat with no more than 13 mm (0.51 inch.) of curl in any direction. - Condition: Do not use labels with wrinkles, bubbles, or other indications of separation. • Make sure that there is no exposed adhesive material between labels. Exposed areas can cause labels to peel off during printing, which can cause paper jams. Exposed adhesive can also cause damage to machine components. • Do not run a sheet of labels through the machine more than once. The adhesive backing is designed for only a single pass through the machine. • Do not use labels that are separating from the backing sheet or are wrinkled, bubbled, or otherwise damaged. Card stock/Custom-sized paper Postcards, cards and other custom-sized materials can be printed with this machine. • Do not print on media smaller than 76 mm (3.00 inches) wide or 183 mm (7.20 inches) long. • In software applications, set the margins at least 6.4 mm (0.25 inches) away from the edges of the material. Letterhead/Preprinted paper SINGLE-SIDED DOUBLE-SIDED Face up Face down • Letterhead/ Preprinted paper must be printed with heat-resistant ink that will not melt, vaporize, or release hazardous emissions when subjected to the machine’s fusing temperature about 170°C(338 °F) for 0.1 second. • Letterhead/ Preprinted paper ink must be non-flammable and should not adversely affect machine rollers. • Forms and letterhead should be sealed in a moisture-proof wrapping to prevent changes during storage. • Before you load letterhead/preprinted paper, verify that the ink on the paper is dry. During the fusing process, wet ink can come off preprinted paper, reducing print quality.Media and tray_ 53 USING THE OUTPUT SUPPORT The surface of the output tray may become hot if you print a large number of pages at once. Make sure that you do not touch the surface, and do not allow children near it. The printed pages stack on the output tray, and the output support will help the printed pages to align. The machine sends printouts to the output tray by default.Printing_ 54 7.printing This chapter explains common printing tasks. This chapter includes: • Introducing useful software program • Printer driver features • Basic printing • Opening printing preferences • Using help • Using special print features • Changing the default print settings • Setting your machine as a default machine • Printing to a file (PRN) • Macintosh printing • Linux printing The procedures in this chapter are mainly based on Windows XP. INTRODUCING USEFUL SOFTWARE PROGRAM Samsung AnyWeb Print This tool helps you to screen-capture, preview, scrap and print the screen of Windows Internet Explorer more easily, than when you use the ordinary program. Click Start > All programs > Samsung Printers > Samsung AnyWeb Print > Download the latest version to link the website where the tool is available for the download. This tool is available only for Windows operating systems. PRINTER DRIVER FEATURES Your printer drivers support the following standard features: • Paper orientation, size, source, and media type selection • Number of copies In addition, you can use various special printing features. The following table shows a general overview of features supported by your printer driver: Some models or operating systems may not support some of the feature(s) in the following table. Printer driver FEATURE WINDOWS Print quality option ● Poster printing ● Multiple pages per sheet ● Booklet printing (manual) ● Fit to page printing ● Reduce and enlarge printing ● Different source for first page ● Watermark ● Overlay ● Double-sided printing (manual) ● (●: supported) BASIC PRINTING Your machine allows you to print from various Windows, Macintosh, or Linux applications. The exact steps for printing a document may vary depending on the application you use. • Your Printing Preferences window that appears in this user’s guide may differ depending on the machine in use. However, the composition of the Printing Preferences window is similar. Check the operating system(s) that are compatible with your machine. Refer to the OS compatibility section of Printer Specifications (See "System requirements" on page 25). • When you select an option in Printing Preferences, you may see a warning mark, , or . An exclamation mark ( ) means you can select that certain option but it is not recommended, and ( ) mark means you cannot select that option due to the machine’s settings or environment. The following procedure describes the general steps required for printing from various Windows applications. • Macintosh basic printing (See "Macintosh printing" on page 59). • Linux basic printing (See "Linux printing" on page 60). The following Printing Preferences window is for Notepad in Windows XP. Your Printing Preferences window may differ, depending on your operating system or the application you are using. 1. Open the document you want to print. 2. Select Print from the File menu. The Print window appears. 3. Select your machine from the Select Printer list.Printing_ 55 You can select the basic print settings, including the number of copies and the print range from within the Print window. To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer driver, click Properties or Preferences in the application’s Print window to change the print setting (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 4. To start the print job, click OK or Print in the Print window. If you are using Windows Internet Explorer, the Samsung AnyWeb Print too will save your time for screen-captured images or printing the image. Click Start > All programs > Samsung Printers > Samsung AnyWeb Print to link the website where the tool is available for the download. Canceling a print job If the print job is waiting in a print queue or print spooler, cancel the job as follows: 1. Click the Windows Start menu. 2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printer and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 3. For Windows Server 2000/XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista, double-click your machine. For Windows 7/Server 2008 R2, right-click your printer icon > context menus > See what’s printing. If See what’s printing item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with selected printer. 4. From the Document menu, select Cancel. You can also access this window by simply double-clicking the machine icon ( ) in the Windows task bar. You can also cancel the current job by pressing Stop/Clear button on the control panel. OPENING PRINTING PREFERENCES You can preview the settings you selected on the upper right of the Printing Preferences. 1. Open the document you want to print. 2. Select Print from the file menu. The Print window appears. 3. Select your machine from the Select Printer. 4. Click Properties or Preferences. Using Presets setting The Presets option, which is visible on each of the preferences tab except for the Samsung tab, allows you to save the current preferences for future use. To save a Presets item: 1. Change the settings as needed on each tab. 2. Enter a name for the item in the Presets input box. 3. Click (Add). When you save Presets, all current driver settings are saved. Select more options and click (Update), settings will be added to the Presets you made. To use a saved setting, select it from the Presets drop-down list. The machine is now set to print according to the settings you have selected. To delete saved settings, select it from the Presets drop-down list and click (Delete). You can also restore the printer driver’s default settings by selecting Default Preset from the Presets drop-down list.Printing_ 56 USING HELP Click the question mark on the upper-right corner of the window and click on the topic you want to know about. Then a pop up window appears with information about that option's feature which is provided from the driver. If you want to search information via a keyword, click the Samsung tab in the Printing Preferences window, and enter a keyword in the input line of the Help option. To get information about supplies, driver updates or registration and so on, click appropriate buttons. USING SPECIAL PRINT FEATURES Special print features include: • "Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper" on page 56. • "Printing posters" on page 56. • "Printing booklets (Manual)" on page 56. • "Change percentage of your document" on page 57. • "Fitting your document to a selected paper size" on page 57. • "Using watermarks" on page 57. • "Using overlays" on page 58. • "Print quality options" on page 58. Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper You can select the number of pages to print on a single sheet of paper. To print more than one page per sheet, the pages will be reduced in size and arranged in the order you specify. You can print up to 16 pages on one sheet. 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Basic tab, select Multiple Pages Per Side in the Type drop-down list. 3. Select the number of pages you want to print per sheet (2, 4, 6, 9, or 16) in the Pages per Side drop-down list. 4. Select the page order from the Page Order drop-down list, if necessary. 5. Check Print Page Border to print a border around each page on the sheet. 6. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source, and Type. 7. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Printing posters This feature allows you to print a single-page document onto 4, 9, or 16 sheets of paper, for the purpose of pasting the sheets together to form one poster-size document. 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Basic tab, select Poster Printing in the Type drop-down list. 3. Select the page layout you want. Available layouts: • Poster 2x2: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 4 pages. • Poster 3x3: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 9 pages. • Poster 4x4: Document will be enlarged and be divided into 16 pages. 4. Select the Poster Overlap value. Specify Poster Overlap in millimeters or inches by selecting the radio button on the upper right of Basic tab to make it easier to paste the sheets together. 5. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source, and Type. 6. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. 7. You can complete the poster by pasting the sheets together. Printing booklets (Manual) This feature prints your document on both sides of a paper and arranges the pages so that the paper can be folded in half after printing to produce a booklet. If you want to make a booklet, you need to print on Letter, Legal, A4, US Folio, or Oficio sized print media. 8 9 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access the Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Basic tab, select Booklet Printing from the Type drop-down list. 3. Click the Papertab, select the Size, Source, and Type. The Booklet Printing option is not available for all paper sizes. In order to find out the available paper size for this feature, select the available paper size in the Size option on the Paper tab. If you select an unavailable paper size, this option can be automatically canceled. Select only available paper. (paper without or mark). 4. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. 5. After printing, fold and staple the pages. Printing on both sides of the paper (Manual) You can print on both sides of a paper (duplex). Before printing, decide how you want your document oriented. You can use this feature with Letter, Legal, A4, US Folio, or Oficio sized paper (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). We recommend not to print on both sides of special media, such as labels, envelopes, or thick paper. It may cause a paper jam or damage the machine. 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Advanced tab.Printing_ 57 3. From the Double-Sided Printing (Manual) section, select the binding option you want. • None • Long Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in bookbinding. • Short Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in calendars. 4. Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source, and Type. 5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. If your machine does not have a duplex unit, you should complete the printing job manually. The machine prints every other page of the document first. After that, a message appears on your computer. Follow the on-screen instructions to complete the printing job. Change percentage of your document You can change the size of a document to appear larger or smaller on the printed page by typing in a percentage you want. 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Paper tab. 3. Enter the scaling rate in the Percentage input box. You can also click the up/down arrows to select the scaling rate. 4. Select the Size, Source, and Type in Paper Options. 5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Fitting your document to a selected paper size This feature allows you to scale your print job to any selected paper size regardless of the document size. This can be useful when you want to check fine details on a small document. A 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Paper tab. 3. Select the paper size you want from the Fit to Page. 4. Select the Size, Source, and Type in Paper Options. 5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Using watermarks The watermark option allows you to print text over an existing document. For example, you use it when you want to have large gray letters reading “DRAFT” or “CONFIDENTIAL” printed diagonally across the first page or all pages of a document. There are several predefined watermarks that come with the machine. They can be modified, or you can add new ones to the list. Using an existing watermark 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Advanced tab, and select the desired watermark from the Watermark drop-down list. You will see the selected watermark in the preview image. 3. Click OK or Print until you exit the print window. Creating a watermark 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears. 3. Enter a text message in the Watermark Message box. You can enter up to 256 characters. The message displays in the preview window. When the First Page Only box is checked, the watermark prints on the first page only. 4. Select watermark options. You can select the font name, style, size, and shade from the Font Attributes section, as well as set the angle of the watermark from the Message Angle section. 5. Click Add to add a new watermark to the Current Watermarks list. 6. When you have finished, click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. To stop printing the watermark, select None from the Watermark drop-down list. Editing a watermark 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears. 3. Select the watermark you want to edit from the Current Watermarks list and change the watermark message and options. 4. Click Update to save the changes. 5. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Printing_ 58 Deleting a watermark 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears. 3. Select the watermark you want to delete from the Current Watermarks list and click Delete. 4. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Using overlays An overlay is content you store on your hard disk drive that can be superimposed over any document you print. An overlay is often used to take the place of letterhead paper. Rather than using preprinted letterhead, you can create an overlay containing exactly the same information that is currently on your letterhead. To print a letter with your company’s letterhead, you do not need to load preprinted letterhead paper in the machine, instead you can just print the letterhead overlay on your document. Creating a new overlay To use a page overlay, you must create a new page overlay file containing your content. 1. Create or open a document containing the content you want to use in a new page overlay. Position the items exactly where you want them to appear when they are added to the original. 2. To save the document as an overlay, access Printing Preference. (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 3. Click the Advanced tab, and select Edit from the Text drop-down list. The Edit Overlay window appears. 4. In the Edit Overlay window, click Create. 5. In the Save As window, type a name of up to eight characters in the File name box. Select the destination path, if necessary. (The default is C:\Formover.) 6. Click Save. The name appears on the Overlay List. 7. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. 8. The file is not printed. Instead, it is stored on your computer hard disk drive. The overlay document size must match same as the document you print. Do not create an overlay with a watermark. Using an overlay After an overlay has been created, it is ready to be printed with your document. To print an overlay on your document: 1. Create or open the document you want to print. 2. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 3. Click the Advanced tab. 4. Select the desired overlay from the Text drop-down list. 5. If the overlay file you want does not appear in the Text drop-down list, select Edit from the list and click Load. Select the overlay file you want to use. If you have stored the overlay file you want to use in an external source, you can also load the file when you access the Open window. After you select the file, click Open. The file appears in the Overlay List box and is available for printing. Select the overlay from the Overlay List box. 6. If necessary, check Confirm Page Overlay When Printing box. If this box is checked, a message window appears each time you submit a document for printing, asking you to confirm that you wish to print an overlay over your document. If this box is not checked and an overlay has been selected, the overlay automatically prints with your document. 7. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. The selected overlay prints over your document. The resolution of the overlay document must match the resolution of the original print job. Deleting an overlay You can delete page overlays that you no longer use. 1. In the Printing Preferences window, click the Advanced tab. 2. Select Edit in the Overlay drop down list. 3. Select the overlay you want to delete from the Overlay List box. 4. Click Delete. 5. When the confirmation message window appears, click Yes. 6. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window. Print quality options Use the following Graphics options to adjust the print quality for your specific printing needs. 1. To change the print settings from your software application, access Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). 2. Click the Graphics tab. • The options you can select may vary depending on your printer model. • Refer to the help for each option’s information provided from the Printing Preferences. • Font/Text: Select Clear Text to print text sharper than on a normal document. Use All Text Black to print solid black, regardless of the color it appears on the screen. • Graphic Controller: Fine Edge allows you to emphasize edges of texts and fine lines for improving readability. • Advanced: Click this button, you can select Darkness and Toner Save features. - Darkness: The option adjusts the toner density on print output. The values are Normal, Light and Dark. - Toner Save: Selecting this option extends the life of your toner cartridge and reduces your cost per page without a significant reduction in print quality. On: Select this option to allow the machine to use less toner on each page. Off: Select this option if you do not wan to save toner when printing a document. 3. Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.Printing_ 59 CHANGING THE DEFAULT PRINT SETTINGS Most Windows applications will override settings you specify in the printer driver. Change all print settings available in the software application first, and change any remaining settings using the printer driver. 1. Click the Windows Start menu. 2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printers and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 3. Right-click your machine. 4. For Windows XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista, press Printing Preferences. For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select the Printing preferences. If Printing preferences item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. 5. Change the settings on each tab. 6. Click OK. If you want to change the settings for each print job, change it in Printing Preferences. SETTING YOUR MACHINE AS A DEFAULT MACHINE 1. Click the Windows Start menu. 2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printers and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 3. Select your machine. 4. Right-click your machine and select Set as Default Printer. For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2 If Set as default printer item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. PRINTING TO A FILE (PRN) You will sometimes need to save the print data as a file. You can print the document to a file instead of routing it directly to a printer. The document is saved with the printer formatting, such as font selection and color specifications, in a .prn file that can be printed on another printer. To save a print job as a file 1. Check the Print to file box at the Print window. 2. Click Print. 3. Type in the destination path and the file name, and then click OK. For example C:\Temp\file name. If you type in only the file name, the file is automatically saved in Documents and Settings or Users. The saved folder may differ, depending on your operating system or the application you are using. MACINTOSH PRINTING This chapter explains how to print using a Macintosh. You need to set the print environment before printing. • USB connected (See "Macintosh" on page 27). Printing a document When you print with a Macintosh, you need to check the printer driver setting in each application you use. Follow the steps below to print from a Macintosh: 1. Open an application and select the file you want to print. 2. Open the File menu and click Page Setup (Document Setup in some applications). 3. Choose your paper size, orientation, scaling, other options, and make sure that your machine is selected. Click OK. 4. Open the File menu and click Print. 5. Choose the number of copies you want and indicate which pages you want to print. 6. Click Print.Printing_ 60 Changing printer settings You can use advanced printing features provided by your machine. Open an application and select Print from the File menu. The machine name, which appears in the printer properties window may differ depending on the machine in use. Except for the name, the composition of the printer properties pane is similar to the following. • The setting options may differ depending on models and Macintosh OS versions. • The following panes may differ, depending on your operating system or the application you are using. The following pane is the first pane you will see when you open the printer properties pane. Select other advanced features from the drop down list. Layout The Layout dialog provides options to adjust how the document appears on the printed page. You can print multiple pages on one sheet of paper. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the following features. • Pages per Sheet: This option determines how many pages to be printed on one page (See "Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper" on page 60). • Layout Direction: This option allows you to select the printing direction on a page similar to the examples on UI. • Border: This option allows you to print a border around each page on the sheet. • Reverse Page Orientation: This option allows you to rotate paper 180 degrees. Graphics The Graphics dialog provides options for selecting Resolution. Select Graphics from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the graphic features. • Resolution (Quality): This option allows you to select the printing resolution. The higher the setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and graphics. A higher setting will also increase the time it takes to print a document. • Darkness: This option allows you to enhance the darkness of the printouts. The available options are Normal, Light, and Dark. Paper Set Paper Type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from which you want to print. This will let you get the best quality printout. If you load a different type of print material, select the corresponding paper type. Printer Settings The Printer Settings dialog provides Toner Save Mode, Reprint When Jammed, and Power Save options. Select Printer Settings from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the following features: • Toner Save Mode: Selecting this option extends the life of your toner cartridge and reduces your cost per page without a significant reduction in print quality. - Printer Setting: If you select this option, this feature is determined by the setting you’ve made from the machine (For some models, you cannot change the setting from the machine. In this case, the default setting is Off). - On: Select this option to allow the printer to use less toner on each page. - Off: Set this option if you do not need to save toner when printing a document. • Power Save: When this option is checked, the switches to the power save mode after a predetermined amount of time. Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper You can print more than one page on a single sheet of paper. This feature provides a cost-effective way to print draft pages. 1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu. 2. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation. In the Pages per Sheet drop-down list, select the number of pages you want to print on one sheet of paper. 3. Select the other options you want to use. 4. Click Print, then the machine prints the selected the number of pages you want to print on one sheet of paper. LINUX PRINTING Printing from applications There are several Linux applications that allow you to print using the Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS). You can print using any of these applications. 1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu. 2. Select Print directly using LPR.Printing_ 61 3. From the LPR GUI window, select the model name of your machine from the printer list and click Properties. 4. Change the print job properties using the following four tabs displayed at the top of the window. • General: This option allows you to change the paper size, the paper type, and the orientation of the documents. It enables the duplex feature, adds start and end banners, and changes the number of pages per sheet. • Text: This option allows you to specify the page margins and set the text options, such as spacing or columns. • Graphics: This option allows you to set image options that are used when printing images/files, such as color options, image size, or image position. • Advanced: This option allows you to set the print resolution, paper source and special print features. If an option is grayed out, it means that the grayed out option is not supported by your machine. 5. Click Apply to apply the changes and close the Properties window. 6. Click OK in the LPR GUI window to start printing. 7. The Printing window appears, allowing you to monitor the status of your print job. To abort the current job, click Cancel. Printing files You can print many different types of files on your machine using the standard CUPS way, directly from the command line interface. The CUPS LPR utility allows you to do that. But the drivers package replaces the standard LPR tool by a much more user-friendly LPR GUI program. To print any document file: 1. Type lpr from the Linux shell command line and press Enter. The LPR GUI window appears. When you type only lpr and press Enter, the Select file(s) to print window appears first. Just select any files you want to print and click Open. 2. From the LPR GUI window, select your machine from the list, and change the print job properties. 3. Click OK to start printing. Configuring printer properties Using the Printer Properties window provided by the Printers configuration, you can change the various properties for your printer. 1. Open the Unified Driver Configurator. If necessary, switch to Printers configuration. 2. Select your machine from the available printers list and click Properties. 3. The Printer Properties window opens. The following five tabs display at the top of the window: • General: This option allows you to change the printer location and name. The name entered in this tab displays on the printer list in Printers configuration. • Connection: This option allows you to view or select another port. If you change the machine port from USB to parallel or vice versa while in use, you must re-configure the machine port in this tab. • Driver: Allows you to view or select another printer driver. By clicking Options, you can set the default device options. • Jobs: This option shows the list of print jobs. Click Cancel job to cancel the selected job and select the Show completed jobs check box to see previous jobs on the job list. • Classes: This option shows the class that your machine is in. Click Add to Class to add your machine to a specific class or click Remove from Class to remove the machine from the selected class. 4. Click OK to apply the changes and close the Printer Properties window.Copying_ 62 8.copying This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for copying documents. This chapter includes: • Basic copying • Changing the settings for each copy • ID card copying When printing a fluorescent color, due to the property of the scanner, the result may differ from the original. BASIC COPYING The following is the normal procedure for copying your originals. 1. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 2. Enter the number of copies using the +/- buttons if necessary. You can copy an original up to 99 pages at a time. • If you press +/- buttons short, the number of one’s place appeared on the display increases or decreases one by one. • If you press +/- buttons long, the number of ten’s place appeared on the display increases or decreases one by one. 3. If you want to customize the copy settings including Darkness, Original Type and more by using the Printer Settings Utility (See "Changing the settings for each copy" on page 62). 4. Press Start button to begin copying. If you need to cancel the copying job during the operation, press Stop/Clear button and the copying will stop. CHANGING THE SETTINGS FOR EACH COPY Your machine provides default settings for copying so that you can quickly and easily make a copy. However, if you want to change the options for each copy, use the Printer Settings Utility. If you press Stop/Clear button on the control panel while setting the copy options, all of the options you have set for the current copy job will be canceled and returned to their default status. Or, they will automatically return to their default status after the machine completes the copy in progress. Original Type The original type setting is used to improve the copy quality by selecting the document type for the current copy job. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Settings. 3. Click Copy > Original Type. Select the appropriate value from the drop-down list, and then click Apply. • Text: Use for originals containing mostly text. • Text/Photo: Use for originals with mixed text and photographs. • Photo: Use when the originals are photographs. Darkness If you have an original containing faint marking and dark images, you can adjust the brightness to make a copy that is easier to read. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Copy > Darkness. Select the appropriate value from the drop-down list, and then click Apply. • Lightest: Works well with lightest print. • Light: Works well with light print. • Normal: Works well with standard typed or printed originals. • Dark: Works well with dark print. • Darkest: Works well with darkest print. Erasing background images You can set the machine to print an image without its background. This copy feature removes the background color and can be helpful when copying an original containing color in the background such as a newspaper or a catalog. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the Status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Copy > Auto Suppress Background. Select the appropriate value from the drop-down list, and then click Apply. • Off: Does not use this feature. • Auto: Optimizes the background. Setting the copy scan size 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Copy > Copy Scan Size. Select the appropriate value from the drop-down list, and then click Apply.Copying_ 63 ID CARD COPYING Your machine can print 2-sided originals on one sheet. The machine prints one side of the original on the upper half of the paper and the other side on the lower half without reducing the size of the original. This feature is helpful for copying a small-sized item such as business card. The original must be placed on the scanner glass to use this feature. 1. Place the front side of an original facing down on the scanner glass where arrows indicate as shown. Then, close the scanner lid. 2. Press ID Copy button on the control panel. Then, the Front LED on the control panel lights on. 3. Press Start button on the control panel. Your machine begins scanning the front side of an original. When scanning the front side of an original is finished the Back LED on the control panel lights on. 4. Turn the original over and place it on the scanner glass where arrows indicate as shown. Then, close the scanner lid. 5. Press Start button on the control panel to begin scanning the back side of an original. 6. The machine prints both sides of an original without reducing its size. • If you do not press Start button, only the front side will be copied. • If the original is larger than the printable area, some portions may not be printed. • If you press Stop/Clear button, the copy job is canceled.Scanning_ 64 9.scanning Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital files that can be stored on your computer. This chapter includes: • Basic scanning method • Scanning originals and sending to your computer (Scan to PC) • Using Samsung Scan and Fax manager • Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software • Scanning using the WIA driver • Macintosh scanning • Linux Scanning When scanning a fluorescent color, due to the property of the scanner, the result my differ from the original. The maximum resolution that can be achieved depends upon various factors, including a computer speed, available disk space, memory, the size of the image being scanned and color bit depth settings. Thus, depending on your system and what you are scanning, you may not be able to scan at a certain resolution, especially using enhanced resolution. Supported optional devices and features may differ according to your model. Check your model name (See "Features by Models" on page 18). BASIC SCANNING METHOD You can scan the originals with your machine via an USB cable or the network. • Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: Scan the originals from the control panel. Then, the scanned data will be stored in the connected computers My Documents folder. When you install all the software in the supplied CD, the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager is also automatically installed on your computer. This feature can be used via the local connection or the network connection (See "Using Samsung Scan and Fax manager" on page 64). • TWAIN: TWAIN is the one of a preset imaging applications. Scanning an image launches the selected application, enabling you to control the scanning process. This feature can be used via the local connection or the network connection (See "Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software" on page 65). • SmarThru: This program is the accompanying software for your machine. You can use this program to scan images or documents. This feature can be used via the local connection or the network connection (See "SmarThru" on page 70). • WIA: WIA stands for Windows Images Acquisition. To use this feature, your computer must be connected directly with the machine via an USB cable (See "Scanning using the WIA driver" on page 66). SCANNING ORIGINALS AND SENDING TO YOUR COMPUTER (SCAN TO PC) You can scan an image on the machine via the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program that is installed in your USB connected computer. Scan to PC feature only works when your machine is connected via USB. For USB connected machine This is a basic scanning method for USB-connected machine. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. Press Scan to button on the control panel. 4. Press Start button on the control panel to begin scanning. • Scanned image is saved in computer’s My Documents > My Pictures > Samsung folder. • You can use Twain driver to scan quickly in Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program. • From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > Scan and Fax Manager > Scan and Fax Manager > Quick Scan. USING SAMSUNG SCAN AND FAX MANAGER If you have installed the printer driver, the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program is installed too. For program information and the scanner's status, start Samsung Scan and Fax Manager. With this program, you can change scan settings and add or delete the folders where scanned documents are saved in your computer. The Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program can only be used in the Windows and Mac OS system. If you use the Macintosh, click the following link ("Setting scan information in Scan and Fax Manager" on page 67). 1. From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > Scan and Fax Manager > Scan and Fax Manager > Quick Scan. You can open Samsung Scan and Fax Manager by right-clicking the Smart Panel icon in the Windows task bar and selecting Scan and Fax Manager. 2. Select the appropriate machine from the Samsung Scan and Fax Manager window. 3. Press Properties. 4. The Set Scan Button tab allows you to change the file saving destination and scan settings, to add or delete application program, and to change the file format to be saved. You can change the scanning machine by using the Change Port tab (Local or Network). 5. When setting is done, press OK.Scanning_ 65 Set Scan Button tab Scan Destination • Available Destination List: Shows the list of applications currently linked to scanned images in the PC’s registry. Select the program you want to use and click the right arrow and add to Front Panel Destination List. • Front Panel Destination List: Shows the list of applications to open scanned image. You can choose only one application to open scanned image from the Available Destination List. • Add Application: Allows you to add application you want to use to Available Destination List. • Remove Application: Allows you to remove an item added by the user in the Available Destination List. • File Format: Allows you to select the form of scanned data to be saved. You can choose among BMP, JPEG, PDF and TIFF. Scan Property • Computer ID: Shows the ID of your computer. • Save Location: Allows you to choose the location of the default saving folder. • Resolution: Allows you to choose the scan resolution. • Scan Color: Allows you to choose the scan color. • Scan Size: Allows you to choose the scan size. • ADF Duplex: Automatically scans both sides. If your model does not support this option, it will be grayed out. • Show Preview: Checking this box allows you to preview applied scan options. You can modify the options before scanning. • Default: Allows you to go back to default options. Change Port tab Local Scanner Select when your machine is connected via USB port. Network Scanner Select when your machine is connected via network port. • Auto detection on the network: Automatically detects your machine. • IP or Host name: Enter in your machine’s IP address to detect your machine. Scan Assistant When you press Quick Scan in Samsung Scan and Fax Manager, the Scan Assistant window appears. Scan Assistant allows you to adjust scan settings and start the scanning process. • Favorites: Allows you to save the current preferences settings for future use. When you save Favorites, all current scan settings are saved. To use a saved setting, select it from the Favorites drop down list. The machine is now set to scan according to the setting you selected. To delete saved setting, select it from the Favorites drop down list and click Delete. To set a favorite as startup, select the favorite you want to set as startup, then click the Set as default button. • Scan settings: The following scan options are available. - Image Type: Allows you to chose the proper color settings for image scanning. - Resolution: Allows you to choose the image resolution. - Document Size: Allows you to choose the proper size of the scanned image. - Document Source: Allows you to choose the device (scan glass) you want to scan with. - Prompt for additional pages: If this check box is checked, you can scan pages continuously. This option is useful when you scan multi-page documents and/or when Document Source is set to Flatbed (platen glass). In this case a sequence of scanned images is processed as a single document. - Pages to Scan: Allows you to specify how many pages are to be scanned. This option is available when Document Source is set to ADF(Document feeder). • Preference: The following scan options are available. - Auto crop image after preview: If this option is checked, the scanning area will be automatically adjusted to the image size. - Preview on program start: If this option is checked, the scanning area will be selected automatically as shown in the preview. - Blank page detection: This operation automatically detects whether the scanned image is blank or not. - Delete page: Blank pages will be deleted at the end of the scanning process. - Separate files: Blank page will work as a scan job separator. That is, when multiple pages are scanned at once a blank page will divide scanned image sequence into parts. Each part will be treated as a separate document (group). - Start from scanner: If this option is checked, scanning process is managed using scanner touch screen rather than from the computer. The option is not available for some scanner models. • Advanced: In the Advanced mode, additional options such as Image Adjustment, Image Enhancement, and Additional Settings are available. - Image Adjustment: Allows you to perform some transformations of the scanned image. These transformations include automatic adjustment of image size, straightening and rotation. - Image Enhancement: Allows you to remove various defects of the image and improve its quality. - Additional settings: Allows special processing of scanned images. These transformations include stitching several partial image scans into a single image, processing of scanned books and watermark stamping. Click the Help button from the lower-left corner of the window and click on any option you want to know about. Then a pop up window appears with information about that option's feature which is provided from the Scan Assistant. SCANNING WITH TWAIN-ENABLED SOFTWARE If you want to scan documents using other software, you will need to use TWAIN-compliant software such as Adobe Photoshop. Follow the steps below to scan with TWAIN-compliant software. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. Open an application such as Adobe Photoshop. 4. Open the TWAIN window and set the scan options. 5. Scan and save your scanned image.Scanning_ 66 SCANNING USING THE WIA DRIVER Your machine also supports the Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) driver for scanning images. WIA is one of the standard components provided by Microsoft Windows XP and works with digital cameras and scanners. Unlike the TWAIN driver, the WIA driver allows you to scan and easily adjust images without using additional software. • The WIA driver works only on Windows XP/Vista/7 with a USB port. • Depending on the selected Control Panel view, the path may differ. Windows XP 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. From the Start menu, select Control Panel > Scanners and Cameras. 4. Double-click your scanner driver icon. The Scanner and Camera wizard appears. 5. Click Next. 6. Set the option in Choose scanning preferences window and click Preview to see how your options affect the picture. 7. Click Next. 8. Enter a picture name, and select a file format and destination to save the picture. 9. Your picture has been successfully copied to your computer. Choose one of the options on screen. 10.Click Next. 11.Click Finish. Windows Vista 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. From the Start menu select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Scanners and Cameras. 4. Double-click Scan a document or picture. Windows Fax and Scan application appears. • You can click on View scanners and cameras to view scanners, • If there is no Scan a document or picture, open the MS paint program and from the File click From Scanner or Camera... 5. Click New Scan. Scan driver appears. 6. Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your preferences affect the picture. 7. Click Scan. If you want to cancel the scan job, press Cancel button on the Scanner and Camera wizard. Windows 7 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. From the Start menu select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers > Printers and Faxes. 4. Click right button of mouse on device driver icon and select Start Scan. New Scan application appears. 5. Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your preferences affect the picture. 6. Click Scan. MACINTOSH SCANNING You can scan documents using Image Capture program. Mac OS offers Image Capture program. Scanning with USB 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. Start Applications and click Image Capture. If No camera or scanner connected message appears, disconnect the USB cable and reconnect it. If the problem persists, refer to the Image Capture’s help. 4. Set the scan options on this program. 5. Scan and save your scanned image. • For more information about using Image Capture, refer to the Image Capture’s help. • Use TWAIN-compliant software to apply more scan options. • You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop. • Scan process differ according to TWAIN-compliant software. Please refer to the user’s guide of the software. • If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to the latest version. Image Capture operates properly in Mac OS X 10.3.9 or higher and Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher. Scanning with network (SCX-3205W(K) only) 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 3. Start Applications and click Image Capture. 4. For Mac OS X 10.4 ~ 10.5 Click Devices and click Browse Devices. For Mac OS X 10.6 Select your device below SHARED. Skip to step 7. 5. For Mac OS X 10.4 Select your machine in TWAIN devices option. Make sure that Use TWAIN software check box is checked, and click Connect. • If a warning message appears, click Change Port.. to select port. • If TWAIN UI appears, from the Preference tab, click Change Port.. to select port. Refer to scan manager for Change port.. use (See "Setting scan information in Scan and Fax Manager" on page 67). For Mac OS X 10.5 Make sure that Connected check box is checked beside your machine Scanning_ 67 in Bonjour Devices. If you want to scan using TWAIN, refer to the Mac OS X 10.4 steps above. 6. Set the scan options on this program. 7. Scan and save your scanned image. • For Mac OS X 10.3, use TWAIN-compliant software. • For more information about using Image Capture, refer to the Image Capture’s help. • Use TWAIN-compliant software to apply more scan options. • You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop. • Scan process differ according to TWAIN-compliant software. Please refer to the user’s guide of the software. • If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to the latest version. Image Capture operates properly in Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher. Setting scan information in Scan and Fax Manager When you want to find out about Scan and Fax Manager program information, to check the installed scan driver's condition, to change scan settings and to add or delete the folders where scanned documents to computer are saved in Scan and Fax Manager program, follow the below steps. 1. From the Smart Panel menu on Status bar, click Scan and Fax Manager. 2. Select the appropriate machine from the Scan and Fax Manager. 3. Press Properties. 4. Use Set Scan Button to change the file destination or scan settings, to add or delete application programs, and to format files. You can change the scanning machine by using Change Port (Local or Network). 5. When done, press OK. LINUX SCANNING You can scan a document using the Unified Driver Configurator window. Scanning 1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on your desktop. 2. Click the button to switch to Scanners configuration. 3. Select the scanner on the list. If you use only one machine device and it is connected to the computer and turned on, your scanner appears on the list and is automatically selected. If you have two or more scanners connected to your computer, you can select any scanner to work at any time. For example, while acquisition is in progress on the first scanner, you may select the second scanner, set the device options and start the image acquisition simultaneously. 4. Click Properties. 5. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 6. From the Scanner Properties window, click Preview. The document is scanned and the image preview appears in the Preview Pane. 7. Drag the pointer to set the image area to be scanned in the Preview Pane. 8. Change the scan options in the Image Quality and Scan Area sections. • Image Quality: This option allows you to select the color composition and the scan resolution for the image. • Scan Area: This option allows you to select the page size. The Advanced button enables you to set the page size manually. If you want to use one of the preset scan option settings, select the option from the Job Type drop-down list (See "Adding Job Type Settings" on page 67). Click Default to restore the default setting for the scan options. 9. When you have finished, click Scan to start scanning. The status bar appears on the bottom left of the window to show you the progress of the scan. To cancel scanning, click Cancel. 10.The scanned image appears. If you want to edit the scanned image, use the toolbar (See "Using the Image Manager" on page 68). 11.When you are finished, click Save on the toolbar. 12.Select the file directory where you want to save the image and enter the file name. 13.Click Save. Adding Job Type Settings You can save your scan option settings for later use.Scanning_ 68 To save a new Job Type setting 1. Change the options from the Scanner Properties window. 2. Click Save As. 3. Enter the name for your setting. 4. Click OK. Your setting is added to the Saved Settings drop-down list. To save a Job Type setting for the next scan job 1. Select the setting you want to use from the Job Type drop-down list. 2. The next time you open the Scanner Properties window, the saved setting is automatically selected for the scan job. To delete a Job Type setting 1. Select the setting you want to delete from the Job Type drop-down list. 2. Click Delete. The setting is deleted from the list. Using the Image Manager The Image Manager application provides you with menu commands and tools to edit your scanned image. Use the following tools to edit the image. TOOLS NAME FUNCTION Save Saves the image. Undo Cancels your last action. Redo Restores the action you canceled. Scroll Allows you to scroll through the image. Crop Crops the selected image area. Zoom Out Zooms the image out. Zoom In Zooms the image in. Scale Allows you to scale the image size; you can enter the size manually, or set the rate to scale proportionally, vertically, or horizontally. Rotate Allows you to rotate the image; you can select the number of degrees from the drop-down list. Flip Allows you to flip the image vertically or horizontally. Brightness Allows you to adjust the brightness or contrast of the image, or to invert the image. Properties Shows the properties of the image. For further details about the Image Manager application, refer to the on screen help.Management tools_ 69 10.management tools This chapter introduces management tools provided to help you make full use of your machine. This chapter includes: • Introducing useful management tools • Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only) • Using the Smart Panel program • SmarThru • Using the Linux Unified Driver Configurator Supported optional devices and features may differ according to your model. Check your model name (See "Features by Models" on page 18). INTRODUCING USEFUL MANAGEMENT TOOLS The programs below help you to use your machine conveniently. • "Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only)" on page 69. • "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70. • "SmarThru" on page 70. • "Using the Linux Unified Driver Configurator" on page 71. USING SYNCTHRU™ WEB SERVICE (SCX-3205W(K) ONLY) Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for SyncThru™ Web Service. If you have connected your machine to a network and set up TCP/IP network parameters correctly, you can manage the machine via SyncThru™ Web Service, an embedded web server. Use SyncThru™ Web Service to: • View the machine’s device information and check its current status. • Change TCP/IP parameters and set up other network parameters. • Change printer preference. • Set the email notifications advising of the machine’s status. • Get support for using the machine. To access SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Access a web browser, such as Internet Explorer, from Windows. Enter the machine IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address field and press the Enter key or click Go. 2. Your machine’s embedded website opens. Logging into SyncThru™ Web Service Before configuring options in SyncThru™ Web Service, you need to log-in as an administrator. You can still use SyncThru™ Web Service without logging in but you won’t have access to Settings tab and Security tab. 1. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website. The Login window appears. 2. Type in the ID and Password then click Login. If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the below default ID and password. • ID: admin • Password: sec00000 SyncThru™ Web Service overview Some tabs may not appear depending on your model. Information tab This tab gives you general information about your machine. You can check things, such as remaining amount of toner. You can also print reports such as an error report and so on. • Active Alerts: This item allows you to check the alerts occurred in the machine and their severity. • Supplies: This item allows you to check how many pages are printed and amount of toner left in the cartridge. • Usage Counters: This item allows you to check the usage count by print types: simplex, duplex. • Current Settings: This item allows you to check the machine and network information. • Print information: This item allows you to print reports such as system related reports, e-mail address and font reports. Settings tab This tab allows you to set configurations provided by your machine and network. You need to log-in as an administrator to view this tab. • Machine Settings tab: This tab allows you to set options provided by your machine. - System: You can set settings related to your machine. - Printer: You can set settings related to printing jobs. - Copy: You can set settings related to copying jobs. • Network Settings tab: This tab allows you to view and change the network environment. You can set things, such as TCP/IP, network protocols and so on. - Restore Default: You can restore default network settings. Security tab This tab allows you to set system and network security information. You need to log-in as an administrator to view this tab. • System Security: You can set the system administrator’s information. • Network Security: You can set settings for IPv4/IPv6 filtering, 802.1x, Authentication servers.Management tools_ 70 Maintenance tab This tab allows you to maintain your machine by upgrading firmware and setting contact information for sending emails. You can also connect to Samsung website or download drivers by selecting the Link menu. • Firmware Upgrade: You can upgrade your machine’s firmware. • Contact Information: You can view the contact information. • Link: You can view the links to useful sites where you can download or check information. USING THE SMART PANEL PROGRAM The Smart Panel is a program that monitors and informs you of the machine status, and allows you to customize the machine’s settings. For Windows and Macintosh, Smart Panel is installed automatically when you install the machine software. For Linux, you can download Smart Panel from the Samsung website and install (See "Installing the Smart Panel" on page 28). To use this program, your computer has to meet the following system requirements: • Windows. Check that your computer’s CPU, RAM and HDD meet or exceed specification (See "System requirements" on page 25). • Mac OS X 10.3 or higher. Check that your computer’s CPU, RAM and HDD meet or exceed specification (See "System requirements" on page 25). • Linux. Check that your computer’s CPU, RAM and HDD meet or exceed specification (See "System requirements" on page 25). • Internet Explorer version 5.0 or higher for flash animation in HTML Help. If you need to know the exact model name of your machine, you can check the supplied software CD. Understanding Smart Panel If an error occurs while operating, you can check the error from the Smart Panel. You can also launch Smart Panel manually. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (in Windows), or Notification Area (in Linux). You can also click it on the status bar (in Mac OS X). Windows Double-click this icon in Windows. Macintosh Click this icon in Mac OS X. Linux Click this icon in Linux. Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. • If you have already installed more than one Samsung machine, first select the correct machine model you want in order to access the corresponding Smart Panel. Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart Panel icon and select your machine. • The Smart Panel window and its contents shown in this user’s guide may differ depending on the machine or operating system in use. The Smart Panel program displays the current status of the machine, the estimated level of toner remaining in each toner cartridge, and various other types of information. You can also change settings. 1 Toner Level You can view the level of toner remaining in each toner cartridge. The machine and the number of toner cartridge(s) shown in the above window may differ depending on the machine in use. Some machines do not have this feature. 2 Buy Now You can order replacement toner cartridge(s) from online. 3 User’s Guide You can view the online User’s Guide. This button changes to Troubleshooting Guide when error occurs. You can directly open the troubleshooting section in the user’s guide. 4 Printer Setting You can configure various machine settings in the Printer Settings Utility window. Some machines do not have this feature. If you connect your machine to a network, the SyncThru™ Web Service window appears instead of the Printer Settings Utility window. 5 Driver Setting You can set all of the machine options you need in the Printing Preferences window. This feature is available only for Windows (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). Changing the Smart Panel Program Settings Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart Panel icon and select Options. Select the settings you want from the Options window. SMARTHRU The supplied software CD provides you with SmarThru. SmarThru offers you convenient features to use with your machine. Starting SmarThru Follow the steps below to start SmarThru. 1. Make sure that your machine and computer are turned on and properly connected to each other. 2. Once you have installed SmarThru, you will see the SmarThru icon on your desktop.Management tools_ 71 3. Double-click the SmarThru icon. 4. The SmarThru appears. • Scan to: Allows you to scan an image and save it to an application or folder, email it, or publish it on a website. • Image: Allows you to edit an image you have saved as a graphic file and send it to a selected application or folder, email it, or publish it on a website. • Print: Allows you to print images you have saved. You can print images in black and white or color mode if your machine supports it. For more information about SmarThru, click at the top right corner of the window. The SmarThru help window appears; you can view on screen help supplied on the SmarThru program. Follow the steps below to uninstall SmarThru. Before you begin the uninstall, ensure that all applications are closed on your computer. a) From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs. b) Select Samsung Printers > SmarThru 4 > Uninstall SmarThru 4. c) When your computer asks you to confirm your selection, read the statement and click OK. d) Click Finish. Using SmarThru Scanning 1. Click Scan To. • Application: Scanning an image and placing it in an image editor application such as Paint or Adobe Photoshop. • E-mail: Scanning an image and emailing it. Allows you to scan an image, preview it, and email it. To send an image by e-mail, you must have a mail client program, like Outlook Express, which has been set up with your e-mail account. • Folder: Scanning an image and saving it to a folder. Allows you to scan an image, preview it, and save it to the folder of your choice. • OCR: Scanning an image and performing text recognition. Allows you to scan an image, preview it, and send it to the OCR program for text recognition. - Recommended scan option for OCR. - Resolution: 200 or 300 dpi. - Image type: grayscale or black & white. • Web: Scanning an image, previewing it, and publishing it on a website, using the specified file format for the image you want to publish. • Settings: Customizing settings of Scan To basic functions. Allows you to customize settings for Application, E-mail, OCR, and Web functions. 2. Set scan settings and click Scan. Printing 1. Click Print. 2. Select the file you want to print. 3. Select the machine you want to use for printing. 4. Click Print to start the job. USING THE LINUX UNIFIED DRIVER CONFIGURATOR The Unified Driver Configurator is a tool primarily intended for configuring machine devices. You need to install Unified Linux Driver to use Unified Driver Configurator (See "Installing the Unified Linux Driver" on page 28). After the driver is installed on your Linux system, the Unified Driver Configurator icon will automatically be created on your desktop. Opening the Unified Driver Configurator 1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on the desktop. You can also click the Startup Menu icon and select Samsung Unified Driver > Unified Driver Configurator. 2. Click each button on the left to switch to the corresponding configuration window.1 Printers Configuration 2 Scanners Configuration 3 Ports Configuration Management tools_ 72 To use the on screen help, click Help. 3. After changing the configurations, click Exit to close the Unified Driver Configurator. Printers configuration window Printers configuration has the two tabs: Printers and Classes. Printers tab View the current system’s printer configuration by clicking on the machine icon button on the left side of the Unified Driver Configurator window. 1 Switches to Printers configuration. 2 Shows all of the installed machine. 3 Shows the status, model name and URL of your machine. The printer control buttons are as follows: • Refresh: Renews the available machines list. • Add Printer: Allows you to add a new machines. • Remove Printer: Removes the selected machine. • Set as Default: Sets the current selected machine as a default machine. • Stop/Start: Stops/starts the machine. • Test: Allows you to print a test page to ensure the machine is working properly. • Properties: Allows you to view and change the printer properties. Classes tab The Classes tab shows a list of available machine classes. 1 Shows all of the machine classes. 2 Shows the status of the class and the number of machines in the class. • Refresh: Renews the classes list. • Add Class: Allows you to add a new machine class. • Remove Class: Removes the selected machine class.Management tools_ 73 Scanners configuration In this window, you can monitor the activity of scanner devices, view a list of installed Samsung machine devices, change device properties, and scan images. 1 Switches to Scanners configuration. 2 Shows all of the installed scanners. 3 Shows the vendor, model name and type of your scanner. • Properties: Allows you to change the scan properties and scan a document. Ports configuration In this window, you can view the list of available ports, check the status of each port, and release a port that is stalled in a busy state when its owner has terminated the job for any reason. 1 Switches to Ports configuration. 2 Shows all of the available ports. 3 Shows the port type, device connected to the port, and status. • Refresh: Renews the available ports list. • Release port: Releases the selected port. Sharing Ports Between Printers and Scanners Your machine may be connected to a host computer via a parallel port or USB port. Since the machine device contains more than one device (printer and scanner), it is necessary to organize proper access of “consumer” applications to these devices via the single I/O port. The Unified Linux Driver package provides an appropriate port sharing mechanism that is used by Samsung printer and scanner drivers. The drivers talk to their devices via so-called machine ports. The current status of any machine port can be viewed via the Ports configuration. The port sharing prevents you from accessing one functional block of the machine device, while another block is in use. When you install a new machine device onto your system, it is strongly recommended you do this with the assistance of an Unified Driver Configurator. In this case you will be asked to choose I/O port for the new device. This choice will provide the most suitable configuration for machine’s functionality. For machine scanners, I/O ports are being chosen by scanner drivers automatically, so proper settings are applied by default.Maintenance_ 74 11.maintenance This chapter provides information about maintaining your machine and the toner cartridge. This chapter includes: • Printing a machine report • Cleaning the machine • Storing the toner cartridge • Tips for moving & storing your machine PRINTING A MACHINE REPORT You can print a configuration page to view current printer settings, or to help troubleshoot printer problems. In ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button for about two seconds, then release. A configuration page prints out. CLEANING THE MACHINE If printing quality problems occur or if you use your machine in a dusty environment, you need to clean your machine regularly to keep the most optimum print quality. • Cleaning the cabinet of the machine with cleaning materials containing large amounts of alcohol, solvent or other strong substances can discolor or distort the cabinet. • If your machine or the surrounding area is contaminated with toner, we recommend that you use a cloth or tissue dampened with water to clean it. If you use a vacuum cleaner, toner blows in the air and might be harmful if inhaled. Cleaning the outside Clean the machine cabinet with a soft and lint-free cloth. Dampen the cloth slightly with water, but be careful not to let any water drip onto or into the machine. Cleaning the inside During the printing process, paper, toner and dust particles can accumulate inside the machine. This buildup can cause print quality problems such as toner specks or smearing. Cleaning the inside of the machine clears and reduces these problems. 1. Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for the machine to cool down. 2. Open the scan unit. 3. Open the inner cover. 4. Pull the toner cartridge out. • To prevent damage to the toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than few minutes. Cover it with a piece of paper, if necessary.Maintenance_ 75 • Do not touch the green surface of the drum located in the toner cartridge or imaging unit. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area. 5. With a dry and lint-free cloth, wipe away any dust and spilled toner from the toner cartridges area. While cleaning the inside of the machine, be careful not to damage the transfer roller or any other inside parts. Do not use solvents such as benzene or thinner to clean. Printing quality problems can occur and cause damage to the machine. After cleaning, let the machine to dry completely. 6. Reinsert the toner cartridge. 7. Close the inner cover and the scan unit completely in order. 8. Plug in the power cord and turn the machine on. Cleaning the scan unit Keeping the scan unit clean helps ensure the best possible copies. We suggest that you clean the scan unit at the start of each day and during the day as needed. 1. Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water. 2. Open the scanner lid. 3. Wipe the surface of the scanner glass until it is clean and dry. 4. Close the scanner lid. STORING THE TONER CARTRIDGE Toner cartridge storage Toner cartridges contain components that are sensitive to light, temperature, and humidity. Samsung suggests users follow the recommendations to ensure the optimum performance, highest quality, and longest life from your new Samsung toner cartridge. Store this cartridge in the same environment as the printer it will be used in; this should be in controlled office temperature and humidity conditions. The toner cartridge should remain in its original, unopened package until installation – If original packaging is not available, cover the top opening of the cartridge with paper and store in a dark cabinet. Opening the cartridge package prior to use dramatically shortens its useful shelf and operating life. Do not store on the floor. If the toner cartridge is removed from the printer, always store the cartridge according to the following guidelines: • Inside the protective bag from the original package. • Store lying flat (not standing on end) with the same side facing up as if was installed in the machine. • Do not store consumable in any of the following conditions: - Temperature greater than 40°C (104°F). - Humidity range less than 20% and not greater than 80%. - An environment with extreme changes in humidity or temperature. - Direct sunlight or room light.Maintenance_ 76 - Dusty places. - A car for a long period of time. - An environment where corrosive gases are present. - An environment with salty air. Handling instructions • Do not touch the surface of the photoconductive drum in the cartridge. • Do not expose the cartridge to unnecessary vibrations or shock. • Never manually rotate the drum, especially in the reverse direction; this can cause internal damage and toner spillage. Use of non-Samsung and refilled toner cartridge Samsung Electronics does not recommend or approve the use of non-Samsung brand toner cartridges in your printer including generic, store brand, refilled, or remanufactured toner cartridges. Samsung’s printer warranty does not cover damage to the machine caused by the use of a refilled, remanufactured, or non-Samsung brand toner cartridge. Estimated cartridge life Estimated cartridge life (the life of the toner cartridge yield) depends on the amount of toner that print jobs require. The actual print yield may vary depending on the print density of the pages you print on, operating environment, printing interval, media type, and/or media size. For example, if you print a lot of graphics, the consumption of the toner is high and you may need to change the cartridge more often. TIPS FOR MOVING & STORING YOUR MACHINE • When moving the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down. Otherwise, the inside of the machine may be contaminated by toner, which can cause damage to the machine or reduce print quality.Troubleshooting_ 77 12.troubleshooting This chapter gives helpful information for what to do if you encounter an error. This chapter includes: • Redistributing toner • Tips for avoiding paper jams • Clearing paper jams • Solving other problems REDISTRIBUTING TONER When the toner cartridge is near the end of its life: • White streaks or light printing occurs. • The Status LED blinks red. If this happens, you can temporarily improve print quality by redistributing the remaining toner in the cartridge. In some cases, white streaks or light printing will still occur even after you have redistributed the toner. 1. Open the scan unit. 2. Open the inner cover. 3. Pull the toner cartridge out. 4. Thoroughly roll the cartridge five or six times to distribute the toner evenly inside the cartridge. If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric. Do not touch the drum in the toner cartridge or imaging unit. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area. 5. Hold the toner cartridge by the handle and slowly insert the cartridge into the opening in the machine. The tabs on the sides of the cartridge and corresponding grooves within the machine will guide the cartridge into the correct position until it locks Troubleshooting_ 78 into place completely. 6. Close the inner cover and the scan unit completely in order. Ensure that they are securely closed. TIPS FOR AVOIDING PAPER JAMS By selecting the correct media types, most paper jams can be avoided. When a paper jam occurs, refer to the guidelines below: • Ensure that the adjustable guides are positioned correctly (See "Loading paper in the tray" on page 50). • Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper capacity mark on the inside of the tray. • Do not remove paper from the tray while your machine is printing. • Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading. • Do not use creased, damp, or highly curled paper. • Do not mix paper types in a tray. • Use only recommended print media. • Ensure that the recommended side of the print media is facing the right side (See "Loading paper in the tray" on page 50). • If duplexing, print one sheet at a time using Start button (See "Printing on both sides of the paper (Manual)" on page 56). • If you are printing on a special paper, print one sheet at a time using Start button (See "Manual feeding in the tray" on page 50). CLEARING PAPER JAMS If a paper jam occurs, the Status LED on the control panel lights orange. Find and remove the jammed paper. To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out slowly and carefully. Follow the instructions in the following sections to clear the jam. 2 1 1 Scan unit 2 Inner cover In the tray Click this link to open an animation about clearing a jam. 1. Open the scan unit first, and then the inner cover. 2. Close the inner cover. The jammed paper is automatically ejected from the machine. If the paper does not eject, go to the next step.Troubleshooting_ 79 3. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight out. If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper in this area, check inside the machine (See "Inside the machine" on page 79). 4. Close the inner cover and the scan unit in order. Printing automatically resumes. Inside the machine Click this link to open an animation about clearing a jam. The fuser area is hot. Be careful when removing paper from this area to prevent getting your fingers burnt. 1. Open the scan unit first, and then the inner cover. 2. Close the inner cover. The jammed paper is automatically ejected from the machine. If the paper does not eject, go to the next step. 3. Open the inner cover. 4. Open the fuser unit cover. 5. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight out. If you do not see the jammed paper, go to the next step.Troubleshooting_ 80 6. Pull the toner cartridge out. 7. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight out. 8. Insert the toner cartridge back into the machine. 9. Close the inner cover and the scan unit in order. Printing automatically resumes. SOLVING OTHER PROBLEMS The following chart lists some trouble conditions that may occur and the recommended solutions. Follow the suggested solutions until the problem is corrected. If the problem persists, contact a service representative. Other problems include: • See "Power problems" on page 81. • See "Paper feeding problems" on page 81. • See "Printing problems" on page 82. • See "Printing quality problems" on page 83. • See "Copying problems" on page 85. • See "Scanning problems" on page 86. • See "Samsung Scan and Fax Manager Problem" on page 86. • See "Common Windows problems" on page 87. • See "Common Linux problems" on page 87. • See "Common Macintosh problems" on page 88.Troubleshooting_ 81 Power problems Click this link to open an animation about solving power problems. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The machine is not receiving power, or the connection cable between the computer and the machine is not connected properly. • Plug in the power cord and press Power button on the control panel. • Disconnect the machine cable and reconnect it. - For Local Printing - For Network Printing (SCX-3205W(K) only) Paper feeding problems CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS Paper jams during printing. Clear the paper jam (See "Clearing paper jams" on page 78). Paper sticks together. • Check the maximum paper capacity of the tray (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Make sure that you are using the correct type of paper (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Remove paper from the tray and flex or fan the paper. • Humid conditions may cause some paper to stick together, replace with a new stack. Multiple sheets of paper do not feed. Different types of paper may be stacked in the tray. Load paper of only one type, size, and weight. Paper does not feed into the machine. • Remove any obstructions from inside the machine. • Paper has not been loaded correctly. Remove paper from the tray and reload it correctly. • There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess paper from the tray. • The paper is too thick. Use only paper that meets the specifications required by the machine (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). The paper keeps jamming. • There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess paper from the tray. If you are printing on special materials, use the manual feeder. • An incorrect type of paper is being used. Use only paper that meets the specifications required by the machine (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • There may be debris inside the machine. Clean the machine inside (See Cleaning the inside). Transparencies stick together in the paper exit. Use only transparencies specifically designed for laser printers. Remove each transparency as it exits from the machine. Envelopes skew or fail to feed correctly. Ensure that the paper guides are against both sides of the envelopes.Troubleshooting_ 82 Printing problems CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSE SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The machine does not print. The machine is not receiving power. Check the power cord connections. The machine is not selected as the default machine. Select your machine as your default machine in your Windows. Check the machine for the followings: • The scan unit is not closed. Close the scan unit. • Paper is jammed. Clear the paper jam (See "Clearing paper jams" on page 78). • No paper is loaded. Load paper (See "Loading paper in the tray" on page 50). • The toner cartridge is not installed. Install the toner cartridge. If a system error occurs, contact a service representative. The connection cable between the computer and the machine is not connected properly. Disconnect the machine cable and reconnect it. The connection cable between the computer and the machine is defective. If possible, attach the cable to another computer that is working properly and print a job. You can also try using a different machine cable. The port setting is incorrect. Check the Windows printer settings to make sure that the print job is sent to the correct port. If the computer has more than one port, make sure that the machine is attached to the correct one. The machine may be configured incorrectly. Check the Printing Preferences to ensure that all of the print settings are correct (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). The printer driver may be incorrectly installed. Repair the machine software (See "Installing USB connected machine’s driver" on page 26). The machine is malfunctioning. • Check the LEDs on the control panel to see if the machine is indicating a system error. If the error cannot be cleared, contact a service representative. • Checking an error message is also possible from the Smart Panel on your computer (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). The machine does not print. The document size is so big that the hard disk space of the computer is insufficient to access the print job. Allocate more hard disk space on your computer for spooling, and try printing. The output tray is full. It can hold up to 50 (80 g/m2 ) sheets of plain paper. Once the paper is removed from the output tray, the machine resumes printing. The machine selects print materials from the wrong paper source. The paper option that was selected in the Printing Preferences may be incorrect. For many software applications, the paper source selection is found under the Paper tab within the Printing Preferences. Select the correct paper source. See the printer driver help scree. (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). A print job is extremely slow. The job may be very complex. Reduce the complexity of the page or try adjusting the print quality settings. Half the page is blank. The page orientation setting may be incorrect. Change the page orientation in your application. See the printer driver help screen. The paper size and the paper size settings do not match. Ensure that the paper size in the printer driver settings matches the paper in the tray. Or, ensure that the paper size in the printer driver settings matches the paper selection in the software application settings you use. The machine prints, but the text is wrong, garbled, or incomplete. The machine cable is loose or defective. Disconnect the machine cable and reconnect. Try a print job that you have already printed successfully. If possible, attach the cable and the machine to another computer that you know works and try a print job. Finally, try a new machine cable. The wrong printer driver was selected. Check the application’s printer selection menu to ensure that your machine is selected. The software application is malfunctioning. Try printing a job from another application. The operating system is malfunctioning. Exit Windows and reboot the computer. Turn the machine off and back on again. CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSE SUGGESTED SOLUTIONSTroubleshooting_ 83 Printing quality problems If the inside of the machine is dirty or paper has been loaded improperly, there might be a reduction in print quality. See the table below to clear the The machine problem. prints, but the text is wrong, garbled, or incomplete. If you are in a DOS environment, the font setting for your machine may be set incorrectly. See "Changing font setting" on page 47. Pages print, but they are blank. The toner cartridge is defective or out of toner. Redistribute the toner, if necessary. If necessary, replace the toner cartridge. The file may have blank pages. Check the file to ensure that it does not contain blank pages. Some parts, such as the controller or the board, may be defective. Contact a service representative. The machine does not print PDF files correctly. Some graphics, text, or illustrations are missing. Incompatibility between the PDF file and the Acrobat products. Printing the PDF file as an image may enable the file to print. Turn on Print As Image from the Acrobat printing options. It will take longer to print when you print a PDF file as an image. The print quality of photos is not good. Images are not clear. The resolution of the photo is very low. Reduce the photo size. If you increase the photo size in the software application, the resolution will be reduced. Before printing, the machine emits vapor near the output tray. Using damp paper can cause vapor during printing. This is not a problem. Just keep printing. The machine does not print special- sized paper, such as billing paper. Paper size and paper size setting do not match. Set the correct paper size in the Edit... in the Paper tab in the Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSE SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS Light or faded print • If a vertical white streak or faded area appears on the page, the toner supply is low. You may be able to temporarily extend the toner cartridge life (See "Redistributing toner" on page 77). If this does not improve the print quality, install a new toner cartridge. • The paper may not meet paper specification; for example, the paper may be too moist or rough (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • If the entire page is light, the print resolution setting is too low or the toner save mode is on. Adjust the print resolution and turn the toner save mode off. See the help screen of the printer driver. • A combination of faded or smeared defects may indicate that the toner cartridge needs cleaning (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). Toner specks • The paper may not meet specification; for example, the paper may be too moist or rough (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the inside of your machine. Contact a service representative. • The paper path may need cleaning. Contact a service representative (See "Clearing paper jams" on page 78). Dropouts If faded areas, generally rounded, occur randomly on the page: • A single sheet of paper may be defective. Try reprinting the job. • The moisture content of the paper is uneven or the paper has moist spots on its surface. Try a different brand of paper (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • The paper lot is bad. The manufacturing processes can cause some areas to reject toner. Try a different kind or brand of paper. • Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab, and set type to Thick (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). • If these steps do not correct the problem, contact a service representative.Troubleshooting_ 84 White Spots If white spots appear on the page: • The paper is too rough and a lot of dirt from a paper falls to the inner devices within the machine, so the transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the inside of your machine (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). • The paper path may need cleaning (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). Vertical lines If black vertical streaks appear on the page: • The surface (drum part) of the toner cartridge inside the machine has probably been scratched. Remove the toner cartridge and install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). If white vertical streaks appear on the page: • The surface of the LSU part inside the machine may be dirty (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). Black background If the amount of background shading becomes unacceptable: • Change to a lighter weight paper (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Check the environmental conditions: very dry conditions or a high level of humidity (higher than 80% RH) can increase the amount of background shading. • Remove the old toner cartridge and, install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). Toner smear If toner smears on the page: • Clean the inside of the machine (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). • Check the paper type and quality (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Remove the toner cartridge and then, install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). Vertical repetitive defects If marks repeatedly appear on the printed side of the page at even intervals: • The toner cartridge may be damaged. If you still have the same problem, remove the toner cartridge and, install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). • Parts of the machine may have toner on them. If the defects occur on the back of the page, the problem will likely correct itself after a few more pages. • The fusing assembly may be damaged. Contact a service representative. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS Background scatter A Background scatter results from bits of toner randomly distributed on the printed page. • The paper may be too damp. Try printing with a fresh ream of paper. Do not open packages of paper until necessary so that the paper does not absorb too much moisture. • If background scatter occurs on an envelope, change the printing layout to avoid printing over areas that have overlapping seams on the reverse side. Printing on seams can cause problems. • If background scatter covers the entire surface area of a printed page, adjust the print quality through your software application or in Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). Toner particles are around bold characters or pictures The toner might not adhere properly to this type of paper. • Change the printer option and try again. Go to the Printing Preferences, click the Paper tab, and set the paper type to Recycled. Misformed characters • If characters are improperly formed and producing hollow images, the paper stock may be too slick. Try different paper (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). Page skew A aBbC A aBbC A aBbC A aBbC A aBbCc • Ensure that the paper is loaded properly. • Check the paper type and quality (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Ensure that the guides are not too tight or too loose against the paper stack. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONSTroubleshooting_ 85 Copying problems Curl or wave • Ensure that the paper is loaded properly. • Check the paper type and quality. Both high temperature and humidity can cause paper curl (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating the paper 180° in the tray. Wrinkles or creases • Ensure that the paper is loaded properly. • Check the paper type and quality (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating the paper 180° in the tray. Back of printouts are dirty Check for leaking toner. Clean the inside of the machine (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). Solid Color or Black pages A • The toner cartridge may not be installed properly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert it. • The toner cartridge may be defective. Remove the toner cartridge and install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). • The machine may require repair. Contact a service representative. Loose toner • Clean the inside of the machine (See "Cleaning the inside" on page 74). • Check the paper type and quality (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). • Remove the toner cartridge and then, install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). • If the problem persists, the machine may require repair. Contact a service representative. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS Character Voids A Character voids are white areas within parts of characters that should be solid black: • If you are using transparencies, try another type of transparency. Because of the composition of transparencies, some character voids are normal. • You may be printing on the wrong surface of the paper. Remove the paper and turn it over. • The paper may not meet paper specifications (See "Print media specifications" on page 93). Horizontal stripes A aBbC A aBbC A aBbC A aBbC A aBbC If horizontally aligned black streaks or smears appear: • The toner cartridge may be installed improperly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert it. • The toner cartridge may be defective. Remove the toner cartridge and install a new one (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). • If the problem persists, the machine may require repair. Contact a service representative. Curl If the printed paper is curled or paper does not feed into the machine: • Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating the paper 180° in the tray. • Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab, and set type to Thin (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). An unknown image repetitively appears on a few sheets or loose toner, light print, or contamination occurs. Your machine is probably being used at an altitude of 1,000 m (3,281 ft.) or above. The high altitude may affect the print quality such as loose toner or light imaging. You can select a correct altitude of your machine location (See "Altitude adjustment" on page 46). CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTION Copies are too light or too dark. Adjust darkness to lighten or darken the backgrounds of copies using Printer Settings Utility (See "Changing the settings for each copy" on page 62). CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONSTroubleshooting_ 86 Scanning problems CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The scanner does not work. • Make sure that you place the original to be scanned face down on the scanner glass. • There may not be enough available memory to hold the document you want to scan. Try the Prescan function to see if that works. Try lowering the scan resolution rate. • Check that the machine cable is connected properly. • Make sure that the machine cable is not defective. Switch the cable with a known good cable. If necessary, replace the cable. • Check that the scanner is configured correctly. Check scan setting in the SmarThru or the application you want to use to make certain that the scanner job is being sent to the correct port (for example, USB001). The unit scans very slowly. • Check if the machine is printing received data. If so, scan the document after the received data has been printed. • Graphics are scanned more slowly than text. Message appears on your computer screen: • Device can’t be set to the H/W mode you want. • Port is being used by another program. • Port is Disabled. • Scanner is busy receiving or printing data. When the current job is completed, try again. • Invalid handle. • Scanning has failed. • There may be a copying or printing job in progress. Try your job again when that job is finished. • The selected port is currently being used. Restart your computer and try again. • The machine cable may be improperly connected or the power may be off. • The scanner driver is not installed or the operating environment is not set up properly. • Ensure that the machine is properly connected and the power is on, then restart your computer. • The USB cable may be improperly connected or the power may be off. Samsung Scan and Fax Manager Problem CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTION Samsung Scan and Fax Manager does not work. Check your system requirements. Samsung Scan and Fax Manager works in Windows and Mac OS (See "System requirements" on page 25). Smears, lines, marks, or spots appear on copies. • If the defects are on the original, adjust darkness to lighten the background of your copies using Printer Settings Utility (See "Changing the settings for each copy" on page 62). • If there are no defects on the original, clean the scan unit (See "Cleaning the scan unit" on page 75). Copy image is skewed. • Ensure that the original is face down on the scanner glass. • Check that the copy paper is loaded correctly. Blank copies print out. Ensure that the original is face down on the scanner glass. Image rubs off the copy easily. • Replace the paper in the tray with paper from a new package. • In high humidity areas, do not leave paper in the machine for extended periods of time. Frequent copy paper jams occur. • Fan the stack of paper, then turn it over in the tray. Replace the paper in the tray with a fresh supply. Check/adjust the paper guides, if necessary. • Ensure that the paper is the proper paper weight. • Check for copy paper or pieces of copy paper remaining in the machine after a paper jam has been cleared. Toner cartridge produces fewer copies than expected before running out of toner. • Your originals may contain pictures, solids, or heavy lines. For example, your originals may be forms, newsletters, books, or other documents that use more toner. • The scanner lid may be left open while copies are being made. • Turn the machine off and back on. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONTroubleshooting_ 87 Common Windows problems CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS “File in Use” message appears during installation. Exit all software applications. Remove all software from the startup group, then restart Windows. Reinstall the printer driver. “General Protection Fault”, “Exception OE”, “Spool 32”, or “Illegal Operation” messages appear. Close all other applications, reboot Windows and try printing again. “Fail To Print”, “A printer timeout error occurred” messages appear. These messages may appear during printing. Just keep waiting until the machine finishes printing. If the message appears in ready mode or after printing has been completed, check the connection and/or whether an error has occurred. Refer to the Microsoft Windows User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Windows error messages. Common Linux problems CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The machine does not print. • Check if the printer driver is installed in your system. Open Unified Driver Configurator and switch to the Printers tab in Printers configuration window to look at the list of available machines. Make sure that your machine is displayed on the list. If not, open Add new printer wizard to set up your device. • Check if the machine is started. Open Printers configuration and select your machine on the printers list. Look at the description in the Selected printer pane. If its status contains Stopped string, press Start button. After that normal operation of the machine should be restored. The “stopped” status might be activated when some problems in printing occurred. For instance, this could be an attempt to print a document when the port is claimed by a scanning application. • Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional components of machine (printer and scanner) share the same I/O interface (port), the situation of simultaneous access of different user applications to the same port is possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them at a time is allowed to gain control over the device. The other user will encounter “device busy” response. You should open ports configuration and select the port assigned to your machine. In the Selected port pane you can see if the port is occupied by some other application. If this is the case, you should either wait for completion of the current job or press the Release port button, if you are sure that the present application is not functioning properly. • Check if your application has special print option such as “-oraw”. If “-oraw” is specified in the command line parameter, then remove it to print properly. For Gimp front-end, select “print” -> “Setup printer” and edit command line parameter in the command item. • The CUPS (Common Unix Printing System) version distributed with SuSE Linux 9.2 (cups-1.1.21) has a problem with ipp (Internet Printing Protocol) printing.Use the socket printing instead of ipp or install a later version of CUPS (cups-1.1.22 or higher). The machine does not print whole pages, and output is printed on half the page. It is a known problem that occurs when a color machine is used on version 8.51 or earlier of Ghostscript, 64-bit Linux OS, and has been reported to bugs.ghostscript.com as Ghostscript Bug 688252.The problem is solved in AFPL Ghostscript v. 8.52 or above. Download the latest version of AFPL Ghostscript from http://sourceforge.net/projects/ghostscript/ and install it to solve this problem.Troubleshooting_ 88 Refer to the Linux User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Linux error messages. Common Macintosh problems CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The machine does not print PDF files correctly. Some parts of graphics, text, or illustrations are missing. Printing the PDF file as an image may enable the file to print. Turn on Print As Image from the Acrobat printing options. It will take longer to print when you print a PDF file as an image. The document has printed, but the print job has not disappeared from the spooler in Mac OS X 10.3.2. Update your Mac OS to Mac OS X 10.3.3. or higher. Some letters are not displayed normally during the Cover page printing. Mac OS cannot create the font during the Cover page printing. The English alphabet and numbers are displayed normally on the Cover page. When printing a document in Macintosh with Acrobat Reader 6.0 or higher, colors print incorrectly. Make sure that the resolution setting in your machine driver matches the one in Acrobat Reader. Refer to the Macintosh User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Macintosh error messages. I cannot scan via Gimp Front-end. Check if Gimp Front-end has Xsane: Device dialog on the Acquire menu. If not, you should install Xsane plug-in for Gimp on the your computer. You can find Xsane plug-in package for Gimp on Linux distribution CD or Gimp home page. For the detailed information, refer to the Help for Linux distribution CD or Gimp Front-end application. If you wish to use another kind of scan application, refer to application’s Help. I encounter the “Cannot open port device file” error when printing a document. Avoid changing print job parameters (via LPR GUI, for example) while a print job is in progress. Known versions of CUPS server break the print job whenever print options are changed and then try to restart the job from the beginning. Since Unified Linux Driver locks the port while printing, the abrupt termination of the driver keeps the port locked and unavailable for subsequent print jobs. If this situation occurs, try to release the port by selecting Release port in Port configuration window. The machine does not appear on the scanners list. • Ensure your machine is attached to your computer, connected properly via the USB port, and is turned on. • Ensure the scanner driver for your machine is installed in your system. Open Unified Linux Driver configurator, switch to Scanners configuration, then press Drivers. Make sure that driver with a name corresponding to your machine's name is listed in the window. • Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional components of machine (printer and scanner) share the same I/O interface (port), the situation of simultaneous access of different user applications to the same port is possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them at a time is allowed to gain control over the device. The other user will encounter “device busy” response. This usually happens when starting a scan procedure. An appropriate message box appears. To identify the source of the problem, open the Ports configuration and select the port assigned to your scanner, port's symbol /dev/mfp0 corresponds to LP:0 designation displayed in the scanners’ options, /dev/mfp1 relates to LP:1, and so on. USB ports start at /dev/mfp4, so scanner on USB:0 relates to /dev/mfp4 respectively and so forth sequentially. In the Selected port pane, you can see if the port is occupied by another application. If this is the case, you should either wait for completion of the current job or press the Release port button, if you are sure that the present port application is not functioning properly. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS The machine does not scan. • Ensure a document is loaded into the machine, ensure your machine is connected to the computer. • If there is an I/O error while scanning. CONDITION SUGGESTED SOLUTIONSSupplies_ 89 13.supplies This chapter provides information about purchasing supplies and maintenance parts available for your machine. This chapter includes: • How to purchase • Available supplies • Available maintenance parts • Replacing the toner cartridge Available accessories may differ from country to country. Contact your sales representatives to obtain the list of available accessories. HOW TO PURCHASE To order Samsung-authorized supplies, accessories, and maintenance parts, contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you purchased your machine. You can also visit www.samsung.com/supplies, select your country/region, and obtain information on calling for service. AVAILABLE SUPPLIES When supplies reach their lifespan, you can order the following types of supplies for your machine: MODEL NUMBER • 104 (MLT-D104S): Available in all regions except those listed in Region A and B. • 1042 (MLT-D1042S): Region Aa a.Region A: Albania, Austria, Belgium, Bosnia, Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Hungary, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Macedonia, Netherlands, Norway, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Serbia, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, UK. • 1043 (MLT-D1043S): Region Bb : b.Region B: China, Bangladesh, India, Nepal, Ukraine, Vietnam. • 104 (MLT-D104X): Not available in all regions. *Refer to your local Samsung website for availability. To replace a toner cartridge, see "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89. Depending on the options and job mode used, the toner cartridge’s lifespan may differ. You must purchase supplies, including toner cartridges, in the same country where you purchased your machine. Otherwise, supplies will be incompatible with your machine since the system configuration of these vary from country to country. Samsung does not recommend using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge such as refilled or remanufactured. Samsung cannot guarantee non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge's quality. Service or repair required as a result of using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridges will not be covered under the machine warranty. AVAILABLE MAINTENANCE PARTS To purchase maintenance parts, contact the source where you bought the machine. Replacing maintenance parts can be performed only by an authorized service provider, dealer, or the retailer where you bought the machine. The warranty does not cover the replacement of any maintenance parts once it has reached its “Average Yield”. Maintenance parts are replaced at specific intervals to avoid print quality and paper feed problems resulting from worn parts, see table below. The purpose of which is to maintain your machine in top working condition. The maintenance parts below should be replaced when the life span of each item has been met. PARTS AVERAGE YIELDA a.Yield is affected by operating system used, computing performance, application software, connecting method, media type, media size, and job complexity. Transfer roller Approx. 30,000 pages Fuser unit Approx. 30,000 pages Pickup roller Approx. 30,000 pages REPLACING THE TONER CARTRIDGE Click this link to open an animation about replacing a toner cartridge. When the toner cartridge reaches its estimated cartridge life, • The Smart Panel program window appears on the computer telling you the toner cartridge needs to be replaced. • The machine stops printing. At this stage, the toner cartridge needs to be replaced. Check the model number for the toner cartridge used in your machine (See "Available supplies" on page 89).Supplies_ 90 1. Turn the machine off, then wait a few minutes for the machine to cool. 2. Open the scan unit. 3. Open the inner cover. 4. Pull the toner cartridge out. 5. Take a new toner cartridge out of its package. 6. Slowly shake the cartridge side to side five or six times to distribute the toner evenly inside the cartridge. It will assure maximum copies per cartridge. If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric. Do not touch the drum located in the toner cartridge or imaging unit. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area. 7. Remove the cap protecting the toner cartridge. 8. Hold the toner cartridge by the handle and slowly insert the cartridge into the opening in the machine. Tabs on the sides of the cartridge and corresponding grooves within the machine will guide the cartridge into the correct position until it locks into place completely. 9. Close the inner cover and the scan unit completely in order. 10.Turn the machine on.Specifications_ 91 14.specifications This chapter covers the machines primary specifications. This chapter includes: • Hardware specifications • Environmental specifications • Electrical specifications • Print media specifications The specification values are listed below: specifications are subject to change without notice: See www.samsung.com/printer for possible changes in information. HARDWARE SPECIFICATIONS ITEM DESCRIPTION Dimension Height 234 mm (9.21 inches) Depth 299 mm (11.77 inches) Width 388 mm (15.28 inches) Weight Machine with consumables 7.5 kg (16.53 lbs) Package weight Paper 1.22 kg (2.69 lbs) Plastic 0.24 kg (0.52 lbs) ENVIRONMENTAL SPECIFICATIONS ITEM DESCRIPTION Noise Levela a.Sound Pressure Level, ISO 7779. Configuration tested: machine basic installation, A4 paper, simplex printing. Ready mode 26 dB(A) Printing mode 49 dB(A) Copying mode 49 dB(A) Temperature Operation 10 to 32 °C (50 to 90 °F) Storage (unpacked) 0 to 40 °C (32 to 104 °F) Humidity Operation 10 to 80% RH Storage (unpacked) 20 to 80% RH ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS Power requirements are based on the country/region where the device is sold. Do not convert operating voltages. Doing so might damage the device and void the product warranty.ITEM DESCRIPTION Power ratinga a.See the rating label on the machine for the correct voltage (V), frequency (hertz) and type of current (A) for your machine. 110 volt models AC 110 - 127 V 220 volt models AC 220 - 240 V Power consumption Average operating mode Less than 270W Ready mode Less than 36W Power save mode • SCX-3200 Series: 3.8W • SCX-3205W(K): 5.6 W Power off mode Less than 0.45 W Specifications_ 92Specifications_ 93 PRINT MEDIA SPECIFICATIONS TYPE SIZE DIMENSIONS PRINT MEDIA WEIGHTA B a.If media weight is over 120 g/m2 (32 lbs), load a paper into the tray one by one. /CAPACITY Plain paper Letter 216 x 279 mm (8.50 x 11.00 inches) 60 to 120 g/m2 (16 to 32 lbs bond) • 150 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lbs bond) 60 to 163 g/m2 (16 to 43 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Legal 216 x 356 mm (8.50 x 14.00 inches) US Folio 216 x 330 mm (8.50 x 13.00 inches) A4 210 x 297 mm (8.27 x 11.69 inches) Oficio 216 x 343 mm (8.50 x 13.50 inches) JIS B5 182 x 257 mm (7.17 x 10.12 inches) ISO B5 176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 inches) Executive 184 x 267 mm (7.25 x 0 inches) A5 148 x 210 mm (5.83 x 8.27 inches) Envelope Envelope Monarch 98 x 191 mm (3.87 x 7.50 inches) 75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lbs bond) Envelope No. 10 105 x 241 mm (4.12 x 9.50 inches) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Envelope DL 110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 inches) Envelope C5 162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.02 inches) Thick paper Refer to the Plain paper section Refer to the Plain paper section 90 g/m2 (24 lbs bond) • 140 sheets 90 to 163 g/m2 (24 to 43 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Thin paper Refer to the Plain paper section Refer to the Plain paper section 60 to 70 g/m2 (16 to 19 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Transparency Letter, A4 Refer to the Plain paper section 138 to 146 g/m2 (37 to 39 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Labelsc c. Smoothness: 100 to 250 (sheffield). Letter, Legal, US Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5, Executive, A5 Refer to the Plain paper section 120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Card stock Letter, Legal, US Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5, Executive, A5 Refer to the Plain paper section 105 to 163 g/m2 (28 to 43 lbs bond) • 1 sheet for manual feeding in the tray Minimum size (custom) 76 x 196 mm (3.00 x 7.70 inches) 60 to 163 g/m2 (16 to 43 lbs bond) Maximum size (custom) 216 x 356 mm (8.50 x 14.02 inches) b.Maximum capacity may differ depending on media weight, thickness and environmental conditions. TRAY MANUAL FEEDING IN THE TRAYContact SAMSUNG worldwide_ 94 contact samsung worldwide If you have any comments or questions regarding Samsung products, contact the Samsung customer care center. COUNTRY/REG ION CUSTOMER CARE CENTER WEB SITE ARGENTINE 0800-333-3733 www.samsung.com ARMENIA 0-800-05-555 AUSTRALIA 1300 362 603 www.samsung.com AUSTRIA 0810-SAMSUNG (7267864, € 0.07/min) www.samsung.com AZERBAIJAN 088-55-55-555 BAHRAIN 8000-4726 BELARUS 810-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.ua www.samsung.com/ua_ru BELGIUM 02-201-24-18 www.samsung.com/be (Dutch) www.samsung.com/be_fr (French) BRAZIL 0800-124-421 4004-0000 www.samsung.com CANADA 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com CHILE 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com CHINA 400-810-5858 010-6475 1880 www.samsung.com COLOMBIA 01-8000112112 www.samsung.com COSTA RICA 0-800-507-7267 www.samsung.com CZECH REPUBLIC 800-SAMSUNG (800-726786) www.samsung.com Samsung Zrt., česká organizační složka, Oasis Florenc, Sokolovská394/17, 180 00, Praha 8 DENMARK 70 70 19 70 www.samsung.com ECUADOR 1-800-10-7267 www.samsung.com EGYPT 0800-726786 EIRE 0818 717100 www.samsung.com EL SALVADOR 800-6225 www.samsung.com ESTONIA 800-7267 www.samsung.com KAZAKHSTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com/kz_ru KYRGYZSTAN 00-800-500-55-500 FINLAND 030-6227 515 www.samsung.com FRANCE 01 48 63 00 00 www.samsung.com GERMANY 01805 - SAMSUNG (726-7864 € 0,14/min) www.samsung.com GEORGIA 8-800-555-555 GUATEMALA 1-800-299-0013 www.samsung.com HONDURAS 800-7919267 www.samsung.com HONG KONG (852) 3698-4698 www.samsung.com/hk www.samsung.com/hk_en/ HUNGARY 06-80-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com INDIA 3030 8282 1800 110011 1800 3000 8282 1800 266 8282 www.samsung.com INDONESIA 0800-112-8888 021-5699-7777 www.samsung.com ITALIA 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com JAMAICA 1-800-234-7267 www.samsung.com JAPAN 0120-327-527 www.samsung.com JORDAN 800-22273 KSA 9200-21230 www.samsung.com BAHRAIN 8000-4726 LATVIA 8000-7267 www.samsung.com LITHUANIA 8-800-77777 www.samsung.com LUXEMBURG 261 03 710 www.samsung.com MALAYSIA 1800-88-9999 www.samsung.com MEXICO 01-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com MOLDOVA 00-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.ua www.samsung.com/ua_ru NETHERLANDS 0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864) (€ 0,10/min) www.samsung.com NEW ZEALAND 0800 SAMSUNG (0800 726 786) www.samsung.com NICARAGUA 00-1800-5077267 www.samsung.com NORWAY 815-56 480 www.samsung.com PANAMA 800-7267 www.samsung.com COUNTRY/REG ION CUSTOMER CARE CENTER WEB SITEContact SAMSUNG worldwide_ 95 PHILIPPINES 1800-10-SAMSUNG (726-7864) 1-800-3-SAMSUNG (726-7864) 1-800-8-SAMSUNG (726-7864) 02-5805777 www.samsung.com POLAND 0 801 1SAMSUNG (172678) 022-607-93-33 www.samsung.com PORTUGAL 80820-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com PUERTO RICO 1-800-682-3180 www.samsung.com QATAR 800-2255 REP. DOMINICA 1-800-751-2676 www.samsung.com RUSSIA 8-800-555-55-55 www.samsung.ru SINGAPORE 1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com SLOVAKIA 0800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com SOUTH AFRICA 0860 SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com SPAIN 902-1-SAMSUNG(902 172 678) www.samsung.com SWEDEN 0771 726 7864 (SAMSUNG) www.samsung.com SWITZERLAND 0848-SAMSUNG (7267864, CHF 0.08/min) www.samsung.com SYRIA 1825-22-73 TADJIKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 TAIWAN 0800-329-999 www.samsung.com THAILAND 1800-29-3232 02-689-3232 www.samsung.com TRINIDAD & TOBAGO 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com TURKEY 444 77 11 www.samsung.com U.A.E 800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com U.K 0845 SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com U.S.A 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com UKRAINE 8-800-502-000 www.samsung.ua www.samsung.com/ua_ru COUNTRY/REG ION CUSTOMER CARE CENTER WEB SITE UZBEKISTAN 8-10-800-500-55-500 www.samsung.com/kz_ru VENEZUELA 0-800-100-5303 www.samsung.com VIETNAM 1 800 588 889 www.samsung.com COUNTRY/REG ION CUSTOMER CARE CENTER WEB SITEGlossary_ 96 glossary The following glossary helps you get familiar with the product by understanding the terminologies commonly used with printing as well as mentioned in this user’s guide. 802.11 802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN) communication, developed by the IEEE LAN/MAN Standards Committee (IEEE 802). 802.11b/g 802.11b/g can share same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band. 802.11b supports bandwidth up to 11 Mbps; 802.11g up to 54 Mbps. 802.11b/g devices may occasionally suffer interference from microwave ovens, cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices. Access point Access Point or Wireless Access Point (AP or WAP) is a device that connects wireless communication devices together on wireless local area networks (WLAN), and acts as a central transmitter and receiver of WLAN radio signals. ADF An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a scanning unit that will automatically feed an original sheet of paper so that the machine can scan some amount of the paper at once. AppleTalk AppleTalk is a proprietary suite of protocols developed by Apple, Inc for computer networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking. BIT Depth A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to represent the color of a single pixel in a bitmapped image. Higher color depth gives a broader range of distinct colors. As the number of bits increases, the number of possible colors becomes impractically large for a color map. 1-bit color is commonly called as monochrome or black and white. BMP A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows graphics subsystem (GDI), and used commonly as a simple graphics file format on that platform. BOOTP Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to obtain its IP address automatically. This is usually done in the bootstrap process of computers or operating systems running on them. The BOOTP servers assign the IP address from a pool of addresses to each client. BOOTP enables 'diskless workstation' computers to obtain an IP address prior to loading any advanced operating system. CCD Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan job. CCD Locking mechanism is also used to hold the CCD module to prevent any damage when you move the machine. Collation Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When collation is selected, the device prints an entire set before printing additional copies. Control Panel A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or monitoring instruments are displayed. They are typically found in front of the machine. Coverage It is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing. For example, 5% coverage means that an A4 sided paper has about 5% image or text on it. So, if the paper or original has complicated images or lots of text on it, the coverage will be higher and at the same time, a toner usage will be as much as the coverage. CSV Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to exchange data between disparate applications. The file format, as it is used in Microsoft Excel, has become a de facto standard throughout the industry, even among non-Microsoft platforms. DADF A Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) is a scanning unit that will automatically feed and turn over an original sheet of paper so that the machine can scan on both sides of the paper. Default The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box state, reset, or initialized. DHCP A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server networking protocol. A DHCP server provides configuration parameters specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally, information required by the client host to participate on an IP network. DHCP also provides a mechanism for allocation of IP addresses to client hosts. DIMM Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds memory. DIMM stores all the data within the machine like printing data, received fax data.Glossary_ 97 DNS The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information associated with domain names in a distributed database on networks, such as the Internet. Dot Matrix Printer A dot matrix printer refers to a type of computer printer with a print head that runs back and forth on the page and prints by impact, striking an ink-soaked cloth ribbon against the paper, much like a typewriter. DPI Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for scanning and printing. Generally, higher DPI results in a higher resolution, more visible detail in the image, and a larger file size. DRPD Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone company service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to answer several different telephone numbers. Duplex A mechanism that will automatically turn over a sheet of paper so that the machine can print (or scan) on both sides of the paper. A printer equipped with a Duplex Unit can print on both sides of paper during one print cycle. Duty Cycle Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer performance for a month. Generally the printer has the lifespan limitation such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity of print-outs, usually within the warranty period. For example, if the duty cycle is 48,000 pages per month assuming 20 working days, a printer limits 2,400 pages a day. ECM Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into Class 1 fax machines or fax modems. It automatically detects and corrects errors in the fax transmission process that are sometimes caused by telephone line noise. Emulation Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as another. An emulator duplicates the functions of one system with a different system, so that the second system behaves like the first system. Emulation focuses on exact reproduction of external behavior, which is in contrast to simulation, which concerns an abstract model of the system being simulated, often considering its internal state. Ethernet Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local area networks (LANs). It defines wiring and signaling for the physical layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access control (MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized as IEEE 802.3. It has become the most widespread LAN technology in use during the 1990s to the present. EtherTalk A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking. FDI Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the machine to allow a third party device such as a coin operated device or a card reader. Those devices allow the pay-for-print service on your machine. FTP A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for exchanging files over any network that supports the TCP/IP protocol (such as the Internet or an intranet). Fuser Unit The part of a laser printer that fuses the toner onto the print media. It consists of a heat roller and a pressure roller. After toner is transferred onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and pressure to ensure that the toner stays on the paper permanently, which is why paper is warm when it comes out of a laser printer. Gateway A connection between computer networks, or between a computer network and a telephone line. It is very popular, as it is a computer or a network that allows access to another computer or network. Grayscale A shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of an image when color images are converted to grayscale; colors are represented by various shades of gray. Halftone An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots. Highly colored areas consist of a large number of dots, while lighter areas consist of a smaller number of dots. HDD Hard Disk Drive (HDD), commonly referred to as a hard drive or hard disk, is a non-volatile storage device which stores digitally-encoded data on rapidly rotating platters with magnetic surfaces. IEEE The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an international non-profit, professional organization for the advancement of technology related to electricity. IEEE 1284 The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). The term "1284-B" refers to a specific connector type on the end of the parallel cable that attaches to the peripheral (for example, a printer). Glossary_ 98 Intranet A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and possibly the public telecommunication system to securely share part of an organization's information or operations with its employees. Sometimes the term refers only to the most visible service, the internal website. IP address An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in order to identify and communicate with each other on a network utilizing the Internet Protocol standard. IPM The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a way of measuring the speed of a printer. An IPM rate indicates the number of single-sided sheets a printer can complete within one minute. IPP The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing as well as managing print jobs, media size, resolution, and so forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet to hundreds of printers, and also supports access control, authentication, and encryption, making it a much more capable and secure printing solution than older ones. IPX/SPX IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet Exchange. It is a networking protocol used by the Novell NetWare operating systems. IPX and SPX both provide connection services similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol having similarities to IP, and SPX having similarities to TCP. IPX/SPX was primarily designed for local area networks (LANs), and is a very efficient protocol for this purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN). ISO The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an international standard-setting body composed of representatives from national standards bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and commercial standards. ITU-T The International Telecommunication Union is an international organization established to standardize and regulate international radio and telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization, allocation of the radio spectrum, and organizing interconnection arrangements between different countries to allow international phone calls. A -T out of ITU-T indicates telecommunication. ITU-T No. 1 chart Standardized test chart published by ITU-T for document facsimile transmissions. JBIG Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression standard with no loss of accuracy or quality, which was designed for compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can also be used on other images. JPEG Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used standard method of lossy compression for photographic images. It is the format used for storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide Web. LDAP The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking protocol for querying and modifying directory services running over TCP/IP. LED A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates the status of a machine. MAC address Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated with a network adapter. MAC address is a unique 48-bit identifier usually written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e. g., 00-00-0c-34-11-4e). This address is usually hard-coded into a Network Interface Card (NIC) by its manufacturer, and used as an aid for routers trying to locate machines on large networks. MFP Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office machine that includes the following functionality in one physical body, so as to have a printer, a copier, a fax, a scanner and etc. MH Modified Huffman (MH) is a compression method for decreasing the amount of data that needs to be transmitted between the fax machines to transfer the image recommended by ITU-T T.4. MH is a codebook-based run-length encoding scheme optimized to efficiently compress white space. As most faxes consist mostly of white space, this minimizes the transmission time of most faxes. MMR Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T T.6. Modem A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information, and also demodulates such a carrier signal to decode transmitted information. MR Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T T.4. MR encodes the first scanned line using MH. The next line is compared to the first, the differences determined, and then the differences are encoded and transmitted.Glossary_ 99 NetWare A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used cooperative multitasking to run various services on a PC, and the network protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS stack. Today NetWare supports TCP/IP as well as IPX/SPX. OPC Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual image for print using a laser beam emitted from a laser printer, and it is usually green or rust colored and has a cylinder shape. An imaging unit containing a drum slowly wears the drum surface by its usage in the printer, and it should be replaced appropriately since it gets worn from contact with the cartridge development brush, cleaning mechanism, and paper. Originals The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text, etc, which is copied, reproduced or translated to produce others, but which is not itself copied or derived from something else. OSI Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) for communications. OSI offers a standard, modular approach to network design that divides the required set of complex functions into manageable, self-contained, functional layers. The layers are, from top to bottom, Application, Presentation, Session, Transport, Network, Data Link and Physical. PABX A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone switching system within a private enterprise. PCL Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language (PDL) developed by HP as a printer protocol and has become an industry standard. Originally developed for early inkjet printers, PCL has been released in varying levels for thermal, dot matrix printer, and laser printers. PDF Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed by Adobe Systems for representing two dimensional documents in a device independent and resolution independent format. PostScript PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming language used primarily in the electronic and desktop publishing areas. - that is run in an interpreter to generate an image. Printer Driver A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer to the printer. Print Media The media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can be used in a printer, a scanner, a fax or, a copier. PPM Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining how fast a printer works, meaning the number of pages a printer can produce in one minute. PRN file An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the device driver using standard input/output system calls, which simplifies many tasks. Protocol A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection, communication, and data transfer between two computing endpoints. PS See PostScript. PSTN The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the world's public circuit-switched telephone networks which, on industrial premises, is usually routed through the switchboard. RADIUS Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS) is a protocol for remote user authentication and accounting. RADIUS enables centralized management of authentication data such as usernames and passwords using an AAA (authentication, authorization, and accounting) concept to manage network access. Resolution The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The higher the dpi, the greater the resolution. SMB Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to share files, printers, serial ports, and miscellaneous communications between nodes on a network. It also provides an authenticated Inter-process communication mechanism. SMTP Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail transmissions across the Internet. SMTP is a relatively simple, text-based protocol, where one or more recipients of a message are specified, and then the message text is transferred. It is a client-server protocol, where the client transmits an email message to the server. SSID Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name of a wireless local area network (WLAN). All wireless devices in a WLAN use the same SSID in order to communicate with each other. The SSIDs are case-sensitive and have a maximum length of 32 characters.Glossary_ 100 Subnet Mask The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to determine which part of the address is the network address and which part is the host address. TCP/IP The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP); the set of communications protocols that implement the protocol stack on which the Internet and most commercial networks run. TCR Transmission Confirmation Report (TCR) provides details of each transmission such as job status, transmission result and number of pages sent. This report can be set to print after each job or only after failed transmissions. TIFF Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bitmapped image format. TIFF describes image data that typically come from scanners. TIFF images make use of tags, keywords defining the characteristics of the image that is included in the file. This flexible and platform-independent format can be used for pictures that have been made by various image processing applications. Toner Cartridge A kind of bottle or container used in a machine like a printer which contains toner. Toner is a powder used in laser printers and photocopiers, which forms the text and images on the printed paper. Toner can be fused by a combination of heat/pressure from the fuser, causing it to bind to the fibers in the paper. TWAIN An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAIN-compliant scanner with a TWAIN-compliant program, a scan can be initiated from within the program. It is an image capture API for Microsoft Windows and Apple Macintosh operating systems. UNC Path Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network shares in Window NT and other Microsoft products. The format of a UNC path is: \\\\ URL Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents and resources on the Internet. The first part of the address indicates what protocol to use, the second part specifies the IP address or the domain name where the resource is located. USB Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to connect computers and peripherals. Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a single computer USB port to multiple peripherals. Watermark A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears lighter when viewed by transmitted light. Watermarks were first introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282; they have been used by papermakers to identify their product, and also on postage stamps, currency, and other government documents to discourage counterfeiting. WEP Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is a security protocol specified in IEEE 802.11 to provide the same level of security as that of a wired LAN. WEP provides security by encrypting data over radio so that it is protected as it is transmitted from one end point to another. WIA Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is originally introduced in Windows Me and Windows XP. A scan can be initiated from within these operating systems by using a WIA-compliant scanner. WPA Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA) is a class of systems to secure wireless (Wi-Fi) computer networks, which was created to improve upon the security features of WEP. WPA-PSK WPA-PSK (WPA Pre-Shared Key) is special mode of WPA for small business or home users. A shared key, or password, is configured in the wireless access point (WAP) and any wireless laptop or desktop devices. WPA-PSK generates a unique key for each session between a wireless client and the associated WAP for more advanced security. WPS The Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) is a standard for establishing a wireless home network. If your wireless access point supports WPS, you can configure the wireless network connection easily without a computer. XPS XML Paper Specification (XPS) is a specification for a Page Description Language (PDL) and a new document format, which has benefits for portable document and electronic document, developed by Microsoft. It is an XML-based specification, based on a new print path and a vector-based device-independent document format. P3110 Mode d’emploiUtilisation de ce mode d’emploi 2 Utilisation de ce mode d’emploi Merci d’avoir choisi cet appareil mobile Samsung. Il vous permettra de communiquer et d’accéder à des divertissements de haute qualité, basés sur les critères de qualité et la technologie de Samsung. Ce mode d’emploi a été spécialement conçu pour vous permettre de découvrir les fonctions et les caractéristiques de votre appareil. À lire avant toute utilisation ● Veuillez lire attentivement l’intégralité de ce mode d’emploi avant d’utiliser votre appareil, afin de l’utiliser en toute sécurité. ● Les explications fournies dans ce mode d’emploi sont basées sur les paramètres par défaut de l’appareil. ● Les illustrations utilisées dans ce mode d’emploi peuvent différer par rapport à l’aspect réel du produit. ● Le contenu de ce mode d’emploi peut différer par rapport au produit ou à la version logicielle fournie par votre opérateur, et faire l’objet de modifications sans préavis. Pour obtenir la version la plus récente de ce mode d’emploi, visitez le site Web de Samsung (www.samsung.com). ● Les fonctions disponibles et les services supplémentaires peuvent varier en fonction de la version logicielle de votre appareil ou de votre opérateur. ● La mise en forme et la distribution de ce mode d’emploi sont basées sur le système d’exploitation Android et peuvent varier en fonction du système d’exploitation de l’utilisateur. ● Les applications de l’appareil peuvent fonctionner différemment des applications comparables sur ordinateur et peuvent ne pas inclure l’ensemble des fonctions disponibles. ● Les applications et leurs fonctions peuvent varier en fonction de votre zone géographique ou des caractéristiques du matériel. Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des problèmes de performance relatifs aux applications fournies par des tiers.Utilisation de ce mode d’emploi 3 ● Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des problèmes de performance ou des incompatibilités découlant de la modification des paramètres de registre par l’utilisateur. Toute tentative de personnalisation du système d’exploitation peut entraîner des problèmes de fonctionnement de votre appareil ou de ses applications. ● Vous pouvez mettre à jour le logiciel de votre appareil en vous connectant sur le site Web de Samsung (www.samsung.com). ● Les logiciels, sons, fonds d’écran et images fourni(e)s dans cet appareil le sont sous licence pour une utilisation limitée entre Samsung et leurs propriétaires respectifs. Extraire et utiliser ces supports à des fins commerciales ou autres constitue une infraction au regard des lois sur les droits d’auteur. Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des infractions sur les droits d’auteur commises par les utilisateurs. ● Veuillez conserver ce mode d’emploi pour pouvoir le consulter ultérieurement. Icônes Familiarisez-vous d’abord avec les icônes utilisées dans ce mode d’emploi : Avertissement : situations susceptibles de vous blesser ou de blesser autrui. Attention : situations susceptibles d’endommager votre appareil ou d’autres équipements. Remarque : remarques, conseils d’utilisation ou informations complémentaires. ► Référence : pages contenant plus d’informations. Exemple : ► p. 12 (signifie « reportez-vous à la page 12 »). → Suivi de : ordre des options ou des menus à suivre pour exécuter une action. Exemple : depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→A propos de l’appareil (signifie que vous devez d’abord appuyer sur Paramètres, puis sur A propos de l’appareil).Utilisation de ce mode d’emploi 4 Droits d’auteur Copyright © 2013 Samsung Electronics Ce mode d’emploi est protégé par les lois internationales sur les droits d’auteur. Il est interdit de reproduire, distribuer, traduire ou transmettre sous quelque forme et par quelque moyen que ce soit, électronique ou mécanique, notamment par photocopie, enregistrement ou stockage dans un système de stockage et de recherche documentaire, tout ou partie de ce document sans le consentement préalable écrit de Samsung Electronics. Marques déposées ● SAMSUNG et le logo SAMSUNG sont des marques déposées de Samsung Electronics. ● Les logos Android, Google ™, Google Maps ™, Google Mail ™, YouTube ™, Google Play ™ Store, Google Latitude ™ et Google Talk ™ sont des marques de Google, Inc. ● Bluetooth® est une marque déposée de Bluetooth SIG, Inc. ● Windows Media Player ® est une marque déposée de Microsoft Corporation. ● Wi-Fi ®, Wi-Fi Protected Setup ™, Wi-Fi Direct ™, Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ et le logo Wi-Fi sont des marques déposées de Wi-Fi Alliance.Utilisation de ce mode d’emploi 5 ● DivX®, DivX Certified® et autres logos associés sont des marques commerciales de Rovi Corporation ou de ces produits et sont utilisées sous licence. ● Toutes les autres marques déposées et droits d’auteur demeurent la propriété de leurs détenteurs respectifs. À PROPOS DU FORMAT VIDÉO DIVX DivX® est en format numérique créé par DivX, LLC, filiale de Rovi Corporation. Cet appareil bénéficie d’une certification officielle de DivX Certified® et permet de lire le format vidéo DivX. Rendezvous sur le site www.divx.com pour obtenir plus d’informations et télécharger des logiciels pour convertir vos fichiers au format vidéo DivX. À PROPOS DE LA VIDÉO DIVX À LA DEMANDE Cet appareil DivX Certified® doit être enregistré pour pouvoir lire du contenu DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD). Pour obtenir votre code d’enregistrement, repérez la section DivX VOD dans le menu de configuration de votre appareil. Rendez-vous ensuite sur vod.divx.com pour plus d’informations sur les modalités d’enregistrement. Les appareils DivX Certified® peuvent lire des vidéos DivX® d’une résolution HD allant jusqu’à 720 pixels, ainsi que du contenu premium.Table des matières 6 Assemblage........................................................10 Contenu du coffret .......................................................................... 10 Aspect de l’appareil ......................................................................... 11 Touches ................................................................................................ 13 Charger la batterie ........................................................................... 13 Insérer une carte mémoire (en option) .................................. 16 Démarrage.........................................................18 Allumer ou éteindre l’appareil .................................................... 18 Utiliser l’écran tactile ....................................................................... 19 Verrouiller ou déverrouiller l’écran tactile et les touches ................................................................................................. 22 Présentation de l’écran d’accueil ............................................... 22 Accéder aux applications ............................................................. 27 Lancer plusieurs applications simultanément .................... 29 Personnaliser l’appareil ................................................................. 29 Saisir du texte .................................................................................... 34 Services Web et GPS..........................................36 Internet ................................................................................................. 36 Game Hub ........................................................................................... 39 Cartes .................................................................................................... 40 Navigation ........................................................................................... 42 Local ....................................................................................................... 43 Play Livres ............................................................................................ 44 Play Films ............................................................................................. 44 Play Store ............................................................................................. 44 Reader Hub ......................................................................................... 45 Table des matièresTable des matières 7 Samsung Apps .................................................................................. 46 S Suggest ............................................................................................. 46 YouTube ............................................................................................... 46 Video Hub ........................................................................................... 48 Recherche vocale ............................................................................. 48 Communication.................................................49 Google Mail ........................................................................................ 49 E-mail ..................................................................................................... 51 Talk ......................................................................................................... 53 ChatON ................................................................................................. 54 Chat+ ..................................................................................................... 55 Google+ ............................................................................................... 55 Divertissements.................................................56 Appareil photo .................................................................................. 56 Lecteur vidéo ..................................................................................... 64 Galerie ................................................................................................... 67 Editeur de photos ............................................................................ 70 Editeur de vidéos ............................................................................. 71 Lecteur MP3 ....................................................................................... 73 Music Hub ........................................................................................... 77 Données personnelles.......................................78 Contacts ............................................................................................... 78 S Calendrier ........................................................................................ 80 Mémo .................................................................................................... 82Table des matières 8 Connectivité.......................................................83 Connexions USB ............................................................................... 83 Wi-Fi ....................................................................................................... 85 Wi-Fi Direct .......................................................................................... 88 AllShare Play ....................................................................................... 89 Bluetooth ............................................................................................. 92 GPS ......................................................................................................... 94 Connexions VPN ............................................................................... 95 Outils ..................................................................98 Alarme .................................................................................................. 98 Calculatrice ......................................................................................... 99 Téléchargements .............................................................................. 99 Dropbox ............................................................................................. 100 Mes fichiers ....................................................................................... 101 Polaris Office .................................................................................... 102 Recherche Google ......................................................................... 104 Horloge mondiale ......................................................................... 104 Paramètres.......................................................105 Accéder au menu Paramètres .................................................. 105 Wi-Fi ..................................................................................................... 105 Bluetooth ........................................................................................... 105 Utilisation des données ............................................................... 105 Paramètres supplémentaires .................................................... 106 Mode blocage ................................................................................. 107 Son ....................................................................................................... 107 Affichage ............................................................................................ 107 Stockage ............................................................................................ 108 Économie d’énergie ...................................................................... 108Table des matières 9 Batterie ............................................................................................... 108 Gestionnaire d’applications ...................................................... 109 Services de localisation ............................................................... 109 Ecran de verrouillage .................................................................... 109 Sécurité ............................................................................................... 110 Langue et saisie .............................................................................. 111 Sauvegarder et réinitialiser ........................................................ 113 Ajouter compte ............................................................................... 113 Accessoire .......................................................................................... 114 Date et heure ................................................................................... 114 Accessibilité ...................................................................................... 114 Options de développement ...................................................... 115 A propos de l’appareil .................................................................. 117 Dépannage.......................................................118 Index.................................................................121Assemblage 10 Assemblage Contenu du coffret Vérifiez le contenu du coffret et la présence de tous les éléments suivants : ● Appareil mobile ● Guide de prise en main rapide Utilisez exclusivement des logiciels homologués par Samsung. L’utilisation de logiciels piratés ou illégaux peut occasionner des dommages ou des dysfonctionnements qui ne sont pas couverts par la garantie du fabricant. ● Les éléments fournis avec votre appareil et les accessoires disponibles peuvent varier en fonction de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● Vous pouvez acquérir d’autres accessoires auprès de votre revendeur Samsung. ● Les éléments fournis sont exclusivement conçus pour cet appareil et peuvent ne pas être compatibles avec d’autres appareils. ● Il est possible que certains accessoires, autres que ceux fournis, ne soient pas compatibles avec votre appareil.Assemblage 11 Aspect de l’appareil › Face avant Numéro Fonction 1 Capteur de luminosité 2 Compartiment pour carte mémoire 3 Écran tactile 4 Haut-parleur 5 Connecteur à fonctions multiples 6 Objectif photo avantAssemblage 12 › Face arrière Numéro Fonction 7 Microphone 8 Antenne GPS1 9 Touche Marche/Arrêt/Réinitialisation/Verrouillage 10 Objectif photo arrière 11 Touche de volume 12 Prise audio 3,5 mm 1. Lorsque vous utilisez les fonctions GPS, ne touchez et ne recouvrez pas l’emplacement de l’antenne avec vos mains ou tout autre objet.Assemblage 13 Touches Touche Fonction Marche/Arrêt/ Réinitialisation1 / Verrouillage Allumer l’appareil (maintenir enfoncée). Accéder aux options de l’appareil (maintenir enfoncée). Réinitialiser l’appareil (maintenir enfoncée pendant 8 à 10 secondes). Éteindre et verrouiller l’écran tactile ou activer l'écran tactile. Volume Régler le volume de l’appareil. Charger la batterie Avant d’utiliser l’appareil pour la première fois ou lorsque la batterie est restée inutilisée pendant une période prolongée, vous devez charger la batterie. Chargez la batterie uniquement à l’aide d’un chargeur. Vous ne pouvez pas la charger à l’aide d’un câble USB. Vous ne pouvez pas remplacer la batterie de l’appareil. Si vous rencontrez des problèmes avec la batterie ou si vous devez la remplacer, apportez votre appareil dans un centre de service après-vente Samsung. Utilisez exclusivement des chargeurs et des câbles USB homologués par Samsung. L’utilisation de chargeurs ou de câbles non homologués peut provoquer l’explosion de la batterie ou endommager votre appareil. 1. Si votre appareil est sujet à des erreurs fatales ou s’il ne répond plus ou mal, vous pouvez le réinitialiser pour qu’il retrouve un fonctionnement correct.Assemblage 14 ● Lorsque le niveau de charge de la batterie est faible, l’appareil émet un signal sonore et affiche un message d’avertissement. Rechargez la batterie pour remettre l’appareil en marche. ● Si la batterie est complètement déchargée, vous ne pouvez pas allumer l’appareil, même si vous le mettez à recharger. Rechargez la batterie pendant quelques minutes avant de tenter d’allumer l’appareil. ● La forme du chargeur USB peut varier en fonction de votre zone géographique. 1 Connectez l’une des fiches du câble USB au chargeur USB, puis l’autre fiche au connecteur à fonctions multiples de votre appareil. Un branchement incorrect du câble USB peut sérieusement endommager l’appareil ou le chargeur USB. Les dégâts résultant d’une mauvaise utilisation ne sont pas couverts par la garantie.Assemblage 15 2 Branchez le chargeur USB sur une prise de courant. ● Lorsque l’appareil est en cours de chargement, il est possible que l’écran tactile ne fonctionne pas en raison de l’instabilité de l’alimentation électrique. Dans ce cas, débranchez le câble USB de l’appareil. ● Il est possible que l’appareil chauffe lorsqu’il est en cours de chargement. Ce phénomène est normal et n’affecte pas la durée de vie, ni les performances de l’appareil. ● Si votre appareil ne se charge pas correctement, apportezle, accompagné de son chargeur, dans un centre de service après-vente Samsung. 3 Une fois la batterie entièrement chargée, débranchez d’abord le câble USB de l’appareil, puis le chargeur USB de la prise de courant. Pour économiser l’énergie, débranchez le chargeur USB lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. Le chargeur USB n’étant pas muni d’un bouton marche/arrêt, vous devez le débrancher de la prise secteur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas, afin d’économiser l’énergie. En cours de chargement, l’appareil doit rester à proximité de la prise secteur. › Réduire la consommation d’énergie de la batterie Votre appareil dispose d’options destinées à optimiser l'autonomie de votre batterie. En personnalisant ces options et en désactivant les applications fonctionnant inutilement en arrière-plan, vous pouvez utiliser l’appareil plus longtemps entre deux chargements : ● Lorsque vous n’utilisez pas votre appareil, désactivez l'écran tactile en appuyant sur la touche Marche/Arrêt. ● Fermez les applications fonctionnant inutilement en arrière-plan avec le gestionnaire de tâches. ● Désactivez la fonction Bluetooth. ● Désactivez la fonction Wi-Fi. ● Désactivez la synchronisation automatique des applications. ● Réduisez la durée du rétroéclairage. ● Réduisez la luminosité de l’écran.Assemblage 16 Insérer une carte mémoire (en option) L’appareil est compatible avec les cartes mémoire d’une capacité allant jusqu’à 32 Go. Selon le fabricant et le modèle, certaines cartes peuvent ne pas être compatibles. Samsung utilise des normes industrielles standardisées pour les cartes mémoire. Néanmoins, il est possible que certaines marques de cartes mémoire ne soient pas entièrement compatibles avec votre appareil. L’utilisation d’une carte mémoire incompatible peut endommager votre appareil ou la carte mémoire elle-même et corrompre les données qui y sont stockées. ● Seule la structure de fichiers FAT est compatible avec les cartes mémoire de votre appareil. Lorsque vous insérez une carte mémoire formatée avec une autre structure de fichiers, votre appareil vous invite à la reformater entièrement. ● Une trop grande fréquence des opérations d’effacement et d’écriture réduit la durée de vie des cartes mémoire. ● Lorsque vous insérez une carte mémoire dans votre appareil, le répertoire des fichiers de la carte mémoire apparaît dans le dossier extSdCard du menu Mes fichiers. 1 Ouvrez le cache du compartiment pour carte mémoire. 2 Insérez la carte en orientant la puce vers le bas.Assemblage 17 3 Enfoncez la carte mémoire dans son compartiment jusqu’à ce qu’elle se verrouille. 4 Refermez le cache du compartiment pour carte mémoire. › Retirer une carte mémoire Avant de retirer la carte mémoire, vous devez au préalable la désactiver pour pouvoir la retirer en toute sécurité. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Stockage→Démonter la carte SD→OK. 2 Ouvrez le cache du compartiment pour carte mémoire. 3 Poussez la carte avec précaution jusqu’à ce qu’elle ressorte de l’appareil. 4 Retirez la carte mémoire. 5 Refermez le cache du compartiment pour carte mémoire. Ne retirez jamais la carte mémoire lorsque l’appareil y enregistre ou lit des informations. Vous risqueriez de perdre des données et d’endommager la carte mémoire ou l’appareil. › Formater une carte mémoire Formater votre carte mémoire sur un ordinateur peut entraîner des problèmes de compatibilité avec votre appareil. Formatez la carte mémoire uniquement avec l’appareil. Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Stockage→Formater la carte SD→Formater la carte SD→ Supprimer tout. Avant de formater la carte mémoire, n’oubliez pas d’effectuer des copies de sauvegarde de toutes les données importantes qui y sont stockées. La garantie du fabricant ne couvre pas la perte de données résultant des manipulations de l’utilisateur.18 Démarrage Démarrage Allumer ou éteindre l’appareil Pour allumer l’appareil, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée. Si vous allumez votre appareil pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à sa configuration. Vous devez vous connecter à Google ou créer un compte Google pour utiliser des applications qui communiquent avec le serveur Google. Pour éteindre votre appareil, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée, puis appuyez sur Éteindre→OK. ● Respectez toutes les consignes de sécurité et directives formulées par le personnel compétent dans les lieux où l’utilisation d’appareils sans fil est interdite, comme par exemple dans les avions et les hôpitaux. ● Pour utiliser uniquement les fonctions hors réseau de votre appareil, c'est-à-dire les fonctions autres que les fonctions d’appel, Wi-Fi et Bluetooth, activez le mode Hors-ligne.► p. 10619 Démarrage Utiliser l’écran tactile L’écran tactile de votre appareil facilite la sélection des éléments et des fonctions. Découvrez les manipulations de base pour utiliser l’écran tactile. ● N’exercez pas de pression sur l’écran tactile avec vos doigts et n’utilisez pas d’objets pointus. Vous risqueriez d’endommager l’écran tactile ou de provoquer un dysfonctionnement. ● Évitez tout contact de l’écran tactile avec d’autres appareils électriques. Les décharges électrostatiques peuvent provoquer des dysfonctionnements de l’écran tactile. ● Évitez de mettre l’écran tactile en contact avec des liquides. L’humidité ou le contact avec des liquides peut provoquer des dysfonctionnements de l’écran tactile. ● Si l’écran tactile reste inactif pendant une période prolongée, des images rémanentes risquent d’apparaître (ou persistance de l’affichage). Éteignez l’écran tactile lorsque vous n’utilisez pas l’appareil. ● Pour une utilisation optimale de l’écran tactile, retirez le film de protection avant d’utiliser l’appareil. ● L’écran tactile comporte une couche qui détecte les petites charges électriques émises par le corps humain. Pour de meilleures performances, appuyez sur l’écran tactile du bout du doigt. L’écran tactile ne réagit pas si vous utilisez des objets pointus, stylet ou stylo par exemple. 20 Démarrage Contrôlez le fonctionnement de l’écran tactile à l’aide des manipulations suivantes : Appuyer Appuyez une seule fois sur l’écran tactile pour sélectionner ou lancer un menu, une option ou une application. Maintenir le doigt appuyé Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur un élément pendant plus de 2 secondes. Faire glisser Maintenez votre doigt appuyé sur un élément et déplacez-le sur l’écran. Appuyer deux fois Appuyez brièvement à deux reprises sur un élément.21 Démarrage Tapoter Faites défiler l’écran vers le haut, le bas, la droite ou la gauche par petits mouvements pour vous déplacer dans les listes ou les écrans. Pincer Placez deux doigts écartés sur l’écran, puis rapprochez-les, et inversement. ● Passé un certain délai d’inactivité, votre appareil désactive l’écran tactile automatiquement. Pour activer l’écran tactile, appuyez sur la touche Marche/Arrêt. ● Vous pouvez définir le délai à l'issue duquel l’appareil doit désactiver l'écran automatiquement. Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→Affichage→ Mise en veille de l’écran.22 Démarrage Verrouiller ou déverrouiller l’écran tactile et les touches Après un certain délai d’inactivité, votre appareil désactive et verrouille automatiquement l’écran tactile et les touches afin d’empêcher toute utilisation accidentelle de l’appareil. Pour verrouiller manuellement l’écran tactile et les touches, appuyez sur la touche Marche/Arrêt. Pour déverrouiller, appuyez sur la touche Marche/Arrêt, et faites glisser votre doigt sur l'écran. Vous pouvez activer la fonction de déverrouillage sécurisé de l'écran afin d’empêcher toute personne non autorisée d’utiliser votre appareil et de consulter les données et informations personnelles qui y sont enregistrées. ► p. 32 Présentation de l’écran d’accueil Vous pouvez afficher l’état de votre appareil et accéder au mode Menu à partir de l’écran d’accueil. L’écran d’accueil comporte plusieurs volets. Faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite pour afficher l’un des volets de l’écran d’accueil. Vous pouvez également appuyer sur un point en bas de l’écran pour accéder directement au volet correspondant.23 Démarrage › Barre Système La barre Système située en bas de l’écran vous permet de naviguer rapidement d’un écran à l’autre et d’accéder aux applications. Numéro Fonction 1 Ouvrir la liste des applications récemment utilisées. 2 Revenir à l’écran d’accueil. Accéder au widget de recherche Google ou au widget Google Now (maintenir enfoncée). 3 Revenir à l’écran précédent. 4 Ouvrir le volet des mini-applications. ›Icônes d’information Les icônes qui sont susceptibles d'apparaître à l’écran peuvent varier en fonction de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. Icône Signification Point d’accès Wi-Fi connecté Fonction Bluetooth activée Services GPS en cours d’utilisation24 Démarrage Icône Signification Connecté à un ordinateur Nouveau message Alarme activée Mode Hors-ligne activé Une erreur s’est produite ou votre attention est nécessaire Niveau de charge de la batterie ›Utiliser le volet des raccourcis Pour ouvrir le volet de raccourcis, appuyez sur la zone des icônes d’information et faites glisser le volet vers le bas. Pour masquer le volet, faites glisser votre doigt de bas en haut de l'écran. Depuis le volet des raccourcis, vous pouvez afficher l’état de l’appareil et utiliser les options suivantes : ● Wi-Fi : activer ou désactiver la fonction Wi-Fi. ► p. 85 ● GPS : activer ou désactiver la fonction GPS. ► p. 94 ● Son : activer ou désactiver le son ou le vibreur de l'appareil. ● Rotation écran : activer ou désactiver la rotation automatique de l’interface lorsque vous faites pivoter l’appareil. ● Éco. énergie : activer ou désactiver le mode d’économie d’énergie. ● Mode blocage : activer ou désactiver le mode blocage. En mode blocage, votre appareil bloque toutes les notifications. ● Bluetooth : activer ou désactiver la fonction Bluetooth. ► p. 92 ● Profil Voiture : activer ou désactiver le Profil Voiture. ● Synchro. : activer ou désactiver la synchronisation automatique des applications.25 Démarrage ● La disponibilité de certaines options dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● Faites glisser votre doigt vers la gauche ou la droite pour afficher toutes les options. ›Déplacer un élément sur l’écran d’accueil Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l'élément à déplacer, puis déplacezle sur l’écran. Vous pouvez ajouter un élément dans un nouveau dossier et le déplacer vers un nouveau volet. Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur un élément, puis déplacez-le vers Créer dossier ou Créer une page. › Supprimer un élément de l’écran d’accueil Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l'élément à supprimer, puis déplacez-le vers la corbeille.26 Démarrage ›Ajouter ou supprimer un volet d'écran d’accueil Vous pouvez ajouter ou supprimer des volets d'écran d’accueil pour organiser les widgets. 1 Depuis l’écran d’accueil, placez deux doigts sur l’écran, puis rapprochez-les pour passer en mode Édition. 2 Ajouter, supprimer ou réorganiser des volets : ● Pour supprimer un volet, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur la miniature correspondante, puis faites-la glisser vers la corbeille. ● Pour ajouter un nouveau volet, appuyez sur . ● Pour définir le volet principal de l’écran d’accueil, appuyez sur . ● Pour changer l’ordre des volets, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur la miniature correspondante, puis faites-la glisser vers un nouvel emplacement. 3 Appuyez sur pour revenir à l’écran précédent. ›Utiliser des widgets Les widgets sont de petites applications qui permettent d’accéder à des fonctions et des informations pratiques sur votre écran d’accueil. La disponibilité des widgets dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Widgets pour ouvrir le volet des widgets. 2 Dans le volet des widgets, faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite pour trouver un widget. 3 Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur un widget pour l’ajouter à l’écran d’accueil.27 Démarrage Accéder aux applications Lancez des applications et profitez pleinement des fonctions de votre appareil. Vous pouvez réorganiser la liste des applications en fonction de vos préférences ou télécharger des applications à partir d’Internet pour améliorer la fonctionnalité de l’appareil. 1 Depuis l’écran d’accueil, appuyez sur Applis pour accéder à la liste des applications. 2 Faites défiler vers la gauche ou la droite pour atteindre un écran d'applications. Vous pouvez également appuyer sur un point en bas de l’écran pour accéder directement à l’écran correspondant. 3 Sélectionnez une application. 4 Appuyez sur pour revenir à l’écran précédent. Appuyez sur pour revenir à l’écran d’accueil. ● Vous pouvez ajouter un raccourci vers une application sur l’écran d’accueil en maintenant le doigt appuyé sur l'icône correspondante dans la liste des applications. ● Si vous faites pivoter l’appareil lorsque vous utilisez des fonctions, l’interface pivote automatiquement. Afin de conserver l’orientation initiale de l’écran, ouvrez le volet de raccourcis, puis appuyez sur Rotation écran. ● Avant d’utiliser les services de localisation, tels que les applications de cartographie et de navigation, ou encore les services Internet, assurez-vous que votre connexion sans fil est activée.28 Démarrage › Organiser les applications Vous pouvez modifier l’ordre des applications dans la liste des applications ou les regrouper par catégories. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur →Modifier. 2 Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l’icône d’une application. 3 Organiser les applications : ● Pour déplacer une application, maintenez votre doigt appuyé sur l'icône correspondante et déplacez-la vers un nouvel emplacement. ● Pour ajouter une application dans un nouveau dossier, maintenez votre doigt appuyé sur l'icône correspondante et déplacez-la vers Créer dossier. ● Pour déplacer une application dans un nouveau volet, maintenez votre doigt appuyé sur l'icône correspondante et déplacez-la vers Créer une page. ● Pour désinstaller une application, maintenez votre doigt appuyé sur l'icône correspondante et déplacez-la vers Désinstaller. 4 Appuyez sur Enreg. ou sur OK→Enreg. › Télécharger une application 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Play Store ou Samsung Apps. 2 Localisez une application et téléchargez-la sur l’appareil. Pour installer des applications téléchargées à partir d’autres sources, reportez-vous au menu Paramètres→Sécurité→ Sources inconnues. ›Désinstaller une application 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur → Désinstaller. 2 Appuyez sur sur une icône d’application, puis appuyez sur OK. Vous pouvez désinstaller uniquement les applications que vous avez téléchargées.29 Démarrage ›Accéder aux applications récentes 1 Appuyez sur pour afficher les applications récemment utilisées. 2 Sélectionnez une application. Lancer plusieurs applications simultanément Votre appareil est multitâche et permet l’exécution simultanée de plusieurs applications. Pour lancer plusieurs applications simultanément, appuyez sur en cours d'utilisation d'une application. Sélectionnez ensuite une autre application à lancer en parallèle à partir de l’écran d’accueil. ›Gérer les applications Vous pouvez gérer les applications avec le gestionnaire de tâches. 1 Appuyez sur → →Applications actives. Le gestionnaire de tâches affiche les applications actives. 2 Contrôler les applications actives : ● Pour basculer vers une autre application, sélectionnez-la dans la liste. ● Pour fermer une application, appuyez sur Fin près de l'application correspondante. ● Pour fermer toutes les applications actives, appuyez sur Tout fermer près du nombre total d'applications actives. Personnaliser l’appareil Tirez le meilleur de votre appareil en modifiant ses paramètres pour qu’il réponde à vos envies et vos préférences. › Modifier la langue d’affichage 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Langue et saisie→Langue. 2 Sélectionnez une langue.30 Démarrage ›Activer ou désactiver la tonalité des touches Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→Son →Tonalité des touches. › Régler le volume de l’appareil 1 Appuyez sur la touche de volume Haut ou Bas. 2 Appuyez sur et faites glisser les curseurs pour régler le volume de chaque son. ›Activer le Profil Discret Activez ou désactivez le son de votre appareil de l’une des façons suivantes : ● Ouvrez le volet de raccourcis, puis appuyez sur Son. ● Maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée et appuyez sur . › Sélectionner un fond d’écran d’accueil 1 Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur une zone vide de l’écran d’accueil. 2 Appuyez sur Définir fond d’écran→Écran d’accueil→ un dossier → une image. › Modifier la police 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Affichage→Police. 2 Sélectionnez une police →Oui.31 Démarrage › Régler la luminosité de l’écran Votre appareil est doté d’un capteur de luminosité capable de détecter le niveau de lumière ambiante et d’ajuster la luminosité de l'écran automatiquement. Vous pouvez également régler manuellement la luminosité de l’écran. La luminosité de l’écran influe sur la vitesse de déchargement de la batterie. Régler la luminosité de l'écran automatiquement 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Affichage→Luminosité. 2 Cochez la case Luminosité automatique. 3 Appuyez sur OK. L’appareil augmente automatiquement la luminosité de l’écran dans les environnements éclairés et la diminue dans les environnements sombres. Régler la luminosité de l’écran manuellement 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Affichage→Luminosité. 2 Décochez la case Luminosité automatique. 3 Faites glisser le curseur vers la gauche ou la droite. 4 Appuyez sur OK.32 Démarrage › Verrouiller l’appareil Vous pouvez sécuriser l'utilisation de votre appareil en définissant un mode de déverrouillage d'écran. ● Si vous oubliez votre mot de passe, modèle ou code PIN de déverrouillage d'écran, confiez l’appareil à un centre de service après-vente Samsung pour le réinitialiser. ● Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable en cas de perte éventuelle de mots de passe, d’informations confidentielles ou d’autres dommages résultant de l’utilisation de logiciels illégaux. Déverrouillage à l’aide de la détection des visages 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres →Ecran de verrouillage→Déverrouillage de l’écran→ Déverrouillage visage. 2 Appuyez sur Suivant→Configurer→Continuer. 3 Placez votre visage dans la zone dédiée. 4 Une fois la prise de vue correctement effectuée, appuyez sur Continuer. 5 Terminez la configuration en définissant un code PIN ou un modèle de déverrouillage de secours. Définir un modèle de déverrouillage 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres →Ecran de verrouillage→Déverrouillage de l’écran→ Modèle. 2 Prenez connaissance des instructions à l’écran et des exemples de modèles, puis appuyez sur Suivant. 3 Dessinez un modèle pour relier au moins 4 points et appuyez sur Continuer. 4 Dessinez à nouveau le modèle pour le valider et appuyez sur Confirmer.33 Démarrage 5 Terminez la configuration en définissant un code PIN de secours. Si vous oubliez votre modèle de déverrouillage, vous pouvez désactiver la fonction à l’aide du code PIN de secours. Définir un code PIN de déverrouillage 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Ecran de verrouillage→Déverrouillage de l’écran→Code PIN. 2 Saisissez un code PIN (numérique) de déverrouillage d'écran et appuyez sur Continuer. 3 Confirmez le code PIN, puis appuyez sur OK. Définir un mot de passe de déverrouillage 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Ecran de verrouillage→Déverrouillage de l’écran→Mot de passe. 2 Saisissez un mot de passe (alphanumérique) de déverrouillage d'écran et appuyez sur Continuer. 3 Confirmez le mot de passe, puis appuyez sur OK. ›Activer la fonction de traçage du mobile Si vous avez égaré votre appareil ou s’il vous a été volé, vous pouvez le localiser sur le site Web SamsungDive (www.samsungdive.com). Pour utiliser cette fonction, vous devez créer un compte Samsung pour contrôler l’appareil à distance via Internet. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Sécurité→Contrôle à distance→OK→Ajouter compte. 2 Appuyez sur Connexion. Pour créer un compte Samsung, appuyez sur Créer un compte. 3 Saisissez l’adresse e-mail et le mot de passe de votre compte Samsung, puis appuyez sur Connexion.34 Démarrage 4 Faites glisser le curseur situé en haut de l'écran vers la droite pour activer la fonction. Saisir du texte Vous pouvez saisir du texte en prononçant les mots dans le microphone ou en appuyant sur les caractères du clavier virtuel. La saisie de texte n’est pas prise en charge dans certaines langues. Pour saisir du texte, vous devez sélectionner une langue prise en charge. › Changer le mode de saisie 1 Appuyez sur une zone de saisie et ouvrez le volet des raccourcis. 2 Appuyez sur Mode de saisie→ un mode de saisie. › Saisir du texte avec la fonction de saisie vocale de Google 1 Pour ajouter des langues de saisie pour la reconnaissance vocale, appuyez sur la langue →Ajouter des langues. 2 Parlez dans le microphone. 3 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur Appuyez pour interrompre. › Saisir du texte avec le clavier Samsung Saisissez le texte en appuyant sur les touches alphanumériques. Vous pouvez également utiliser les touches suivantes :35 Démarrage Numéro Fonction 1 Modifier la casse. 2 Basculer entre les modes de saisie. 3 Accéder aux paramètres du clavier. Saisir du texte oralement (maintenir la touche enfoncée). 4 Insérer un espace. 5 Effacer la saisie. 6 Effectuer un retour à la ligne. 7 Ajouter un élément à partir du presse-papiers. › Copier et coller du texte Lorsque vous saisissez du texte, vous pouvez exploiter la fonction copier-coller pour utiliser le même texte dans d’autres applications. 1 Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur un passage de texte. 2 Faites glisser l'icône ou pour sélectionner le texte à copier. 3 Appuyez Copie ou sur Couper pour ajouter du texte dans le presse-papiers. 4 Dans une autre application, positionnez le curseur à l’emplacement où vous souhaitez insérer le texte. 5 Appuyez sur →Coller pour insérer le texte du pressepapiers dans le champ de saisie.Services Web et GPS 36 Services Web et GPS L’accès à Internet et le téléchargement de fichiers multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. Internet Découvrez comment accéder à des pages Web et enregistrer vos favoris. ● Cette fonction peut s’intituler différemment selon votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur. ● La disponibilité de certaines icônes dépend de votre pays ou de votre opérateur. ›Naviguer sur une page Web 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Internet. 2 Pour accéder à une page Web spécifique, appuyez sur le champ de l’URL, saisissez l’adresse de la page Web, puis appuyez sur Aller à. 3 Utilisez les touches suivantes pour naviguer sur les pages Web :Services Web et GPS 37 Numéro Fonction 1 Ouvrir une nouvelle fenêtre. 2 Fermer la fenêtre ouverte. 3 Revenir à la page précédente ou passer à la page suivante de l’historique. 4 Actualiser la page Web en cours. En cours d’actualisation, cette icône devient . 5 Saisir une adresse Web ou un mot-clé. 6 Accéder aux options du navigateur Web. 7 Afficher vos favoris, vos pages enregistrées et l’historique des pages fréquemment visitées. 8 Activer le champ de saisie de l’URL. 9 Créer un favori pour la page Web affichée. Lorsque vous naviguez sur une page Web, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour effectuer un zoom avant, posez vos deux doigts joints sur l’écran et écartez-les lentement, puis rapprochez-les. Pour revenir à la taille d’origine, appuyez deux fois sur l’écran. ● Pour ouvrir une nouvelle fenêtre, appuyez sur →Nouvel onglet. ● Pour ouvrir la page Web dans une nouvelle fenêtre sans enregistrer les données de navigation, appuyez sur → Nouvel onglet privé. ● Pour ajouter, sur l’écran d’accueil, un raccourci vers la page Web affichée, appuyez sur →Ajouter raccourci à l’écran d’accueil. ● Pour envoyer l'adresse Web à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur →Partager page. ● Pour rechercher du texte sur la page Web, appuyez sur → Rech. sur page. ● Pour changer le mode d'affichage, appuyez sur →Affichage bureau.Services Web et GPS 38 ● Pour enregistrer la page Web en cours afin de la lire hors connexion, appuyez sur →Enregistrer pour la lecture hors connexion. Vous pouvez afficher les pages enregistrées en appuyant sur →Pages enregistrées. ● Pour afficher l’historique des téléchargements, appuyez sur →Téléchargements. ● Pour imprimer la page Web via une connexion Wi-Fi ou USB, appuyez sur →Imprimer. Votre appareil est compatible uniquement avec certaines imprimantes Samsung. ● Pour modifier les paramètres du navigateur, appuyez sur → Paramètres. › Rechercher des informations vocalement La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Internet. 2 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie de l’URL. 3 Appuyez sur et prononcez un mot-clé dans le microphone de l’appareil. L’appareil recherche les pages Web contenant ce mot-clé. 4 Sélectionnez un résultat de recherche. › Créer des favoris de pages Web Vous pouvez ajouter un favori manuellement si vous connaissez l’adresse de la page Web. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Internet. 2 Saisissez une adresse Web ou naviguez sur une page Web. 3 Appuyez sur . 4 Saisissez le nom du favori, puis appuyez sur OK.Services Web et GPS 39 › Télécharger un fichier depuis Internet Lorsque vous téléchargez des fichiers ou des applications depuis Internet, votre appareil les enregistre dans la mémoire interne. Les fichiers téléchargés depuis Internet peuvent contenir des virus potentiellement dangereux pour votre appareil. Pour réduire les risques, téléchargez uniquement des fichiers provenant de sources fiables. Certains fichiers multimédia intègrent le système de Gestion des droits numériques (DRM) visant à protéger les droits d’auteur. Cette protection peut empêcher le téléchargement, la copie, la modification ou le transfert de certains fichiers. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Internet. 2 Recherchez un fichier ou une application et téléchargez l'élément sur l’appareil. ›Afficher l’historique récent 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Internet→ → →Historique. 2 Sélectionnez une page Web à ouvrir. Game Hub Découvrez comment accéder à des jeux et les télécharger. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Game Hub. 2 Sélectionnez un service de jeux. 3 Recherchez des jeux dans la boutique en ligne, puis téléchargez-les. La disponibilité des jeux dépend de votre zone géographique et de votre opérateur.Services Web et GPS 40 Cartes Découvrez comment utiliser le service de cartes Google Maps ™ pour rechercher votre position ou des lieux, et calculer un itinéraire. ● La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● Pour trouver votre position et effectuer une recherche sur la carte, vous devez activer les services de localisation. ► p. 94 › Rechercher un lieu 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Maps. La carte affiche votre position actuelle. 2 Appuyez sur Rechercher. 3 Saisissez un mot-clé pour la localisation, puis appuyez sur . Pour effectuer une recherche oralement, appuyez sur . 4 Sélectionnez la position pour en afficher les détails. En mode affichage de la carte, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour effectuer un zoom avant, posez vos deux doigts joints sur l’écran et écartez-les lentement, puis rapprochez-les. ● Pour afficher tous les résultats de recherche, appuyez sur Résultats de recherche. ● Pour afficher votre position actuelle, appuyez sur . Pour passer en vue boussole et modifier l’orientation lorsque vous déplacez l’appareil, appuyez sur . ● Pour obtenir un itinéraire vers une destination spécifique, appuyez sur . ● Pour ajouter un lieu à vos favoris, appuyez sur le nom du lieu, puis sur →Enregistrer le lieu.Services Web et GPS 41 ● Pour enregistrer la carte et pouvoir la consulter en mode horsligne, appuyez sur →Disponible hors connexion. Pour afficher la carte enregistrée, appuyez sur →Mes adresses→ HORS CONNEXION. ● Pour rechercher un lieu à proximité, appuyez sur →Local. ● Pour ajouter des données géographiques à la carte ou modifier le mode d’affichage, appuyez sur →Calques. ● Pour partager votre position avec vos amis, appuyez sur → Latitude. › Partager votre position à l’aide de Google Latitude Découvrez comment partager votre position avec vos amis et afficher leur position avec le service de localisation Google Latitude ™. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Maps. 2 Appuyez sur →Latitude. L’appareil se connecte automatiquement à Latitude. 3 Appuyez sur →Ajouter des amis→ une option. 4 Sélectionnez un ami ou saisissez une adresse e-mail, puis appuyez sur Ajouter des amis. 5 Appuyez sur Oui. Lorsque votre ami accepte l’invitation, vous pouvez partager vos positions.Services Web et GPS 42 › Calculer un itinéraire vers une destination spécifique 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Maps. 2 Appuyez sur . 3 Saisissez les adresses du lieu de départ et du lieu de destination. Pour saisir une adresse à partir de votre liste de contacts ou de vos lieux favoris, ou pour sélectionner un point sur la carte, appuyez sur → une option. 4 Sélectionnez un mode de déplacement, puis appuyez sur OK. L’itinéraire est indiqué sur la carte. En fonction du mode de déplacement sélectionné, plusieurs itinéraires peuvent s’afficher. 5 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur →Effacer résultats. Navigation Découvrez comment obtenir des instructions vocales qui vous guideront vers votre destination. ● Les cartes, votre position actuelle et autres données de navigation peuvent différer des informations de localisation réelles. Soyez attentif aux conditions de trafic, à l’état de la route et à tous les autres facteurs qui pourraient affecter votre conduite, et respectez le code de la route et les consignes de sécurité en vigueur. ● La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.Services Web et GPS 43 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Navigation. 2 Saisissez votre destination en utilisant l’une des méthodes suivantes : ● Énoncer destination : prononcer le nom de la destination. ● Saisir destination : saisir la destination à l’aide du clavier virtuel. ● Contacts : sélectionner la destination à partir de votre liste de contacts. ● Adresses enregistrées : sélectionner la destination à partir de la liste de vos lieux favoris. 3 Installez le logiciel requis, puis utilisez les fonctions de navigation. Local Découvrez comment rechercher des commerces ou sites touristiques à proximité de votre position. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Local. 2 Si vous souhaitez rechercher des commerces ou des lieux touristiques à proximité d’un lieu spécifique, sélectionnez votre position →Saisir une adresse. 3 Choisissez une catégorie. L’appareil recherche des lieux à proximité de votre position actuelle en fonction de la catégorie choisie. 4 Sélectionnez le nom d’un lieu pour en afficher les détails. Vous pouvez ajouter des catégories supplémentaires en appuyant sur →Ajouter une recherche.Services Web et GPS 44 Play Livres Parcourez et téléchargez des livres électroniques grâce à Google Play Livres. Vous pouvez également lire des livres électroniques sur votre appareil. Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Play Livres. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. Play Films Parcourez et louez des films grâce à Google Play Films. Vous pouvez également regarder des films sur votre appareil. Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Play Films. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. Play Store Les fonctionnalités de votre appareil peuvent être enrichies grâce à l’installation d’applications supplémentaires. Play Store vous permet d’acquérir facilement et rapidement des applications et des jeux pour mobiles. ● La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● L’appareil enregistre les fichiers utilisateur des applications téléchargées dans la mémoire interne. Services Web et GPS 45 › Télécharger une application 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Play Store. 2 Localisez une application et téléchargez-la sur l’appareil. Une fois le téléchargement terminé, l’appareil installe l’application automatiquement. ›Désinstaller une application 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Play Store. 2 Appuyez sur . 3 Sélectionnez un élément. 4 Appuyez sur Désinstaller→OK. Reader Hub Découvrez comment accéder à un vaste choix de supports de lecture. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Reader Hub. 2 Sélectionnez un type de support de lecture. 3 Recherchez un support de lecture dans le magasin en ligne, puis téléchargez-le.Services Web et GPS 46 Samsung Apps Samsung Apps vous permet de télécharger en toute simplicité une vaste quantité d’applications et de mises à jour dans votre appareil. Grâce aux applications parfaitement optimisées de Samsung Apps, votre appareil devient plus intelligent. Découvrez des applications utiles et profitez pleinement de la vie avec votre appareil mobile. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Samsung Apps. Si vous lancez cette application pour la première fois, l’appareil vous invite à sélectionner votre zone géographique. 2 Recherchez et téléchargez des applications sur votre appareil. ● La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● Pour plus d’informations, visitez le site www.samsungapps.com ou reportez-vous à la brochure Samsung Apps. S Suggest Recherchez et téléchargez les dernières applications suggérées par Samsung. Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur S Suggest. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. YouTube Découvrez comment visionner et charger des vidéos via le service de partage de vidéos YouTube ™. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.Services Web et GPS 47 › Lire une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur YouTube. 2 Sélectionnez une vidéo. 3 Les touches suivantes permettent de contrôler la lecture : Numéro Fonction 1 Interrompre ou reprendre la lecture. 2 Effectuer une avance ou un retour rapide dans le fichier en faisant glisser la barre. 3 Lire la vidéo en plein écran. › Télécharger une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur YouTube. 2 Sélectionnez votre compte Google s’il est lié à YouTube. Vous pouvez également appuyer sur →Connexion→ Ajouter compte et configurer un compte pour vous connecter à YouTube. 3 Appuyez sur → une catégorie → une vidéo. Si vous chargez une vidéo pour la première fois, sélectionnez un type de réseau compatible. 4 Saisissez les détails du chargement et appuyez sur Envoyer.Services Web et GPS 48 Video Hub Découvrez comment accéder aux vidéos. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Video Hub. 2 Choisissez une catégorie. 3 Recherchez et accédez aux vidéos. Recherche vocale Découvrez comment effectuer une recherche sur Internet oralement. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Recherche vocale. 2 Prononcez un mot-clé dans le microphone. L’appareil recherche les pages Web contenant ce mot-clé. 3 Sélectionnez un résultat de recherche.Communication 49 Communication Google Mail Découvrez comment envoyer ou consulter des e-mails via le service de messagerie électronique Google Mail ™. ● La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ● Cette fonction peut s’intituler différemment selon votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur. › Envoyer un e-mail 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Google Mail→ . 2 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie du destinataire et saisissez une adresse e-mail. 3 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie de l’objet et indiquez un objet. 4 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie du texte et rédigez votre message. 5 Appuyez sur et joignez un fichier. 6 Pour envoyer un message, appuyez sur ENVOYER. Si vous êtes hors connexion, le message est conservé dans le fil de discussion jusqu’à votre prochaine connexion.Communication 50 ›Afficher un e-mail 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Google Mail. 2 Appuyez sur pour mettre à jour la liste des messages. 3 Sélectionnez un e-mail. Dans la fenêtre du message, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour passer au message suivant ou revenir au message précédent, faites défiler l’écran vers la droite ou la gauche. ● Pour répondre à un message, appuyez sur . ● Pour répondre au message en incluant tous les destinataires, appuyez sur . ● Pour transférer le message à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur . ● Pour ajouter un message à la liste des favoris, appuyez sur . ● Pour archiver le message, appuyez sur . ● Pour supprimer le message, appuyez sur . ● Pour ajouter un libellé au message, appuyez sur . ● Pour appliquer le statut Non lu au message, appuyez sur . ● Pour identifier un message comme non important, appuyez sur →Marquer comme non important. ● Pour masquer le message, appuyez sur →Ignorer. Pour afficher les messages masqués, appuyez sur Tous les messages dans la liste des libellés. ● Pour ajouter le message à la liste du courrier indésirable, appuyez sur →Signaler comme spam ou Signaler comme phishing. ● Pour personnaliser les paramètres des e-mails, appuyez sur → Paramètres. La disponibilité des options dépend du compte de messagerie électronique ou de l’orientation de l’appareil.Communication 51 E-mail Découvrez comment envoyer ou consulter des e-mails via votre compte de messagerie électronique personnel ou professionnel. › Créer un compte e-mail 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur E-mail. 2 Saisissez votre adresse e-mail et votre mot de passe. 3 Appuyez sur Suivant. Pour saisir manuellement les détails du compte, appuyez sur Config. manuelle. 4 Suivez les instructions qui s’affichent à l’écran. Une fois que vous avez créé le compte de messagerie, les e-mails sont téléchargés sur votre appareil. Si vous avez créé plusieurs comptes, vous pouvez passer d’un compte e-mail à l’autre aisément. Pour ce faire, appuyez sur un nom de compte en haut de l’écran, puis sélectionnez celui à partir duquel vous voulez récupérer les messages. › Envoyer un e-mail 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur E-mail→ . 2 Ajoutez des destinataires : ● Entrez manuellement les adresses e-mail, en les séparant par un point-virgule ou une virgule. ● Sélectionnez les adresses e-mail dans la liste de vos contacts en appuyant sur . 3 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie de l’objet et indiquez un objet. 4 Appuyez sur le champ de saisie du texte et rédigez votre message.Communication 52 5 Appuyez sur et joignez un fichier. 6 Pour envoyer un message, appuyez sur Envoyer. Si vous êtes hors connexion, le message est conservé dans le fil de discussion jusqu’à votre prochaine connexion. ›Afficher un e-mail 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur E-mail. 2 Appuyez sur pour mettre à jour la liste des messages. 3 Sélectionnez un e-mail. Dans la fenêtre du message, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour passer au message suivant ou revenir au message précédent, appuyez sur ou . ● Pour rédiger un nouveau message, appuyez sur . ● Pour répondre à un message, appuyez sur . ● Pour transférer le message à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur . ● Pour supprimer le message, appuyez sur . ● Pour appliquer le statut Non lu au message, appuyez sur → Marquer comme Non lu. ● Pour déplacer le message vers un autre dossier, appuyez sur →Déplacer. ● Pour enregistrer le message sur votre appareil, appuyez sur →Enregistrer e-mail. Le message est enregistré dans Mes fichiers→sdcard0→Saved Email. ● Pour imprimer le message à l’aide d’une connexion Wi-Fi ou USB, appuyez sur →Imprimer. Votre appareil est compatible uniquement avec certaines imprimantes Samsung.Communication 53 ● Pour enregistrer l’adresse e-mail des destinataires dans votre répertoire sous forme de groupe de contacts, appuyez sur → Enreg. comme groupe. ● Pour personnaliser les paramètres des e-mails, appuyez sur →Paramètres. ● Pour enregistrer une pièce jointe sur votre appareil, appuyez sur l’onglet des pièces jointes → . La disponibilité des options dépend du compte de messagerie électronique ou de l’orientation de l’appareil. Talk Découvrez comment échanger des messages instantanés avec votre famille ou vos amis par l’intermédiaire du service de messagerie instantanée Google Talk ™. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. ›Définir votre statut 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Talk. 2 Sélectionnez un compte Google. 3 Personnalisez votre statut, ainsi que votre image et votre message. ›Ajouter un contact à votre liste d’amis 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Talk→ . 2 Saisissez l’adresse e-mail d’un ami et appuyez sur TERMINÉ. Lorsque votre ami accepte l’invitation, ce dernier est ajouté à votre liste d’amis.Communication 54 ›Démarrer une conversation 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Talk. 2 Sélectionnez un contact dans la liste de vos amis. L’écran de conversation apparaît. 3 Saisissez votre message et envoyez-le. ● Pour ajouter d’autres contacts à une conversation, appuyez sur →Ajouter au chat. ● Pour utiliser le chat vidéo, appuyez sur . ● Pour utiliser le chat vocal, appuyez sur . 4 Appuyez sur →Arrêter le chat pour terminer la conversation. ChatON Découvrez comment utiliser ChatON pour envoyer et recevoir des messages instantanés depuis n’importe quel appareil associé à un numéro de téléphone portable. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur ChatON. Si vous lancez cette application pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à la configuration du compte. 2 Saisissez votre message et envoyez-le.Communication 55 Chat+ Découvrez comment échanger des messages instantanés avec votre famille ou vos amis par l’intermédiaire du service de messagerie instantanée Chat+. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Chat +. Si vous lancez cette application pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à la configuration du compte. 2 Saisissez votre message et envoyez-le. Google+ Découvrez comment accéder au service de réseau social de Google. Vous pouvez créer des groupes pour recevoir et envoyer des messages instantanés, et télécharger vos photos. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Google+. Si vous lancez cette application pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à la configuration du compte. 2 Sélectionnez une fonction de réseau social.56 Divertissements Divertissements Appareil photo Découvrez comment capturer et visionner des photos et des vidéos. ● L’appareil photo s’éteint automatiquement lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas pendant un certain temps. ● Il est possible que les capacités de la mémoire diffèrent en fonction de la scène photographiée ou des conditions de prise de vue. › Prendre une photo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Appareil photo. 2 Faites pivoter l’appareil vers la gauche pour passer en mode paysage. 3 Pointez l’objectif de l’appareil photo vers le sujet et procédez aux réglages nécessaires.57 Divertissements Numéro Fonction 1 Raccourcis de l’appareil photo : ●  : activer l’objectif photo avant et prendre une photo de vous-même. ●  : changer le mode de prise de vue. ► p. 59 ●  : sélectionner le délai à l’issue duquel l’appareil doit prendre une photo. ●  : appliquer un effet spécial. ●  : régler la valeur d’exposition pour modifier la luminosité. Vous pouvez ajouter ou supprimer des raccourcis vers les options les plus fréquemment utilisées. ► p. 64 2 Modifier les paramètres de l’appareil photo. 3 Emplacement de stockage. 4 Passer en mode Caméscope. 5 Prendre une photo. 6 Afficher les photos que vous avez prises. Pour effectuer un zoom avant, placez deux doigts sur l’écran et écartez-les doucement. Pour effectuer un zoom arrière, rapprochez-les. Vous pouvez également effectuer un zoom avant ou arrière à l’aide de la touche de volume. Il est possible que la fonction de zoom ne soit pas disponible lors d’une prise de vue avec la résolution la plus élevée. 4 Appuyez sur pour prendre une photo. La photo est enregistrée automatiquement.58 Divertissements Après avoir pris une photo, appuyez sur l’écran d’aperçu pour la visionner. ● Pour afficher plus de photos, faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite. ● Pour effectuer un zoom avant, posez vos deux doigts joints sur l’écran et écartez-les doucement. Pour effectuer un zoom arrière, rapprochez-les. Pour revenir à la taille d’origine, appuyez deux fois sur l’écran. ● Pour ajouter la photo à la liste des favoris, appuyez sur . ● Pour envoyer la photo à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur . ● Pour supprimer la photo, appuyez sur . ● Pour lancer un diaporama, appuyez sur →Diaporama→ Lancer le diaporama. Pour arrêter le diaporama, appuyez sur l’écran. ● Pour modifier les paramètres d’un diaporama, appuyez sur → Diaporama→Paramètres du diaporama. ● Pour enregistrer les visages de la photo comme libellés, appuyez sur →Libellé de portrait. ► p. 68 ● Pour ajouter la photo au presse-papiers, appuyez sur → Copier dans le presse-papiers. ● Pour faire pivoter la photo dans le sens inverse des aiguilles d’une montre, appuyez sur →Rotation à gauche. ● Pour faire pivoter la photo dans le sens des aiguilles d’une montre, appuyez sur →Rotation à droite. ● Pour couper une partie de l’image, appuyez sur →Rogner. ● Pour modifier la photo avec l’éditeur d’images ou de vidéos, appuyez sur →Modifier. ► p. 70, 71 ● Pour définir la photo en tant que fond d’écran ou l’attribuer à un contact, appuyez sur →Définir comme. ● Pour envoyer la photo à la personne dont le visage est utilisé comme libellé, appuyez sur →Partage de photo d’ami. ● Pour imprimer la photo via une connexion Wi-Fi ou USB, appuyez sur →Imprimer. Votre appareil est compatible uniquement avec certaines imprimantes Samsung. ● Pour changer le nom du fichier, appuyez sur →Renommer. ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur →Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour afficher les détails de la photo, appuyez sur →Détails.59 Divertissements › Changer le mode de prise de vue Vous pouvez prendre une photo avec divers effets de prise de vue. Pour changer le mode de prise de vue, appuyez sur →Mode de capture→ une option. Option Fonction Panorama Prendre des photos panoramiques. Partage Prendre une photo et l’envoyer à d’autres personnes via Wi-Fi Direct. Partage de photo d’ami Paramétrer l’appareil pour envoyer la photo à la personne dont le visage est utilisé comme libellé. Sourire Régler l’appareil pour qu’il reconnaisse les visages et vous aide à prendre des photos lorsque vos sujets sourient. › Personnaliser les paramètres de l’appareil photo Avant de prendre une photo, appuyez sur pour accéder aux options suivantes : Option Fonction Modifier les raccourcis Modifier les raccourcis vers les options fréquemment utilisées. Autoportrait Prendre des photos de vous-même en utilisant l’objectif avant. Mode de capture Changer le mode de prise de vue. Effets Appliquer un effet spécial. Mode scène Changer le mode scénique.60 Divertissements Option Fonction Valeur d’exposition Régler la valeur d’exposition pour modifier la luminosité. Retardateur Sélectionner le délai à l’issue duquel l’appareil doit prendre une photo. Résolution Sélectionner une option de résolution. Balance des blancs Régler la gamme de couleurs en fonction des conditions d’éclairage. Mesure Sélectionner un type de posemètre. Guide Afficher des lignes directrices sur l’écran de prévisualisation. Balise GPS Régler l’appareil pour qu’il ajoute des informations de localisation à vos photos. ● Pour améliorer la réception GPS, évitez de prendre des photos dans des lieux où le signal peut être limité, par exemple entre des bâtiments ou dans des zones de faible altitude, ou encore lorsque les conditions météorologiques sont mauvaises. ● Votre localisation peut apparaître sur vos photos lorsque vous les mettez sur Internet. Pour éviter cela, désactivez le paramètre Balise GPS. Qualité d’image Définir le niveau de qualité des photos. Stockage Sélectionner un emplacement d’enregistrement pour les photos prises. Réinitialiser Réinitialiser les paramètres de l’appareil photo.61 Divertissements › Enregistrer une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Appareil photo. 2 Faites pivoter l’appareil vers la gauche pour passer en mode paysage. 3 Faites glisser le curseur vers le caméscope. 4 Pointez l’objectif sur le sujet et procédez aux réglages nécessaires. Numéro Fonction 1 Raccourcis du caméscope : ●  : activer l’objectif photo avant et enregistrer une vidéo de vous-même. ●  : modifier le mode d’enregistrement (pour joindre la vidéo à un message ou pour l’enregistrer au format standard). ●  : sélectionner le délai à l’issue duquel le caméscope doit commencer à filmer. ●  : appliquer un effet spécial. ●  : régler la valeur d’exposition pour modifier la luminosité. Vous pouvez ajouter ou supprimer des raccourcis vers les options les plus fréquemment utilisées. ► p. 6462 Divertissements Numéro Fonction 2 Modifier les paramètres du caméscope. 3 Emplacement de stockage. 4 Basculer en mode Appareil photo. 5 Enregistrer une vidéo. 6 Afficher les vidéos que vous avez enregistrées. Pour effectuer un zoom avant, placez deux doigts sur l’écran et écartez-les doucement. Pour effectuer un zoom arrière, rapprochez-les. Vous pouvez également effectuer un zoom avant ou arrière à l’aide de la touche de volume. Il est possible que la fonction zoom ne soit pas disponible lorsque vous enregistrez une vidéo avec la résolution la plus élevée. 5 Appuyez sur pour commencer à enregistrer. 6 Appuyez sur pour arrêter l’enregistrement. La vidéo est enregistrée automatiquement. Il est possible que le caméscope ne puisse pas enregistrer des vidéos correctement sur les cartes mémoire dont le taux de transfert est lent. Après avoir enregistré une vidéo, appuyez sur l’écran d’aperçu pour la visionner. ● Faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite pour afficher plus de vidéos. ● Pour lire la vidéo, appuyez sur . ● Pour ajouter la vidéo à la liste des favoris, appuyez sur . ● Pour envoyer la vidéo à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur . ● Pour supprimer la vidéo, appuyez sur . ● Pour lancer un diaporama, appuyez sur →Diaporama→ Lancer le diaporama. Pour arrêter le diaporama, appuyez sur l’écran. ● Pour modifier les paramètres d’un diaporama, appuyez sur → Diaporama→Paramètres du diaporama. ● Pour changer le nom du fichier, appuyez sur →Renommer.63 Divertissements ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur →Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour afficher les détails de la vidéo, appuyez sur →Détails. › Personnaliser les paramètres du caméscope Avant de commencer à enregistrer une vidéo, appuyez sur pour accéder aux options suivantes : Option Fonction Modifier les raccourcis Modifier les raccourcis vers les options fréquemment utilisées. Autoportrait Activer l’objectif photo avant et enregistrer une vidéo de vous-même. Mode d’enregistrement Modifier le mode d’enregistrement (pour joindre la vidéo à un message ou pour l’enregistrer au format standard). Effets Appliquer un effet spécial. Valeur d’exposition Régler la valeur d’exposition pour modifier la luminosité. Retardateur Sélectionner le délai à l’issue duquel l’appareil doit commencer à enregistrer une vidéo. Résolution Sélectionner une option de résolution. Balance des blancs Régler la gamme de couleurs en fonction des conditions d’éclairage. Guide Afficher des lignes directrices sur l’écran de prévisualisation. Qualité vidéo Définir le niveau de qualité des vidéos. Stockage Sélectionner un emplacement de stockage par défaut où enregistrer les vidéos. Réinitialiser Réinitialiser les paramètres du caméscope.64 Divertissements › Modifier les icônes de raccourcis Vous pouvez ajouter ou supprimer des raccourcis vers les options les plus fréquemment utilisées. 1 Depuis l’écran de prévisualisation, appuyez sur →Modifier les raccourcis. 2 Maintenez le doigt appuyé sur une icône de la liste des options, puis faites-la glisser dans la zone des raccourcis. Pour supprimer des raccourcis, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur une icône, puis faites-la glisser dans la liste des options. 3 Appuyez sur l’écran pour revenir à l’écran de prévisualisation. Lecteur vidéo Découvrez comment utiliser le lecteur vidéo. ● Certains formats peuvent ne pas être compatibles selon la version logicielle de l’appareil. ● Une erreur peut se produire à l’ouverture d’un fichier si la taille de celui-ci dépasse la quantité de mémoire disponible. ● La qualité de lecture peut varier en fonction du type de contenu. ● Certains fichiers peuvent ne pas être lus correctement en fonction de leur encodage. › Lire une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Lecteur vidéo. 2 Sélectionnez une vidéo.65 Divertissements 3 Les touches suivantes permettent de contrôler la lecture : 11 12 10 Numéro Fonction 1 Régler le volume. 2 Changer le format de l’écran vidéo. 3 Couper le son. 4 Se déplacer dans le fichier en faisant glisser ou en appuyant sur la barre. 5 Reprendre la lecture depuis le début. Revenir au fichier précédent (appuyer dans un délai de 3 secondes). Effectuer un retour rapide dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée).66 Divertissements Numéro Fonction 6 Interrompre la lecture. Pour la reprendre, appuyer sur . 7 Capturer une image. 8 Réduire le format de l’écran vidéo. Pour revenir à la taille d’origine, appuyez deux fois sur l’écran vidéo. 9 Accéder aux options du lecteur vidéo. 10 Sélectionner un effet sonore. 11 Insérer un favori. 12 Passer au fichier suivant. Effectuer une avance rapide dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée). En cours de lecture, appuyez sur pour accéder aux options suivantes: ● Pour envoyer la vidéo à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur Partager via. ● Pour couper un segment de la vidéo, appuyez sur Rogner. ● Pour écouter de la musique via un casque Bluetooth, appuyez sur Par Bluetooth. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser cette option lorsque vous branchez un casque physiquement sur votre appareil. ● Pour modifier la vidéo avec l’éditeur de vidéos, appuyez sur Editeur de vidéos. ● Pour afficher vos favoris, appuyez sur Favoris. Cette option apparaît uniquement si vous avez inséré des favoris en cours de lecture. ● Pour afficher les détails de la vidéo, appuyez sur Détails. ● Pour configurer le lecteur vidéo pour qu’il s’éteigne automatiquement au bout d’un certain délai, appuyez sur Heure définie pour désactiver la vidéo auto. ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour modifier les paramètres du lecteur vidéo, appuyez sur Paramètres.67 Divertissements Galerie Découvrez comment visionner les images et les vidéos enregistrées dans votre appareil. ● Certains formats peuvent ne pas être compatibles selon la version logicielle de l’appareil. ● Une erreur peut se produire à l’ouverture d’un fichier si la taille de celui-ci dépasse la quantité de mémoire disponible. ● La qualité de lecture peut varier en fonction du type de contenu. ● Certains fichiers peuvent ne pas être lus correctement en fonction de leur encodage. ›Afficher une image 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Galerie. 2 Sélectionnez un dossier → une image. En mode affichage d’une image, utilisez les options suivantes: ● Pour afficher plus d’images, faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite. ● Pour effectuer un zoom avant, posez vos deux doigts joints sur l’écran et écartez-les doucement, puis rapprochez-les pour effectuer un zoom arrière. Pour revenir à la taille d’origine, appuyez deux fois sur l’écran. ● Pour ajouter la photo à la liste des favoris, appuyez sur . ● Pour envoyer l’image à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur . ● Pour supprimer l’image, appuyez sur . ● Pour lancer un diaporama, appuyez sur →Diaporama→ Lancer le diaporama. Pour arrêter le diaporama, appuyez sur l’écran. ● Pour modifier les paramètres d’un diaporama, appuyez sur → Diaporama→Paramètres du diaporama. ● Pour enregistrer les visages de la photo comme libellés, appuyez sur →Libellé de portrait. ► p. 68 ● Pour ajouter une image au presse-papiers, appuyez sur → Copier dans le presse-papiers.68 Divertissements ● Pour faire pivoter l’image dans le sens inverse des aiguilles d’une montre, appuyez sur →Rotation à gauche. ● Pour faire pivoter l’image dans le sens des aiguilles d’une montre, appuyez sur →Rotation à droite. ● Pour couper une partie de l’image, appuyez sur →Rogner. ● Pour modifier la photo avec l’éditeur d’images ou de vidéos, appuyez sur →Modifier. ► p. 70, 71 ● Pour définir la photo en tant que fond d’écran ou l’attribuer à un contact, appuyez sur →Définir comme. ● Pour envoyer la photo à la personne dont le visage est utilisé comme libellé, appuyez sur →Partage de photo d’ami. ● Pour imprimer l’image via une connexion Wi-Fi ou USB, appuyez sur →Imprimer. Votre appareil est compatible uniquement avec certaines imprimantes Samsung. ● Pour changer le nom du fichier, appuyez sur →Renommer. ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur →Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour afficher les détails de l’image, appuyez sur →Détails. Les options disponibles peuvent varier en fonction du dossier sélectionné. ›Ajouter un libellé de portrait à une image Découvrez comment ajouter des libellés de portrait aux images pour envoyer et télécharger des messages sur des réseaux sociaux à l’aide de raccourcis de libellés de portrait. Selon l’angle du visage, sa taille, son expression, les conditions lumineuses ou les accessoires portés par la personne, il est possible que la reconnaissance faciale ne fonctionne pas. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Galerie. 2 Sélectionnez une image.69 Divertissements 3 Appuyez sur →Libellé de portrait→Activé. Les portraits apparaissent dans le cadre. Si les visages ne sont pas reconnus automatiquement, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur un visage afin d’ajouter un cadre manuellement. 4 Sélectionnez un portrait, puis appuyez sur Ajouter un nom. 5 Sélectionnez le nom d’une personne dans la liste des contacts. Le contact est lié au portrait. Lorsque le libellé de portrait apparaît avec un nom, sélectionnez-le et utilisez les options disponibles. › Lire une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Galerie. 2 Sélectionnez un dossier → une vidéo (avec l’icône ). 3 Appuyez sur pour démarrer la lecture. 4 Contrôlez la lecture à l’aide des touches. ► p. 64 En cours de lecture, appuyez sur pour accéder aux options suivantes: ● Pour envoyer la vidéo à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur Partager via. ● Pour couper un segment de la vidéo, appuyez sur Rogner. ● Pour écouter de la musique via un casque Bluetooth, appuyez sur Par Bluetooth. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser cette option lorsque vous branchez un casque physiquement sur votre appareil. ● Pour modifier la vidéo avec l’éditeur de vidéos, appuyez sur Editeur de vidéos. ● Pour afficher vos favoris, appuyez sur Favoris. Cette option apparaît uniquement si vous avez inséré des favoris en cours de lecture. ● Pour afficher les détails de la vidéo, appuyez sur Détails. ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour modifier les paramètres du lecteur vidéo, appuyez sur Paramètres.70 Divertissements Editeur de photos Vous pouvez retoucher des images et appliquer plusieurs effets. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Editeur de photos. 2 Sélectionnez une image ou appuyez sur Sélectionner image → un dossier → une image. Pour prendre une nouvelle photo, appuyez sur Prendre une photo. 3 Appuyez sur Sélection→OK. 4 Faites glisser le doigt autour de la zone à sélectionner, puis appuyez sur . ● Pour changer le type d’outil de sélection, appuyez sur Sélection. ● Pour modifier la bordure de sélection, appuyez sur , ou . Si vous appuyez sur Magnétique ou Pinc., vous pouvez ajuster la taille de sélection en appuyant sur Taille de sélection. ● Pour inverser la sélection, appuyez sur Inverser. 5 Modifiez l’image en utilisant les outils suivants : Outil Fonction Pivoter Faire pivoter l’image. Redimensionner Redimensionner l’image en faisant glisser le rectangle ou en appuyant sur 100%→ une option. Rogner Rogner l’image en déplaçant ou en faisant glisser le rectangle. Couleur Appliquer un effet de couleur. Effet Appliquer un effet de filtre. Outils Utiliser des outils supplémentaires. Annuler votre dernière opération. Répéter votre dernière opération.71 Divertissements 6 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur . 7 Saisissez le nom de l’image, puis appuyez sur OK. Editeur de vidéos Vous pouvez éditer des vidéos et appliquer plusieurs effets. › Créer une vidéo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Editeur de vidéos. 2 Faites pivoter l’appareil vers la gauche pour passer en mode paysage. 3 Sélectionnez un thème. 4 Appuyez sur Ajouter des fichiers. 5 Sélectionnez une catégorie dans le volet de gauche et choisissez des images, des vidéos et des contenus audio pour réaliser la vidéo, puis appuyez sur OK. ● Pour définir la durée pendant laquelle une image apparaît, appuyez sur la miniature, puis faites-en glisser la bordure gauche ou droite. ● Pour supprimer des images ou des vidéos, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l'élément et faites-le glisser vers la corbeille. ● Pour déplacer des images ou des vidéos, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l'élément et faites-le glisser vers un nouvel emplacement. 6 Sélectionnez une icône d’effet de transition entre les images ou les vidéos, puis choisissez un effet. 7 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur →Export de film. 8 Sélectionnez une option de résolution. 9 Saisissez le nom de la vidéo, puis appuyez sur OK.72 Divertissements › Couper un segment de vidéo 1 Lancez l’éditeur de vidéos et ouvrez un fichier vidéo. 2 Appuyez sur la miniature. 3 Déplacez le crochet de départ vers le point où vous souhaitez commencer à rogner la vidéo. 4 Déplacez le crochet de fin vers le point où vous souhaitez terminer de rogner la vidéo. 5 Enregistrez la vidéo éditée. ›Diviser une vidéo 1 Lancez l’éditeur de vidéos et ouvrez un fichier vidéo. 2 Appuyez sur la miniature. 3 Faites glisser la miniature vers le bas de l’écran pour positionner la ligne de pointillés jaunes. 4 Appuyez sur . 5 Enregistrez la vidéo éditée. ›Appliquer un effet à une vidéo 1 Lancez l’éditeur de vidéos et ouvrez un fichier vidéo. 2 Faites glisser la miniature vers le bas de l’écran pour positionner la ligne de pointillés jaunes. 3 Appuyez sur Effet vidéo→ une option d’effet. 4 Enregistrez la vidéo éditée.73 Divertissements Lecteur MP3 Découvrez comment écouter vos morceaux de musique favoris à tout moment. ● Certains formats peuvent ne pas être compatibles selon la version logicielle de l’appareil. ● Une erreur peut se produire à l’ouverture d’un fichier si la taille de celui-ci dépasse la quantité de mémoire disponible. ● La qualité de lecture peut varier en fonction du type de contenu. ● Certains fichiers peuvent ne pas être lus correctement en fonction de leur encodage. ›Ajouter des fichiers audio sur l’appareil Commencez par transférer des fichiers dans l’appareil ou sur une carte mémoire : ● Téléchargez à partir d’Internet. ► p. 36 ● Téléchargez depuis un ordinateur à l’aide du logiciel Samsung Kies. ► p. 83 ● Téléchargez depuis un ordinateur à l’aide du lecteur Windows Media. ► p. 84 ● Recevez des fichiers par l’intermédiaire de la fonction Bluetooth. ► p. 94 › Écouter de la musique 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Lecteur MP3. 2 Sélectionnez une catégorie de musique → un fichier audio. 3 Sélectionnez l’image de l’album pour ouvrir l’écran du lecteur MP3.74 Divertissements 4 Les touches suivantes permettent de contrôler la lecture : Numéro Fonction 1 Régler le volume. 2 Définir le fichier comme votre morceau favori. 3 Couper le son. 4 Effectuer une avance ou un retour rapide dans le fichier en faisant glisser ou en appuyant sur la barre. 5 Activer le mode Aléatoire. 6 Reprendre la lecture depuis le début. Revenir au fichier précédent (appuyer dans un délai de 3 secondes). Effectuer un retour rapide dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée).75 Divertissements Numéro Fonction 7 Interrompre la lecture. Pour la reprendre, appuyer sur . 8 Afficher les détails du fichier. 9 Ouvrir la liste de lecture. 10 Accéder aux options du lecteur. 11 Sélectionner un effet sonore. 12 Changer le mode de répétition. 13 Passer au fichier suivant. Effectuer une avance rapide dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée). Vous pouvez contrôler le lecteur MP3 avec un casque. Depuis l’écran d’accueil, maintenez la touche du casque enfoncée pour démarrer le lecteur MP3. Appuyez ensuite sur la touche du casque pour lancer ou interrompre la lecture. En cours de lecture, appuyez sur pour accéder aux options suivantes : ● Pour ajouter le fichier audio à la liste de lecture, appuyez sur Liste de lecture. ● Pour écouter de la musique via un casque Bluetooth, appuyez sur Par Bluetooth. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser cette option lorsque vous branchez physiquement un casque sur votre appareil. ● Pour envoyer le fichier audio à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur Partager via. ● Pour définir le fichier audio comme alarme, appuyez sur Définir comme tonalité d’alarme. ● Pour rechercher des appareils sur lesquels le partage multimédia est activé, appuyez sur Rechercher des périphériques. ● Pour modifier les paramètres du lecteur MP3, appuyez sur Paramètres.76 Divertissements › Créer une liste de lecture 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Lecteur MP3. 2 Appuyez sur →Nouvelle liste de lecture. 3 Saisissez le titre de la nouvelle liste de lecture, puis appuyez sur OK. 4 Choisissez une catégorie de musique. 5 Sélectionnez les fichiers à ajouter et appuyez sur OK. › Personnaliser les paramètres du lecteur MP3 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Lecteur MP3. 2 Appuyez sur →Paramètres. 3 Modifiez les options suivantes : Option Fonction Paramètres avancés → SoundAlive Sélectionner un effet sonore. Paramètres avancés → Vitesse de lecture Modifier la vitesse de lecture. Paramètres avancés → Paroles Configurer l’appareil pour qu'il affiche les paroles lors de la lecture d’un morceau (si disponibles). Paramètres avancés → Arrêt auto de la musique Paramétrer le lecteur MP3 pour qu’il s’éteigne automatiquement après une période de temps donnée. Menu musique Sélectionner les catégories de musique à afficher dans la bibliothèque.77 Divertissements Music Hub Vous pouvez accéder au magasin de musique en ligne et télécharger vos morceaux préférés. Vous pouvez également ajouter des morceaux à votre liste de souhaits et les écouter. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Music Hub. 2 Recherchez vos morceaux favoris, écoutez-en un extrait ou achetez-les.Données personnelles 78 Données personnelles Contacts Découvrez comment créer et gérer la liste de vos contacts personnels ou professionnels. Pour tous vos contacts, vous pouvez enregistrer des noms, des numéros de téléphone, des adresses e-mail et de nombreuses autres informations. › Créer un contact 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts→ . 2 Sélectionnez un emplacement de stockage. 3 Saisissez les coordonnées du contact. 4 Appuyez sur pour enregistrer le contact dans la mémoire sélectionnée. › Rechercher un contact 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts. 2 Faites défiler la liste de contacts vers le haut ou le bas. 3 Sélectionnez le nom du contact. Dans la fenêtre du contact, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour envoyer un e-mail, appuyez sur . ● Pour définir le contact comme contact favori, appuyez sur . ● Pour modifier les coordonnées du contact, appuyez sur → Modifier.Données personnelles 79 › Créer une carte de visite 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts. 2 Sélectionnez votre nom en haut de l’écran de la liste de contacts. 3 Appuyez sur →Modifier. 4 Saisissez vos coordonnées et appuyez sur . Vous pouvez envoyer votre carte de visite à d’autres personnes en appuyant sur →Partager carte de visite via. › Créer un groupe de contacts En créant des groupes de contacts, vous pouvez gérer plusieurs contacts simultanément et envoyer un message à tous les membres d’un groupe. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts→Groupes→ . 2 Saisissez le nom du groupe, puis personnalisez les paramètres du groupe. 3 Ajoutez des membres au groupe. 4 Appuyez sur . ›Importer ou exporter un contact Vous pouvez importer ou exporter des fichiers (au format vcf) vers et depuis le stockage USB ou la carte mémoire de votre appareil. Importer des fichiers de contacts 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts. 2 Appuyez sur →Importer/Exporter→Importer depuis la carte SD ou Importer depuis stockage USB. 3 Sélectionnez un emplacement de stockage.Données personnelles 80 4 Choisissez entre importer un seul contact, plusieurs contacts ou l’ensemble des contacts, puis appuyez sur OK. 5 Sélectionnez les contacts à importer et appuyez sur OK. Exporter des contacts 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Contacts→ Contacts. 2 Appuyez sur →Importer/Exporter→Exporter vers la carte SD ou Exporter vers le stockage USB. 3 Appuyez sur OK pour confirmer. S Calendrier Votre appareil est équipé d'un calendrier performant destiné à vous aider à organiser vos rendez-vous de façon plus pratique et plus efficace. Découvrez comment créer et gérer des événements et des tâches, et définir des alarmes de rappel. › Créer un événement ou une tâche 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur S Calendrier. 2 Appuyez sur . 3 Sélectionnez un type d’événement en haut de l’écran. 4 Saisissez les détails de l’événement et appuyez sur Enregistrer. › Modifier le mode d’affichage 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur SCalendrier. 2 Sélectionnez un mode d’affichage. ● Année : tous les mois de l’année. ● Mois : un mois entier.Données personnelles 81 ● Semaine : semaine complète décomposée en tranches horaires. ● Jour : journée complète décomposée en tranches horaires. ● Liste : liste de l’ensemble des événements et congés programmés pour une période spécifique. ● Tâche : liste des tâches. Vous pouvez également changer le mode d’affichage en plaçant deux doigts sur l’écran, puis en les rapprochant ou en les écartant. ›Afficher un événement ou une tâche 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur SCalendrier. 2 Sélectionnez une date dans le calendrier. ● Pour accéder à une date spécifique, appuyez sur →Aller à, puis saisissez une date. ● Pour accéder à la date du jour, appuyez sur Aujourd’hui. 3 Sélectionnez un événement pour en afficher les détails. Vous pouvez envoyer l’événement à d’autres personnes en appuyant sur →Partager via. ›Arrêter l’alarme d’un événement ou d’une tâche Si vous définissez un rappel pour un événement ou une tâche du calendrier, une alarme retentira à l’heure spécifiée. 1 Pour ouvrir le volet des raccourcis, appuyez en bas et à droite de l’écran. 2 Appuyez sur la notification d’événements. 3 Sélectionnez un événement pour en afficher les détails. Pour répéter l’alarme de l’événement, appuyez sur Répétition.Données personnelles 82 Mémo Découvrez comment enregistrer une information importante pour la consulter ultérieurement. › Créer un mémo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Mémo. 2 Appuyez sur . 3 Saisissez le texte de votre mémo. 4 Appuyez sur Effectué. ›Afficher un mémo 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Mémo. 2 Sélectionnez un mémo pour en afficher les détails. En mode affichage d’un mémo, utilisez les options suivantes : ● Pour supprimer le mémo, appuyez sur → . ● Pour modifier la couleur de l’arrière-plan, appuyez sur → . ● Pour protéger le mémo contre une suppression accidentelle, appuyez sur → . ● Pour imprimer le mémo à l’aide d’une connexion Wi-Fi ou USB, appuyez sur → . Votre appareil est compatible uniquement avec certaines imprimantes Samsung. ● Pour envoyer le mémo à d’autres personnes, appuyez sur → .Connectivité 83 Connectivité Connexions USB Découvrez comment connecter votre appareil à un ordinateur à l’aide d’un câble USB. Ne débranchez pas le câble USB de l’ordinateur lorsque l’appareil transfère ou accède à des données. Vous risqueriez de perdre des données ou d’endommager l’appareil. Pour obtenir de meilleurs résultats, branchez le câble USB directement au port USB de votre ordinateur. Les transferts de données peuvent échouer si vous utilisez un adaptateur USB. › Établir une connexion avec Samsung Kies Assurez-vous que le logiciel Samsung Kies est bien installé sur l’ordinateur. Vous pouvez le télécharger à partir du site Web de Samsung. Samsung Kies fonctionne à la fois sur les ordinateurs Windows et Macintosh. 1 Connectez votre appareil à un ordinateur à l’aide d’un câble USB. Samsung Kies démarre automatiquement sur l’ordinateur. Si Samsung Kies ne démarre pas, double-cliquez sur l’icône correspondante sur votre ordinateur. 2 Transférez des fichiers entre votre appareil et l’ordinateur. Pour plus d’informations, consultez l’aide de Samsung Kies.Connectivité 84 › Établir une connexion avec le lecteur Windows Media Assurez-vous que le lecteur Windows Media est bien installé sur l’ordinateur. 1 Connectez votre appareil à un ordinateur à l’aide d’un câble USB. 2 Ouvrez le lecteur Windows Media et synchronisez les fichiers audio. › Connecter l’appareil en tant que périphérique multimédia Vous pouvez connecter l’appareil à un ordinateur et accéder aux fichiers multimédia qui y sont stockés. 1 Connectez l’appareil à un ordinateur à l’aide d’un câble USB. 2 Appuyez sur la zone des icônes d’information et faites-la glisser vers le bas pour ouvrir le volet de raccourcis. 3 Appuyez sur Connecté en tant que périphérique multimédia→Périphérique multimédia (MTP). 4 Transférez des fichiers entre l’appareil et l’ordinateur. › Connecter l’appareil en tant qu'appareil photo Vous pouvez connecter l’appareil à un ordinateur en tant qu'appareil photo et accéder aux fichiers sur l’appareil. Utilisez ce mode de connexion USB lorsque l’ordinateur n’est pas compatible avec le protocole de transfert multimédia (MTP) ou lorsque le pilote USB de l’appareil n’est pas installé. 1 Connectez l’appareil à un ordinateur à l’aide d’un câble USB. 2 Appuyez sur la zone des icônes d’information et faites-la glisser vers le bas pour ouvrir le volet de raccourcis. 3 Appuyez sur Connecté en tant que périphérique multimédia→Appareil photo (PTP). 4 Transférez des fichiers entre l’appareil et l’ordinateur.Connectivité 85 Wi-Fi Découvrez comment utiliser les capacités de réseau sans fil de votre appareil pour vous connecter à un réseau local sans fil (Wi-Fi) compatible avec la norme IEEE 802.11. Vous pouvez vous connecter à Internet ou à d’autres périphériques réseau dès qu’un point d’accès sans fil est disponible. Votre appareil utilise une fréquence non harmonisée. Il est conçu pour fonctionner dans tous les pays européens. Au sein de l’Union Européenne, le réseau Wi-Fi peut fonctionner sans restriction en intérieur, mais pas en extérieur. ›Activer la fonction Wi-Fi Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres, puis faites glisser le curseur Wi-Fi vers la droite. Tout réseau Wi-Fi fonctionnant en arrière-plan consomme de l’énergie. Pour économiser la batterie, activez le réseau Wi-Fi seulement lorsque vous en avez besoin. › Rechercher un point d’accès Wi-Fi et s’y connecter 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi. L’appareil recherche automatiquement les points d’accès Wi-Fi disponibles. 2 Sélectionnez un point d’accès. 3 Saisissez un mot de passe pour vous connecter au point d’accès (si nécessaire). 4 Appuyez sur Connexion.Connectivité 86 ›Ajouter un point d’accès Wi-Fi manuellement 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi→Ajouter un réseau Wi-Fi. 2 Saisissez le SSID du point d’accès et choisissez un type de sécurité. 3 Définissez les paramètres de sécurité en fonction du type de sécurité choisi précédemment, puis appuyez sur Enreg. › Établir une connexion à un point d’accès Wi-Fi avec une configuration protégée Vous pouvez vous connecter à un point d’accès sécurisé via une touche WPS ou un code PIN WPS. Pour utiliser cette méthode, le point d’accès sans fil doit disposer d’une touche WPS. Établir une connexion avec une touche WPS 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi. 2 Appuyez sur →Touche WPS. 3 Appuyez sur la touche WPS du point d’accès dans un délai de 2 minutes. Établir une connexion avec un code PIN WPS 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi. 2 Appuyez sur →Entrée PIN WPS. 3 Depuis le point d’accès, saisissez le code PIN de l’appareil.Connectivité 87 › Configurer les paramètres IP fixes 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi. 2 Sélectionnez un point d’accès →Afficher les options avancées. 3 Appuyez sur le menu déroulant Paramètres IP. 4 Appuyez sur Statique. 5 Modifiez les paramètres IP. 6 Appuyez sur Connexion. › Personnaliser les paramètres Wi-Fi 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Wi-Fi→ →Paramètres avancés. 2 Modifiez les options suivantes : Option Fonction Notification réseau Configurer l’appareil pour qu’il vous avertisse lorsqu’un point d’accès Wi-Fi est disponible. Wi-Fi activé en mode veille Configurer l’appareil pour laisser la fonction Wi-Fi activée en mode veille. Adresse MAC Afficher l’adresse MAC. Adresse IP Afficher l’adresse IP.Connectivité 88 Wi-Fi Direct Découvrez comment utiliser la fonction Wi-Fi Direct pour raccorder deux appareils via un réseau Wi-Fi sans passer par un point d’accès. › Connecter votre appareil à un autre appareil 1 Dans la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→WiFi→Wi-Fi Direct. 2 Appuyez sur Analyser. 3 Sélectionnez un appareil. Dès que le propriétaire de l’autre appareil accepte la connexion, les appareils sont connectés. › Envoyer des données via Wi-Fi Direct 1 Sélectionnez un fichier ou un élément à partir de l’application appropriée. 2 Sélectionnez une option d’envoi de données via Wi-Fi. La méthode de sélection d’une option peut varier selon le type de données. 3 Recherchez et sélectionnez un autre appareil. › Recevoir des données via Wi-Fi Direct Lorsque vous recevez des données, elles sont automatiquement enregistrées dans votre appareil. Les données reçues sont enregistrées dans le dossier ShareViaWifi du menu Mes fichiers.Connectivité 89 AllShare Play Découvrez comment utiliser le service AllShare Play pour lire du contenu enregistré sur différents appareils via Internet. Vous pouvez lire et envoyer tout fichier stocké sur un appareil sur un autre appareil ou serveur de stockage Web via AllShare Play. Pour utiliser le service AllShare Play, vous devez vous connecter à votre comptes Samsung, et enregistrer au moins deux appareils en tant que serveurs de fichiers. La méthode d’enregistrement peut varier en fonction du type d’appareil. Pour en savoir plus sur l’utilisation de AllShare Play, appuyez sur →Réglages→ Service client. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. › Envoyer un fichier 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur AllShare Play. 2 Sélectionnez un appareil ou un serveur de stockage Web contenant des fichiers multimédia. 3 Sélectionnez une catégorie de fichiers multimédia et cochez le fichier souhaité. 4 Appuyez sur . 5 Sélectionnez un appareil ou un serveur de stockage Web pour enregistrer le fichier. › Partager un fichier 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur AllShare Play. 2 Sélectionnez un appareil ou un serveur de stockage Web contenant des fichiers multimédia. 3 Sélectionnez une catégorie de fichiers multimédia et cochez le fichier souhaité. 4 Appuyez sur et sélectionnez un site de réseau social.Connectivité 90 › Lire un fichier sur un appareil distant ● Les formats de fichiers pris en charge peuvent différer selon les appareils connectés en tant que lecteurs multimédia. ● Selon la connexion réseau, certains fichiers peuvent être mis en mémoire tampon en cours de lecture. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur AllShare Play. 2 Sélectionnez un appareil ou un serveur de stockage Web contenant des fichiers multimédia. 3 Sélectionnez une catégorie de fichiers multimédia et cochez le fichier souhaité. 4 Appuyez sur . 5 Sélectionnez un appareil à utiliser comme lecteur multimédia. 6 Contrôlez la lecture à l’aide des touches de votre appareil. ›Gérer des contenus sur un serveur de stockage Web 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur AllShare Play. 2 Sélectionnez un serveur de stockage Web. 3 Affichez et gérez vos fichiers.Connectivité 91 › Personnaliser les paramètres AllShare Play 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur AllShare Play. 2 Appuyez sur →Réglages. 3 Modifiez les options suivantes: Option Fonction Stockages enregistrés Afficher les serveurs de stockage Web ajoutés à AllShare Play. Périphériques enregistrés Afficher ou modifier les appareils ajoutés à AllShare Play. Configurer des services Web Se connecter à des sites de réseaux sociaux pour télécharger des fichiers. Télétransmettre automatiquement des photos depuis le téléphone portable Paramétrer l’appareil pour qu'il télécharge automatiquement des photos sur le serveur de stockage Web lorsqu’une connexion est établie. Réglages de qualité vidéo Paramétrer l’appareil pour qu'il optimise la qualité vidéo lors de la lecture de vidéos enregistrées sur un ordinateur. Verrouiller AllShare Play Paramétrer l’appareil pour qu'il verrouille AllShare Play avec le mot de passe de votre compte Samsung. Langue Sélectionner une langue d’interface. À propos Afficher les informations à propos de AllShare Play.Connectivité 92 Bluetooth Découvrez comment échanger des données ou des fichiers multimédia avec d’autres appareils via une connexion Bluetooth. ● Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la perte, de l’interception ou du mauvais usage des données envoyées ou reçues via la fonction Bluetooth. ● Assurez-vous de toujours utiliser des appareils dignes de confiance et correctement protégés avant de partager ou de recevoir des données. La présence d’obstacles entre les deux appareils peut réduire le rayon d’action. ● Il est possible que votre appareil ne fonctionne pas avec certains autres appareils, en particulier ceux qui n’ont pas été testés ou approuvés par Bluetooth SIG. ● N’utilisez pas la fonction Bluetooth de manière illégale (par exemple, pour la copie pirate de fichiers ou l’enregistrement de communications à des fins commerciales). Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des répercussions d’une utilisation illégale de la fonction Bluetooth. ›Activer la fonction Bluetooth Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres, puis faites glisser le curseur Bluetooth vers la droite.Connectivité 93 › Rechercher d’autres appareils et s’y connecter 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Bluetooth→Analyser. 2 Sélectionnez un appareil. 3 Appuyez sur OK pour faire correspondre le code PIN Bluetooth des deux appareils. Vous pouvez également saisir un code PIN Bluetooth, puis appuyer sur OK. Lorsque l’utilisateur de l’autre appareil accepte la connexion ou saisit le même code PIN, la liaison entre les deux appareils est effective. Lorsque la connexion est établie avec succès, l’appareil recherche automatiquement les services disponibles. Il est possible que certains appareils, notamment les casques et les kits mains-libres pour voiture, possèdent un code PIN Bluetooth fixe, par exemple 0000. Si c’est le cas, vous devez saisir ce code. › Envoyer des données via le Bluetooth 1 Sélectionnez un fichier ou un élément à partir de l’application appropriée. 2 Sélectionnez une option d’envoi de données via la fonction Bluetooth. La méthode de sélection d’une option peut varier selon le type de données. 3 Recherchez et connectez-vous à un appareil Bluetooth.Connectivité 94 › Recevoir des données via le Bluetooth 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Bluetooth, puis cochez la case située à côté du nom de votre appareil. Pour sélectionner la durée pendant laquelle votre appareil est visible, appuyez sur →Expiration de la visibilité. 2 Lorsque vous y êtes invité, appuyez sur OK pour faire correspondre le code PIN Bluetooth ou saisir le code PIN Bluetooth, puis appuyez sur OK (si nécessaire). 3 Appuyez sur Accepter pour accepter de recevoir les données. Les données reçues sont enregistrées dans le dossier bluetooth du menu Mes fichiers. Si vous recevez un contact, il est automatiquement enregistré dans le répertoire. GPS Votre appareil est équipé d’un récepteur pour système de localisation GPS. Découvrez comment activer les services de localisation et utiliser les autres fonctions GPS. Pour améliorer la qualité de réception GPS, évitez d’utiliser votre appareil dans les conditions suivantes : ● entre des immeubles, dans des tunnels ou des passages souterrains ou à l’intérieur de bâtiments ; ● en cas de mauvaises conditions météorologiques ; ● à proximité de champs magnétiques ou de lignes à haute tension ; ● dans un véhicule doté d’un film de protection solaire. Lorsque vous utilisez les fonctions GPS, ne touchez et ne recouvrez pas l’emplacement de l’antenne avec les mains ou tout autre objet. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.Connectivité 95 ›Activer les services de localisation Pour être en mesure de recevoir des informations de localisation ou parcourir la carte, vous devez activer les services de localisation. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Services de localisation. 2 Modifiez les options suivantes : Option Fonction Utiliser réseaux sans fil Utiliser le réseau Wi-Fi pour localiser votre position géographique. Utiliser les satellites GPS Configurer l’appareil pour qu’il utilise les satellites GPS pour localiser votre position. Localisation & recherche Google Configurer l’appareil pour qu’il utilise votre position actuelle pour la recherche Google et les autres services Google. Connexions VPN Découvrez comment créer des réseaux privés virtuels (VPN) et vous y connecter en toute sécurité via Internet. ● Votre appareil doit être préalablement configuré pour accéder à Internet. En cas de difficultés pour accéder à Internet, vous devez modifier les paramètres de connexion. Si vous n’êtes pas certain des informations de connexion à saisir, renseignez-vous auprès de l’administrateur de votre réseau VPN. ● Pour utiliser cette fonction, vous devez activer la fonction de verrouillage de l’écran.Connectivité 96 ›Définir un profil VPN 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Paramètres supplémentaires→VPN→Ajouter un réseau VPN. 2 Modifiez les options suivantes : Option Fonction Nom Saisir le nom du serveur VPN. Type Sélectionner un type de VPN. Adresse serveur Saisir l’adresse IP du serveur VPN. Secret L2TP Saisir un mot de passe secret L2TP. Identifiant IPSec Saisir un nom d’utilisateur. Clé pré-partagée IPsec Saisir une clé de sécurité pré-partagée. Certificat utilisateur IPSec Sélectionner un certificat utilisateur qui permet au serveur VPN de vous identifier. Vous pouvez importer des certificats depuis le serveur VPN ou les télécharger depuis Internet. Certificat AC IPSec Sélectionner une autorité de certification qui permet au serveur VPN de vous identifier. Vous pouvez importer des certificats depuis le serveur VPN ou les télécharger depuis Internet. Certificat serveur IPSec Sélectionner un certificat de serveur qui permet au serveur VPN de vous identifier. Vous pouvez importer des certificats depuis le serveur VPN ou les télécharger depuis Internet.Connectivité 97 Option Fonction Cryptage PPP (MPPE) Activer le cryptage avant de les envoyer vers le serveur VPN. Afficher les options avancées Modifier les options avancées du réseau. Les options disponibles peuvent varier en fonction du type de réseau VPN. 3 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur Enreg. › Établir une connexion à un réseau privé 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres→ Paramètres supplémentaires→VPN. 2 Sélectionnez un réseau privé. 3 Saisissez votre nom d’utilisateur et votre mot de passe, puis appuyez sur Connexion.98 Outils Outils Alarme Découvrez comment programmer et gérer des alarmes pour des événements importants. › Programmer une alarme 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Alarme. 2 Appuyez sur . 3 Définissez les détails de l’alarme. 4 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur OK. Pour activer ou désactiver une alarme, appuyez sur l’icône en forme d'horloge à côté de l’alarme. Pour supprimer une alarme, appuyez sur . ›Arrêter une alarme Lorsque l’alarme sonne : ● Pour arrêter l’alarme, faites glisser votre doigt sur l'icône . ● Pour interrompre l’alarme pendant la période de répétition, faites glisser votre doigt sur l'icône .99 Outils Calculatrice Découvrez comment exécuter des calculs avec votre appareil. › Effectuer des calculs 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Calculatrice. 2 Utilisez les touches à l’écran pour réaliser des calculs simples. Faites pivoter l’appareil vers la gauche pour utiliser la calculatrice scientifique. Si vous avez désactivé la fonction de rotation automatique, appuyez sur →Calculatrice scientifique. ›Afficher l’historique du calcul 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Calculatrice. 2 Effectuez un calcul. 3 Appuyez sur pour masquer le clavier de la calculatrice. L’historique du calcul apparaît. Téléchargements Découvrez comment gérer les historiques des fichiers téléchargés à partir du Web et de vos e-mails. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Téléch. 2 Choisissez une catégorie. 3 Pour ouvrir un fichier téléchargé, sélectionnez-le dans l’historique. Pour supprimer un fichier, cochez la case correspondante dans l’historique, puis appuyez sur .100 Outils Dropbox Découvrez comment utiliser le service Dropbox de stockage sur le Cloud pour enregistrer et partager vos fichiers avec d’autres personnes. Lorsque vous enregistrez des fichiers dans Dropbox, votre appareil les synchronise automatiquement avec le serveur Web et tout autre ordinateur sur lequel le service Dropbox est installé. ›Activer le service Dropbox 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Dropbox→ Démarrer. 2 Saisissez une adresse e-mail et un mot de passe, puis appuyez sur Se connecter. Si vous êtes un nouvel utilisateur, appuyez sur Vous découvrez Dropbox ? Créer un compte pour créer un compte. 3 Appuyez sur Suivant. 4 Appuyez sur Mettre en marche pour télécharger automatiquement les photos et vidéos de votre appareil photo. › Télécharger des fichiers dans votre dossier Dropbox 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Dropbox. 2 Appuyez sur → →Charger ici→Photos ou vidéos ou Autres fichiers. 3 Sélectionnez des fichiers. 4 Appuyez sur Charger. Les fichiers contenus dans le dossier sont ajoutés sur le serveur Web et sur votre ordinateur.101 Outils ›Afficher un fichier 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Dropbox→ . 2 Sélectionnez un fichier. Mes fichiers Découvrez comment accéder aux divers types de fichiers enregistrés dans votre appareil. › Formats de fichiers compatibles Votre appareil est compatible avec les formats de fichiers suivants : Type Format Image bmp, gif, jpg, png Vidéo avi, 3gp/mp4, wmv, flv, mkv, webm Musique flac, mp3, wma, aac, ogg, amr, wav, mid, xmf, imy Son amr-nb/wb, wav, mid, midi, xmf, mxmf, i-melody (imy), sp-midi, rtttl/rtx, ota Autres doc, docx, pdf, ppt, pptx, txt, xls, xlsx, htm, html, vcf, vcs, vnt ● Certains formats peuvent ne pas être compatibles selon la version logicielle de l’appareil. ● Une erreur peut se produire à l’ouverture d’un fichier si la taille de celui-ci dépasse la quantité de mémoire disponible.102 Outils ›Afficher un fichier 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Mes fichiers. 2 Sélectionnez un dossier. ● Pour accéder au niveau supérieur du répertoire de fichiers, appuyez sur . ● Appuyez sur pour revenir au répertoire principal. 3 Sélectionnez un fichier. Dans la liste des dossiers, accédez aux options suivantes : ● Pour rechercher des fichiers enregistrés dans votre appareil, appuyez sur . ● Pour afficher les fichiers sous forme de miniature, appuyez sur . ● Pour créer des dossiers pour gérer les fichiers, appuyez sur . ● Pour modifier les paramètres du gestionnaire de fichiers, appuyez sur →Paramètres. ● Pour trier des fichiers ou des dossiers, appuyez sur Heure dans le menu déroulant et sélectionnez une option. ● Pour envoyer un fichier à d’autres personnes, cochez la case correspondante, puis appuyez sur . ● Pour copier ou déplacer des fichiers ou des dossiers vers un autre dossier, cochez les cases correspondantes, puis appuyez sur ou . ● Pour supprimer des fichiers ou des dossiers, cochez la case correspondante, puis appuyez sur . ● Pour changer le nom d’un fichier ou d’un dossier, cochez la case et appuyez sur →Renommer. ● Pour afficher des informations détaillées sur des fichiers ou des dossiers, cochez la case correspondante, puis appuyez sur → Détails. Polaris Office Découvrez comment créer et afficher des documents avec votre appareil. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.103 Outils › Créer un document 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Polaris Office. 2 Appuyez sur → un type de document. 3 Sélectionnez un modèle (si nécessaire). 4 Créez le document. 5 Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur →Enregistrer. 6 Attribuez un nom au document, sélectionnez son emplacement d’enregistrement, puis appuyez sur Enregistrer. › Ouvrir un document 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Polaris Office. 2 Appuyez sur Navigateur→ un document. Pour ouvrir un fichier récemment utilisé, sélectionnez un fichier dans Documents récents. 3 Affichez le document. Dans la fenêtre du document, accédez aux options suivantes : ● Pour effectuer un zoom avant, posez vos deux doigts joints sur l’écran et écartez-les lentement, puis rapprochez-les. ● Pour annuler votre dernière opération, appuyez sur . ● Pour répéter votre dernière opération, appuyez sur . ● Pour ajouter un élément au document, appuyez sur . ● Pour ouvrir la barre d’outils des modifications, appuyez sur . ● Pour rechercher du texte dans un document texte, appuyez sur . ● Pour utiliser des options supplémentaires, appuyez sur . Les options disponibles peuvent varier en fonction du type de document.104 Outils ›Gérer des documents en ligne 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Polaris Office. 2 Appuyez sur Clouds→Ajouter compte→ un service de cloud. 3 Saisissez votre adresse e-mail et votre mot de passe pour accéder à votre compte, puis appuyez sur OK. 4 Affichez et gérez vos documents sur le serveur. Recherche Google Découvrez comment rechercher des données enregistrées sur votre appareil ou sur Internet. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Google. 2 Saisissez un mot-clé et appuyez sur . Pour rechercher des données oralement, appuyez sur et prononcez un mot-clé dans le microphone de votre appareil. 3 Sélectionnez un résultat de recherche. Horloge mondiale Découvrez comment afficher l’heure d’une autre zone géographique et paramétrer l’affichage de l’horloge mondiale sur votre écran. 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Horloge mondiale→ . 2 Saisissez le nom d’une ville ou sélectionnez-en une sur le globe. 3 Appuyez sur . Pour appliquer l’heure d’été, maintenez le doigt appuyé sur l’horloge, puis appuyez sur Heure d’été.Paramètres 105 Paramètres Accéder au menu Paramètres 1 Depuis la liste des applications, appuyez sur Paramètres. 2 Sélectionnez une catégorie de paramètres, puis une option. Wi-Fi Activez la fonction Wi-Fi pour permettre la connexion à un point d’accès Wi-Fi et accéder à Internet ou à d’autres périphériques réseau. Pour utiliser des options supplémentaires, appuyez sur . ● Paramètres avancés : personnalisez les paramètres Wi-Fi. ● Touche WPS : connectez-vous à un point d’accès Wi-Fi sécurisé à l’aide d’une touche WPS. ● Entrée PIN WPS : connectez-vous à un point d’accès Wi-Fi sécurisé à l’aide d’un code PIN WPS. Bluetooth Activez ou désactivez la fonction Bluetooth pour échanger des informations sur de courtes distances. Utilisation des données Suivez votre utilisation des données et personnalisez les paramètres relatifs à votre limite d’utilisation.Paramètres 106 Paramètres supplémentaires Modifiez les paramètres servant à contrôler les connexions avec d’autres appareils ou réseaux. › Mode Hors-ligne Activez le mode Hors-ligne pour désactiver toutes les fonctions sans fil de l’appareil. Vous pouvez alors uniquement utiliser les fonctions qui ne nécessitent pas de connexion radio, c’est-à-dire toutes les fonctions sauf le Wi-Fi et le Bluetooth. › VPN Paramétrez et gérez les réseaux privés virtuels (VPN). ›Appareils à proximité ● Partage de fichiers : activez le partage multimédia pour permettre à d’autres appareils certifiés DLNA d’accéder aux fichiers multimédia enregistrés sur votre appareil. ● Contenus partagés : paramétrez l’appareil pour pouvoir partager son contenu avec d’autres appareils. ● Nom de l’appareil : saisissez un nom pour désigner votre appareil en tant que serveur multimédia. ● Liste des appareils autorisés : affichez la liste des appareils qui peuvent accéder à votre appareil. ● Liste des périphériques non autorisés : affichez la liste des appareils qui ne sont pas autorisés à accéder à votre appareil. ● Télécharger sur : sélectionnez l’emplacement de la mémoire dans laquelle enregistrer les fichiers multimédia téléchargés. ● Charger depuis d’autres périphériques : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu'il autorise le chargement à partir d’autres appareils. › Kies via Wi-Fi Connectez votre appareil à Samsung Kies via le Wi-Fi.Paramètres 107 Mode blocage Sélectionnez quelles notifications bloquer. Son Modifiez les paramètres des différents sons de l’appareil. ● Volume : réglez le volume des différents sons de l’appareil. ● Notifications par défaut : sélectionnez une sonnerie pour signaler des événements. ● Tonalité des touches : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu’il émette un son lorsque vous sélectionnez une application ou une option. ● Son verrouillage écran : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu’il émette un son lorsque vous verrouillez ou déverrouillez l’écran tactile. Affichage Modifiez les paramètres servant à contrôler l’écran et le rétroéclairage de votre appareil. ● Fond d’écran : - Écran d’accueil : sélectionnez l’image d’arrière-plan de l’écran d’accueil. - Ecran de verrouillage : sélectionnez l’image d’arrière-plan de l’écran de verrouillage. - Ecrans d’accueil et de verrouillage : sélectionnez l’image d’arrière-plan de l’écran d’accueil et de l’écran de verrouillage. ● Luminosité : réglez la luminosité de l’écran. ● Mise en veille de l’écran : définissez le délai de désactivation automatique du rétroéclairage. ● Veille intelligente : paramétrez l’appareil pour éviter que le rétroéclairage de l’écran ne s’éteigne lorsque vous regardes l’écran.Paramètres 108 ● Police : modifiez le type de police du texte affiché à l’écran. ● Taille de police : modifiez la taille de la police pour créer ou afficher des éléments dans les applications. ● Affich. pourcentage batterie : paramétrez l’appareil pour afficher la durée d’autonomie de la batterie. Stockage Affichez les informations de mémoire relatives à l’appareil et à la carte mémoire. Vous pouvez également formater la carte mémoire. Le formatage d’une carte mémoire supprime définitivement toutes ses données. La capacité réelle de la mémoire interne est inférieure à la capacité indiquée, car le système d’exploitation et les applications par défaut occupent une partie de cette mémoire. Économie d’énergie Activez le mode Économie d’énergie et modifiez ses paramètres. ● Éco. d’énergie UC : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu'il limite l’utilisation de certaines ressources système de l’appareil. ● Éco. d’énergie écran : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu'il diminue la luminosité de l’écran. ● En savoir plus : affichez les informations pour savoir comment économiser l’énergie de la batterie. Batterie Affichez la quantité d’énergie de la batterie consommée par l’appareil.Paramètres 109 Gestionnaire d’applications Affichez et gérez les applications de votre appareil. Services de localisation Modifiez les paramètres des services de localisation. ● Utiliser réseaux sans fil : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu'il utilise les réseaux Wi-Fi et/ou mobiles pour localiser votre position. ● Utiliser les satellites GPS : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu’il utilise les satellites GPS pour localiser votre position. ● Localisation & recherche Google : paramétrez l’appareil pour qu’il utilise votre position actuelle pour la recherche Google et les autres services Google. Ecran de verrouillage Modifiez les paramètres de sécurité de votre appareil. ● Déverrouillage de l’écran : activez la fonction de déverrouillage sécurisé de l’écran. ● Options de l’écran de verrouillage : Ces paramètres sont disponibles uniquement si l’option Verrouillage par glissement est activée. - Raccourcis : paramétrez l’appareil pour pouvoir afficher et modifier les raccourcis des applications sur l’écran vérrouillé. La disponibilité de cette fonction dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur. - Symbole informations : paramétrez l’appareil pour afficher les actualités ou les cours de la Bourse sur l’écran vérrouillé. - Horloge : paramétrez l’appareil pour afficher l’horloge sur l’écran vérrouillé.Paramètres 110 - Météo : paramétrez l’appareil pour pouvoir afficher les informations météo et modifier les paramètres d’affichage de la météo. - Texte d’aide : paramétrez l’appareil pour afficher l’aide sur l’écran vérrouillé. ● Infos propriétaire : saisissez les informations que vous souhaitez